3 @setfilename coreutils.info
4 @settitle @sc{gnu} Coreutils
9 @include constants.texi
11 @c Define new indices.
15 @c Put everything in one index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
25 * Coreutils: (coreutils). Core GNU (file, text, shell) utilities.
26 * Common options: (coreutils)Common options. Common options.
27 * File permissions: (coreutils)File permissions. Access modes.
28 * Date input formats: (coreutils)Date input formats.
31 @c FIXME: the following need documentation
32 @c * [: (coreutils)[ invocation. File/string tests.
33 @c * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. FIXME.
34 @c * uptime: (coreutils)uptime invocation. FIXME.
35 @c * mktemp: (coreutils)mktemp invocation. FIXME.
36 @c * chcon: (coreutils)chcon invocation. FIXME.
38 @dircategory Individual utilities
40 * arch: (coreutils)arch invocation. Print machine hardware name.
41 * base64: (coreutils)base64 invocation. Base64 encode/decode data.
42 * basename: (coreutils)basename invocation. Strip directory and suffix.
43 * cat: (coreutils)cat invocation. Concatenate and write files.
44 * chgrp: (coreutils)chgrp invocation. Change file groups.
45 * chmod: (coreutils)chmod invocation. Change file permissions.
46 * chown: (coreutils)chown invocation. Change file owners/groups.
47 * chroot: (coreutils)chroot invocation. Specify the root directory.
48 * cksum: (coreutils)cksum invocation. Print POSIX CRC checksum.
49 * comm: (coreutils)comm invocation. Compare sorted files by line.
50 * cp: (coreutils)cp invocation. Copy files.
51 * csplit: (coreutils)csplit invocation. Split by context.
52 * cut: (coreutils)cut invocation. Print selected parts of lines.
53 * date: (coreutils)date invocation. Print/set system date and time.
54 * dd: (coreutils)dd invocation. Copy and convert a file.
55 * df: (coreutils)df invocation. Report file system disk usage.
56 * dir: (coreutils)dir invocation. List directories briefly.
57 * dircolors: (coreutils)dircolors invocation. Color setup for ls.
58 * dirname: (coreutils)dirname invocation. Strip non-directory suffix.
59 * du: (coreutils)du invocation. Report on disk usage.
60 * echo: (coreutils)echo invocation. Print a line of text.
61 * env: (coreutils)env invocation. Modify the environment.
62 * expand: (coreutils)expand invocation. Convert tabs to spaces.
63 * expr: (coreutils)expr invocation. Evaluate expressions.
64 * factor: (coreutils)factor invocation. Print prime factors
65 * false: (coreutils)false invocation. Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
66 * fmt: (coreutils)fmt invocation. Reformat paragraph text.
67 * fold: (coreutils)fold invocation. Wrap long input lines.
68 * groups: (coreutils)groups invocation. Print group names a user is in.
69 * head: (coreutils)head invocation. Output the first part of files.
70 * hostid: (coreutils)hostid invocation. Print numeric host identifier.
71 * hostname: (coreutils)hostname invocation. Print or set system name.
72 * id: (coreutils)id invocation. Print user identity.
73 * install: (coreutils)install invocation. Copy and change attributes.
74 * join: (coreutils)join invocation. Join lines on a common field.
75 * kill: (coreutils)kill invocation. Send a signal to processes.
76 * link: (coreutils)link invocation. Make hard links between files.
77 * ln: (coreutils)ln invocation. Make links between files.
78 * logname: (coreutils)logname invocation. Print current login name.
79 * ls: (coreutils)ls invocation. List directory contents.
80 * md5sum: (coreutils)md5sum invocation. Print or check MD5 digests.
81 * mkdir: (coreutils)mkdir invocation. Create directories.
82 * mkfifo: (coreutils)mkfifo invocation. Create FIFOs (named pipes).
83 * mknod: (coreutils)mknod invocation. Create special files.
84 * mv: (coreutils)mv invocation. Rename files.
85 * nice: (coreutils)nice invocation. Modify niceness.
86 * nl: (coreutils)nl invocation. Number lines and write files.
87 * nohup: (coreutils)nohup invocation. Immunize to hangups.
88 * od: (coreutils)od invocation. Dump files in octal, etc.
89 * paste: (coreutils)paste invocation. Merge lines of files.
90 * pathchk: (coreutils)pathchk invocation. Check file name portability.
91 * pr: (coreutils)pr invocation. Paginate or columnate files.
92 * printenv: (coreutils)printenv invocation. Print environment variables.
93 * printf: (coreutils)printf invocation. Format and print data.
94 * ptx: (coreutils)ptx invocation. Produce permuted indexes.
95 * pwd: (coreutils)pwd invocation. Print working directory.
96 * readlink: (coreutils)readlink invocation. Print referent of a symlink.
97 * rm: (coreutils)rm invocation. Remove files.
98 * rmdir: (coreutils)rmdir invocation. Remove empty directories.
99 * seq: (coreutils)seq invocation. Print numeric sequences
100 * sha1sum: (coreutils)sha1sum invocation. Print or check SHA-1 digests.
101 * sha2: (coreutils)sha2 utilities. Print or check SHA-2 digests.
102 * shred: (coreutils)shred invocation. Remove files more securely.
103 * shuf: (coreutils)shuf invocation. Shuffling text files.
104 * sleep: (coreutils)sleep invocation. Delay for a specified time.
105 * sort: (coreutils)sort invocation. Sort text files.
106 * split: (coreutils)split invocation. Split into fixed-size pieces.
107 * stat: (coreutils)stat invocation. Report file(system) status.
108 * stty: (coreutils)stty invocation. Print/change terminal settings.
109 * su: (coreutils)su invocation. Modify user and group ID.
110 * sum: (coreutils)sum invocation. Print traditional checksum.
111 * sync: (coreutils)sync invocation. Synchronize memory and disk.
112 * tac: (coreutils)tac invocation. Reverse files.
113 * tail: (coreutils)tail invocation. Output the last part of files.
114 * tee: (coreutils)tee invocation. Redirect to multiple files.
115 * test: (coreutils)test invocation. File/string tests.
116 * touch: (coreutils)touch invocation. Change file timestamps.
117 * tr: (coreutils)tr invocation. Translate characters.
118 * true: (coreutils)true invocation. Do nothing, successfully.
119 * tsort: (coreutils)tsort invocation. Topological sort.
120 * tty: (coreutils)tty invocation. Print terminal name.
121 * uname: (coreutils)uname invocation. Print system information.
122 * unexpand: (coreutils)unexpand invocation. Convert spaces to tabs.
123 * uniq: (coreutils)uniq invocation. Uniquify files.
124 * unlink: (coreutils)unlink invocation. Removal via unlink(2).
125 * users: (coreutils)users invocation. Print current user names.
126 * vdir: (coreutils)vdir invocation. List directories verbosely.
127 * wc: (coreutils)wc invocation. Line, word, and byte counts.
128 * who: (coreutils)who invocation. Print who is logged in.
129 * whoami: (coreutils)whoami invocation. Print effective user ID.
130 * yes: (coreutils)yes invocation. Print a string indefinitely.
134 This manual documents version @value{VERSION} of the @sc{gnu} core
135 utilities, including the standard programs for text and file manipulation.
137 Copyright @copyright{} 1994-1996, 2000-2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
140 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
141 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
142 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
143 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
144 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
145 Free Documentation License''.
150 @title @sc{gnu} @code{Coreutils}
151 @subtitle Core GNU utilities
152 @subtitle for version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}
153 @author David MacKenzie et al.
156 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
168 @cindex core utilities
169 @cindex text utilities
170 @cindex shell utilities
171 @cindex file utilities
174 * Introduction:: Caveats, overview, and authors.
175 * Common options:: Common options.
176 * Output of entire files:: cat tac nl od
177 * Formatting file contents:: fmt pr fold
178 * Output of parts of files:: head tail split csplit
179 * Summarizing files:: wc sum cksum md5sum sha1sum sha2
180 * Operating on sorted files:: sort shuf uniq comm ptx tsort
181 * Operating on fields within a line:: cut paste join
182 * Operating on characters:: tr expand unexpand
183 * Directory listing:: ls dir vdir dircolors
184 * Basic operations:: cp dd install mv rm shred
185 * Special file types:: ln mkdir rmdir mkfifo mknod
186 * Changing file attributes:: chgrp chmod chown touch
187 * Disk usage:: df du stat sync
188 * Printing text:: echo printf yes
189 * Conditions:: false true test expr
191 * File name manipulation:: dirname basename pathchk
192 * Working context:: pwd stty printenv tty
193 * User information:: id logname whoami groups users who
194 * System context:: date uname hostname hostid
195 * Modified command invocation:: chroot env nice nohup su
196 * Process control:: kill
198 * Numeric operations:: factor seq
199 * File permissions:: Access modes.
200 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
201 * Opening the software toolbox:: The software tools philosophy.
202 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual.
203 * Concept index:: General index.
206 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
210 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
211 * Backup options:: Backup options
212 * Block size:: Block size
213 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp and chown owner and group syntax
214 * Random sources:: Sources of random data
215 * Target directory:: Target directory
216 * Trailing slashes:: Trailing slashes
217 * Traversing symlinks:: Traversing symlinks to directories
218 * Treating / specially:: Treating / specially
219 * Standards conformance:: Standards conformance
221 Output of entire files
223 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
224 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
225 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
226 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
227 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
229 Formatting file contents
231 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
232 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
233 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
235 Output of parts of files
237 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
238 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
239 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces.
240 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
244 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
245 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
246 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
247 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
248 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
249 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
251 Operating on sorted files
253 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
254 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
255 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
256 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
257 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
258 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
260 @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
262 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
263 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
264 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
265 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
266 * Compatibility in ptx:: The @acronym{GNU} extensions to @command{ptx}
268 Operating on fields within a line
270 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
271 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
272 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
274 Operating on characters
276 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
277 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
278 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
280 @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
282 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
283 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
284 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
288 * ls invocation:: List directory contents
289 * dir invocation:: Briefly list directory contents
290 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely list directory contents
291 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for @command{ls}
293 @command{ls}: List directory contents
295 * Which files are listed:: Which files are listed
296 * What information is listed:: What information is listed
297 * Sorting the output:: Sorting the output
298 * More details about version sort:: More details about version sort
299 * General output formatting:: General output formatting
300 * Formatting the file names:: Formatting the file names
304 * cp invocation:: Copy files and directories
305 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file
306 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes
307 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files
308 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories
309 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely
313 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
314 * ln invocation:: Make links between files
315 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories
316 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
317 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files
318 * readlink invocation:: Print the referent of a symbolic link
319 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories
320 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via unlink syscall
322 Changing file attributes
324 * chown invocation:: Change file owner and group
325 * chgrp invocation:: Change group ownership
326 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions
327 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps
331 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage
332 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage
333 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status
334 * sync invocation:: Synchronize data on disk with memory
338 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text
339 * printf invocation:: Format and print data
340 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted
344 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
345 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully
346 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values
347 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions
349 @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
351 * File type tests:: File type tests
352 * Access permission tests:: Access permission tests
353 * File characteristic tests:: File characteristic tests
354 * String tests:: String tests
355 * Numeric tests:: Numeric tests
357 @command{expr}: Evaluate expression
359 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
360 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
361 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
362 * Examples of expr:: Examples of using @command{expr}
366 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
368 File name manipulation
370 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
371 * dirname invocation:: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name
372 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name portability
376 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory
377 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics
378 * printenv invocation:: Print all or some environment variables
379 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input
381 @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
383 * Control:: Control settings
384 * Input:: Input settings
385 * Output:: Output settings
386 * Local:: Local settings
387 * Combination:: Combination settings
388 * Characters:: Special characters
389 * Special:: Special settings
393 * id invocation:: Print user identity
394 * logname invocation:: Print current login name
395 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID
396 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in
397 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in
398 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in
402 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name
403 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time
404 * uname invocation:: Print system information
405 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name
406 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
408 @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
410 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
411 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
412 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
413 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
414 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
415 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
416 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
417 * Examples of date:: Examples.
419 Modified command invocation
421 * chroot invocation:: Run a command with a different root directory
422 * env invocation:: Run a command in a modified environment
423 * nice invocation:: Run a command with modified niceness
424 * nohup invocation:: Run a command immune to hangups
425 * su invocation:: Run a command with substitute user and group ID
429 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
433 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time
437 * factor invocation:: Print prime factors
438 * seq invocation:: Print numeric sequences
442 * Mode Structure:: Structure of file mode bits.
443 * Symbolic Modes:: Mnemonic representation of file mode bits.
444 * Numeric Modes:: File mode bits as octal numbers.
445 * Directory Setuid and Setgid:: Set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
449 * General date syntax:: Common rules.
450 * Calendar date items:: 19 Dec 1994.
451 * Time of day items:: 9:20pm.
452 * Time zone items:: @sc{est}, @sc{pdt}, @sc{gmt}.
453 * Day of week items:: Monday and others.
454 * Relative items in date strings:: next tuesday, 2 years ago.
455 * Pure numbers in date strings:: 19931219, 1440.
456 * Seconds since the Epoch:: @@1078100502.
457 * Specifying time zone rules:: TZ="America/New_York", TZ="UTC0".
458 * Authors of get_date:: Bellovin, Eggert, Salz, Berets, et al.
460 Opening the software toolbox
462 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
463 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
464 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
465 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
466 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
467 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
468 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
472 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual.
479 @chapter Introduction
481 This manual is a work in progress: many sections make no attempt to explain
482 basic concepts in a way suitable for novices. Thus, if you are interested,
483 please get involved in improving this manual. The entire @sc{gnu} community
486 @cindex @acronym{POSIX}
487 The @sc{gnu} utilities documented here are mostly compatible with the
488 @acronym{POSIX} standard.
489 @cindex bugs, reporting
490 Please report bugs to @email{bug-coreutils@@gnu.org}. Remember
491 to include the version number, machine architecture, input files, and
492 any other information needed to reproduce the bug: your input, what you
493 expected, what you got, and why it is wrong. Diffs are welcome, but
494 please include a description of the problem as well, since this is
495 sometimes difficult to infer. @xref{Bugs, , , gcc, Using and Porting GNU CC}.
501 @cindex MacKenzie, D.
504 This manual was originally derived from the Unix man pages in the
505 distributions, which were written by David MacKenzie and updated by Jim
506 Meyering. What you are reading now is the authoritative documentation
507 for these utilities; the man pages are no longer being maintained. The
508 original @command{fmt} man page was written by Ross Paterson. Fran@,{c}ois
509 Pinard did the initial conversion to Texinfo format. Karl Berry did the
510 indexing, some reorganization, and editing of the results. Brian
511 Youmans of the Free Software Foundation office staff combined the
512 manuals for textutils, fileutils, and sh-utils to produce the present
513 omnibus manual. Richard Stallman contributed his usual invaluable
514 insights to the overall process.
517 @chapter Common options
521 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
524 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
525 @cindex backups, making
526 @xref{Backup options}.
527 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
530 @macro optBackupSuffix
531 @item -S @var{suffix}
532 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
535 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}.
536 @xref{Backup options}.
539 @macro optTargetDirectory
540 @item -t @var{directory}
541 @itemx @w{@kbd{--target-directory}=@var{directory}}
543 @opindex --target-directory
544 @cindex target directory
545 @cindex destination directory
546 Specify the destination @var{directory}.
547 @xref{Target directory}.
550 @macro optNoTargetDirectory
552 @itemx --no-target-directory
554 @opindex --no-target-directory
555 @cindex target directory
556 @cindex destination directory
557 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
558 symbolic link to a directory. @xref{Target directory}.
565 Append an SI-style abbreviation to each size, such as @samp{M} for
566 megabytes. Powers of 1000 are used, not 1024; @samp{M} stands for
567 1,000,000 bytes. This option is equivalent to
568 @option{--block-size=si}. Use the @option{-h} or
569 @option{--human-readable} option if
570 you prefer powers of 1024.
573 @macro optHumanReadable
575 @itemx --human-readable
577 @opindex --human-readable
578 @cindex human-readable output
579 Append a size letter to each size, such as @samp{M} for mebibytes.
580 Powers of 1024 are used, not 1000; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
581 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=human-readable}.
582 Use the @option{--si} option if you prefer powers of 1000.
585 @macro optStripTrailingSlashes
586 @itemx @w{@kbd{--strip-trailing-slashes}}
587 @opindex --strip-trailing-slashes
588 @cindex stripping trailing slashes
589 Remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument.
590 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
593 @cindex common options
595 Certain options are available in all of these programs. Rather than
596 writing identical descriptions for each of the programs, they are
597 described here. (In fact, every @sc{gnu} program accepts (or should accept)
600 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
601 Normally options and operands can appear in any order, and programs act
602 as if all the options appear before any operands. For example,
603 @samp{sort -r passwd -t :} acts like @samp{sort -r -t : passwd}, since
604 @samp{:} is an option-argument of @option{-t}. However, if the
605 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, options must appear
606 before operands, unless otherwise specified for a particular command.
608 A few programs can usefully have trailing operands with leading
609 @samp{-}. With such a program, options must precede operands even if
610 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set, and this fact is noted in the
611 program description. For example, the @command{env} command's options
612 must appear before its operands, since in some cases the operands
613 specify a command that itself contains options.
615 Some of these programs recognize the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
616 options only when one of them is the sole command line argument.
623 Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully.
627 @cindex version number, finding
628 Print the version number, then exit successfully.
632 @cindex option delimiter
633 Delimit the option list. Later arguments, if any, are treated as
634 operands even if they begin with @samp{-}. For example, @samp{sort --
635 -r} reads from the file named @file{-r}.
639 @cindex standard input
640 @cindex standard output
641 A single @samp{-} operand is not really an option, though it looks like one. It
642 stands for standard input, or for standard output if that is clear from
643 the context. For example, @samp{sort -} reads from standard input,
644 and is equivalent to plain @samp{sort}, and @samp{tee -} writes an
645 extra copy of its input to standard output. Unless otherwise
646 specified, @samp{-} can appear as any operand that requires a file
650 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
651 * Backup options:: -b -S, in some programs.
652 * Block size:: BLOCK_SIZE and --block-size, in some programs.
653 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp and chown owner and group syntax
654 * Random sources:: --random-source, in some programs.
655 * Target directory:: Specifying a target directory, in some programs.
656 * Trailing slashes:: --strip-trailing-slashes, in some programs.
657 * Traversing symlinks:: -H, -L, or -P, in some programs.
658 * Treating / specially:: --preserve-root and --no-preserve-root.
659 * Special built-in utilities:: @command{break}, @command{:}, @command{eval}, @dots{}
660 * Standards conformance:: Conformance to the @acronym{POSIX} standard.
668 An exit status of zero indicates success,
669 and a nonzero value indicates failure.
672 Nearly every command invocation yields an integral @dfn{exit status}
673 that can be used to change how other commands work.
674 For the vast majority of commands, an exit status of zero indicates
675 success. Failure is indicated by a nonzero value---typically
676 @samp{1}, though it may differ on unusual platforms as @acronym{POSIX}
677 requires only that it be nonzero.
679 However, some of the programs documented here do produce
680 other exit status values and a few associate different
681 meanings with the values @samp{0} and @samp{1}.
682 Here are some of the exceptions:
683 @command{chroot}, @command{env}, @command{expr},
684 @command{nice}, @command{nohup}, @command{printenv},
685 @command{sort}, @command{su}, @command{test}, @command{tty}.
689 @section Backup options
691 @cindex backup options
693 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{cp}, @command{install},
694 @command{ln}, and @command{mv}) optionally make backups of files
695 before writing new versions.
696 These options control the details of these backups. The options are also
697 briefly mentioned in the descriptions of the particular programs.
702 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
705 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
706 @cindex backups, making
707 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
708 Without this option, the original versions are destroyed.
709 Use @var{method} to determine the type of backups to make.
710 When this option is used but @var{method} is not specified,
711 then the value of the @env{VERSION_CONTROL}
712 environment variable is used. And if @env{VERSION_CONTROL} is not set,
713 the default backup type is @samp{existing}.
715 Note that the short form of this option, @option{-b} does not accept any
716 argument. Using @option{-b} is equivalent to using @option{--backup=existing}.
718 @vindex version-control @r{Emacs variable}
719 This option corresponds to the Emacs variable @samp{version-control};
720 the values for @var{method} are the same as those used in Emacs.
721 This option also accepts more descriptive names.
722 The valid @var{method}s are (unique abbreviations are accepted):
727 @opindex none @r{backup method}
732 @opindex numbered @r{backup method}
733 Always make numbered backups.
737 @opindex existing @r{backup method}
738 Make numbered backups of files that already have them, simple backups
743 @opindex simple @r{backup method}
744 Always make simple backups. Please note @samp{never} is not to be
745 confused with @samp{none}.
749 @item -S @var{suffix}
750 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
753 @cindex backup suffix
754 @vindex SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
755 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}. If this
756 option is not specified, the value of the @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX}
757 environment variable is used. And if @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX} is not
758 set, the default is @samp{~}, just as in Emacs.
767 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{df}, @command{du}, and
768 @command{ls}) display sizes in ``blocks''. You can adjust the block size
769 and method of display to make sizes easier to read. The block size
770 used for display is independent of any file system block size.
771 Fractional block counts are rounded up to the nearest integer.
773 @opindex --block-size=@var{size}
776 @vindex DF_BLOCK_SIZE
777 @vindex DU_BLOCK_SIZE
778 @vindex LS_BLOCK_SIZE
779 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT@r{, and block size}
781 The default block size is chosen by examining the following environment
782 variables in turn; the first one that is set determines the block size.
787 This specifies the default block size for the @command{df} command.
788 Similarly, @env{DU_BLOCK_SIZE} specifies the default for @command{du} and
789 @env{LS_BLOCK_SIZE} for @command{ls}.
792 This specifies the default block size for all three commands, if the
793 above command-specific environment variables are not set.
796 This specifies the default block size for all values that are normally
797 printed as blocks, if neither @env{BLOCK_SIZE} nor the above
798 command-specific environment variables are set. Unlike the other
799 environment variables, @env{BLOCKSIZE} does not affect values that are
800 normally printed as byte counts, e.g., the file sizes contained in
803 @item POSIXLY_CORRECT
804 If neither @env{@var{command}_BLOCK_SIZE}, nor @env{BLOCK_SIZE}, nor
805 @env{BLOCKSIZE} is set, but this variable is set, the block size
810 If none of the above environment variables are set, the block size
811 currently defaults to 1024 bytes in most contexts, but this number may
812 change in the future. For @command{ls} file sizes, the block size
815 @cindex human-readable output
818 A block size specification can be a positive integer specifying the number
819 of bytes per block, or it can be @code{human-readable} or @code{si} to
820 select a human-readable format. Integers may be followed by suffixes
821 that are upward compatible with the
822 @uref{http://www.bipm.fr/enus/3_SI/si-prefixes.html, SI prefixes}
823 for decimal multiples and with the
824 @uref{http://physics.nist.gov/cuu/Units/binary.html, IEC 60027-2
825 prefixes for binary multiples}.
827 With human-readable formats, output sizes are followed by a size letter
828 such as @samp{M} for megabytes. @code{BLOCK_SIZE=human-readable} uses
829 powers of 1024; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
830 @code{BLOCK_SIZE=si} is similar, but uses powers of 1000 and appends
831 @samp{B}; @samp{MB} stands for 1,000,000 bytes.
834 A block size specification preceded by @samp{'} causes output sizes to
835 be displayed with thousands separators. The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale
836 specifies the thousands separator and grouping. For example, in an
837 American English locale, @samp{--block-size="'1kB"} would cause a size
838 of 1234000 bytes to be displayed as @samp{1,234}. In the default C
839 locale, there is no thousands separator so a leading @samp{'} has no
842 An integer block size can be followed by a suffix to specify a
843 multiple of that size. A bare size letter,
844 or one followed by @samp{iB}, specifies
845 a multiple using powers of 1024. A size letter followed by @samp{B}
846 specifies powers of 1000 instead. For example, @samp{1M} and
847 @samp{1MiB} are equivalent to @samp{1048576}, whereas @samp{1MB} is
848 equivalent to @samp{1000000}.
850 A plain suffix without a preceding integer acts as if @samp{1} were
851 prepended, except that it causes a size indication to be appended to
852 the output. For example, @samp{--block-size="kB"} displays 3000 as
855 The following suffixes are defined. Large sizes like @code{1Y}
856 may be rejected by your computer due to limitations of its arithmetic.
860 @cindex kilobyte, definition of
861 kilobyte: @math{10^3 = 1000}.
865 @cindex kibibyte, definition of
866 kibibyte: @math{2^{10} = 1024}. @samp{K} is special: the SI prefix is
867 @samp{k} and the IEC 60027-2 prefix is @samp{Ki}, but tradition and
868 @acronym{POSIX} use @samp{k} to mean @samp{KiB}.
870 @cindex megabyte, definition of
871 megabyte: @math{10^6 = 1,000,000}.
874 @cindex mebibyte, definition of
875 mebibyte: @math{2^{20} = 1,048,576}.
877 @cindex gigabyte, definition of
878 gigabyte: @math{10^9 = 1,000,000,000}.
881 @cindex gibibyte, definition of
882 gibibyte: @math{2^{30} = 1,073,741,824}.
884 @cindex terabyte, definition of
885 terabyte: @math{10^{12} = 1,000,000,000,000}.
888 @cindex tebibyte, definition of
889 tebibyte: @math{2^{40} = 1,099,511,627,776}.
891 @cindex petabyte, definition of
892 petabyte: @math{10^{15} = 1,000,000,000,000,000}.
895 @cindex pebibyte, definition of
896 pebibyte: @math{2^{50} = 1,125,899,906,842,624}.
898 @cindex exabyte, definition of
899 exabyte: @math{10^{18} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
902 @cindex exbibyte, definition of
903 exbibyte: @math{2^{60} = 1,152,921,504,606,846,976}.
905 @cindex zettabyte, definition of
906 zettabyte: @math{10^{21} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}
909 @math{2^{70} = 1,180,591,620,717,411,303,424}.
910 (@samp{Zi} is a @acronym{GNU} extension to IEC 60027-2.)
912 @cindex yottabyte, definition of
913 yottabyte: @math{10^{24} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
916 @math{2^{80} = 1,208,925,819,614,629,174,706,176}.
917 (@samp{Yi} is a @acronym{GNU} extension to IEC 60027-2.)
922 @opindex --block-size
923 @opindex --human-readable
926 Block size defaults can be overridden by an explicit
927 @option{--block-size=@var{size}} option. The @option{-k}
928 option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}, which
929 is the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is
930 set. The @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable} option is equivalent to
931 @option{--block-size=human-readable}. The @option{--si} option is
932 equivalent to @option{--block-size=si}.
934 @node Disambiguating names and IDs
935 @section chown and chgrp: Disambiguating user names and IDs
936 @cindex user names, disambiguating
937 @cindex user IDs, disambiguating
938 @cindex group names, disambiguating
939 @cindex group IDs, disambiguating
940 @cindex disambiguating group names and IDs
942 Since the @var{owner} and @var{group} arguments to @command{chown} and
943 @command{chgrp} may be specified as names or numeric IDs, there is an
945 What if a user or group @emph{name} is a string of digits?
946 @footnote{Using a number as a user name is common in some environments.}
947 Should the command interpret it as a user name or as an ID?
948 @acronym{POSIX} requires that @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
949 first attempt to resolve the specified string as a name, and
950 only once that fails, then try to interpret it as an ID.
951 This is troublesome when you want to specify a numeric ID, say 42,
952 and it must work even in a pathological situation where
953 @samp{42} is a user name that maps to some other user ID, say 1000.
954 Simply invoking @code{chown 42 F}, will set @file{F}s owner ID to
955 1000---not what you intended.
957 GNU @command{chown} and @command{chgrp} provide a way to work around this,
958 that at the same time may result in a significant performance improvement
959 by eliminating a database look-up.
960 Simply precede each numeric user ID and/or group ID with a @samp{+},
961 in order to force its interpretation as an integer:
965 chgrp +$numeric_group_id another-file
969 GNU @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
970 skip the name look-up process for each @samp{+}-prefixed string,
971 because a string containing @samp{+} is never a valid user or group name.
972 This syntax is accepted on most common Unix systems, but not on Solaris 10.
975 @section Sources of random data
977 @cindex random sources
979 The @command{shuf}, @command{shred}, and @command{sort} commands
980 sometimes need random data to do their work. For example, @samp{sort
981 -R} must choose a hash function at random, and it needs random data to
984 Normally these commands use the device file @file{/dev/urandom} as the
985 source of random data. Typically, this device gathers environmental
986 noise from device drivers and other sources into an entropy pool, and
987 uses the pool to generate random bits. If the pool is short of data,
988 the device reuses the internal pool to produce more bits, using a
989 cryptographically secure pseudorandom number generator.
991 @file{/dev/urandom} suffices for most practical uses, but applications
992 requiring high-value or long-term protection of private data may
993 require an alternate data source like @file{/dev/random} or
994 @file{/dev/arandom}. The set of available sources depends on your
997 To use such a source, specify the @option{--random-source=@var{file}}
998 option, e.g., @samp{shuf --random-source=/dev/random}. The contents
999 of @var{file} should be as random as possible. An error is reported
1000 if @var{file} does not contain enough bytes to randomize the input
1003 To reproduce the results of an earlier invocation of a command, you
1004 can save some random data into a file and then use that file as the
1005 random source in earlier and later invocations of the command.
1007 Some old-fashioned or stripped-down operating systems lack support for
1008 @command{/dev/urandom}. On these systems commands like @command{shuf}
1009 by default fall back on an internal pseudorandom generator initialized
1010 by a small amount of entropy.
1012 @node Target directory
1013 @section Target directory
1015 @cindex target directory
1017 The @command{cp}, @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv}
1018 commands normally treat the last operand specially when it is a
1019 directory or a symbolic link to a directory. For example, @samp{cp
1020 source dest} is equivalent to @samp{cp source dest/source} if
1021 @file{dest} is a directory. Sometimes this behavior is not exactly
1022 what is wanted, so these commands support the following options to
1023 allow more fine-grained control:
1028 @itemx --no-target-directory
1029 @opindex --no-target-directory
1030 @cindex target directory
1031 @cindex destination directory
1032 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
1033 symbolic link to a directory. This can help avoid race conditions in
1034 programs that operate in a shared area. For example, when the command
1035 @samp{mv /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no guarantee that
1036 @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}: it could have been
1037 renamed to @file{/tmp/dest/source} instead, if some other process
1038 created @file{/tmp/dest} as a directory. However, if @file{mv
1039 -T /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no
1040 question that @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}.
1042 In the opposite situation, where you want the last operand to be
1043 treated as a directory and want a diagnostic otherwise, you can use
1044 the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option.
1046 @item -t @var{directory}
1047 @itemx @w{@kbd{--target-directory}=@var{directory}}
1048 @opindex --target-directory
1049 @cindex target directory
1050 @cindex destination directory
1051 Use @var{directory} as the directory component of each destination
1054 The interface for most programs is that after processing options and a
1055 finite (possibly zero) number of fixed-position arguments, the remaining
1056 argument list is either expected to be empty, or is a list of items
1057 (usually files) that will all be handled identically. The @command{xargs}
1058 program is designed to work well with this convention.
1060 The commands in the @command{mv}-family are unusual in that they take
1061 a variable number of arguments with a special case at the @emph{end}
1062 (namely, the target directory). This makes it nontrivial to perform some
1063 operations, e.g., ``move all files from here to ../d/'', because
1064 @code{mv * ../d/} might exhaust the argument space, and @code{ls | xargs ...}
1065 doesn't have a clean way to specify an extra final argument for each
1066 invocation of the subject command. (It can be done by going through a
1067 shell command, but that requires more human labor and brain power than
1070 The @w{@kbd{--target-directory}} (@option{-t}) option allows the @command{cp},
1071 @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv} programs to be used
1072 conveniently with @command{xargs}. For example, you can move the files
1073 from the current directory to a sibling directory, @code{d} like this:
1076 ls | xargs mv -t ../d --
1079 However, this doesn't move files whose names begin with @samp{.}.
1080 If you use the @sc{gnu} @command{find} program, you can move those
1081 files too, with this command:
1084 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 \
1088 But both of the above approaches fail if there are no files in the
1089 current directory, or if any file has a name containing a blank or
1090 some other special characters.
1091 The following example removes those limitations and requires both
1092 @sc{gnu} @command{find} and @sc{gnu} @command{xargs}:
1095 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 -print0 \
1096 | xargs --null --no-run-if-empty \
1103 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) and
1104 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T})
1105 options cannot be combined.
1107 @node Trailing slashes
1108 @section Trailing slashes
1110 @cindex trailing slashes
1112 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{cp} and @command{mv}) allow you to
1113 remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument before
1114 operating on it. The @w{@kbd{--strip-trailing-slashes}} option enables
1117 This is useful when a @var{source} argument may have a trailing slash and
1118 @c FIXME: mv's behavior in this case is system-dependent
1119 specify a symbolic link to a directory. This scenario is in fact rather
1120 common because some shells can automatically append a trailing slash when
1121 performing file name completion on such symbolic links. Without this
1122 option, @command{mv}, for example, (via the system's rename function) must
1123 interpret a trailing slash as a request to dereference the symbolic link
1124 and so must rename the indirectly referenced @emph{directory} and not
1125 the symbolic link. Although it may seem surprising that such behavior
1126 be the default, it is required by @acronym{POSIX} and is consistent with
1127 other parts of that standard.
1129 @node Traversing symlinks
1130 @section Traversing symlinks
1132 @cindex symbolic link to directory, controlling traversal of
1134 The following options modify how @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1135 @c FIXME: note that `du' has these options, too, but they have slightly
1136 @c different meaning.
1137 traverse a hierarchy when the @option{--recursive} (@option{-R})
1138 option is also specified.
1139 If more than one of the following options is specified, only the final
1141 These options specify whether processing a symbolic link to a directory
1142 entails operating on just the symbolic link or on all files in the
1143 hierarchy rooted at that directory.
1145 These options are independent of @option{--dereference} and
1146 @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-h}), which control whether to modify
1147 a symlink or its referent.
1154 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is specified on the command line
1155 If @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}) is specified and
1156 a command line argument is a symbolic link to a directory, traverse it.
1163 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is encountered
1164 In a recursive traversal, traverse every symbolic link to a directory
1165 that is encountered.
1172 @cindex symbolic link to directory, never traverse
1173 Do not traverse any symbolic links.
1174 This is the default if none of @option{-H}, @option{-L},
1175 or @option{-P} is specified.
1182 @node Treating / specially
1183 @section Treating @file{/} specially
1185 Certain commands can operate destructively on entire hierarchies.
1186 For example, if a user with appropriate privileges mistakenly runs
1187 @samp{rm -rf / tmp/junk}, that may remove
1188 all files on the entire system. Since there are so few
1189 legitimate uses for such a command,
1190 @sc{gnu} @command{rm} normally declines to operate on any directory
1191 that resolves to @file{/}. If you really want to try to remove all
1192 the files on your system, you can use the @option{--no-preserve-root}
1193 option, but the default behavior, specified by the
1194 @option{--preserve-option}, is safer for most purposes.
1196 The commands @command{chgrp}, @command{chmod} and @command{chown}
1197 can also operate destructively on entire hierarchies, so they too
1198 support these options. Although, unlike @command{rm}, they don't
1199 actually unlink files, these commands are arguably more dangerous
1200 when operating recursively on @file{/}, since they often work much
1201 more quickly, and hence damage more files before an alert user can
1202 interrupt them. Tradition and @acronym{POSIX} require these commands
1203 to operate recursively on @file{/}, so they default to
1204 @option{--no-preserve-root}, but using the @option{--preserve-root}
1205 option makes them safer for most purposes. For convenience you can
1206 specify @option{--preserve-root} in an alias or in a shell function.
1208 Note that the @option{--preserve-root} option also ensures
1209 that @command{chgrp} and @command{chown} do not modify @file{/}
1210 even when dereferencing a symlink pointing to @file{/}.
1212 @node Special built-in utilities
1213 @section Special built-in utilities
1215 Some programs like @command{nice} can invoke other programs; for
1216 example, the command @samp{nice cat file} invokes the program
1217 @command{cat} by executing the command @samp{cat file}. However,
1218 @dfn{special built-in utilities} like @command{exit} cannot be invoked
1219 this way. For example, the command @samp{nice exit} does not have a
1220 well-defined behavior: it may generate an error message instead of
1223 Here is a list of the special built-in utilities that are standardized
1224 by @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2004.
1227 @t{.@: : break continue eval exec exit export readonly
1228 return set shift times trap unset}
1231 For example, because @samp{.}, @samp{:}, and @samp{exec} are special,
1232 the commands @samp{nice . foo.sh}, @samp{nice :}, and @samp{nice exec
1233 pwd} do not work as you might expect.
1235 Many shells extend this list. For example, Bash has several extra
1236 special built-in utilities like @command{history}, and
1237 @command{suspend}, and with Bash the command @samp{nice suspend}
1238 generates an error message instead of suspending.
1240 @node Standards conformance
1241 @section Standards conformance
1243 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
1244 In a few cases, the @sc{gnu} utilities' default behavior is
1245 incompatible with the @acronym{POSIX} standard. To suppress these
1246 incompatibilities, define the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment
1247 variable. Unless you are checking for @acronym{POSIX} conformance, you
1248 probably do not need to define @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}.
1250 Newer versions of @acronym{POSIX} are occasionally incompatible with older
1251 versions. For example, older versions of @acronym{POSIX} required the
1252 command @samp{sort +1} to sort based on the second and succeeding
1253 fields in each input line, but starting with @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001
1254 the same command is required to sort the file named @file{+1}, and you
1255 must instead use the command @samp{sort -k 2} to get the field-based
1258 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
1259 The @sc{gnu} utilities normally conform to the version of @acronym{POSIX}
1260 that is standard for your system. To cause them to conform to a
1261 different version of @acronym{POSIX}, define the @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}
1262 environment variable to a value of the form @var{yyyymm} specifying
1263 the year and month the standard was adopted. Two values are currently
1264 supported for @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}: @samp{199209} stands for
1265 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.2-1992, and @samp{200112} stands for @acronym{POSIX}
1266 1003.1-2001. For example, if you have a newer system but are running software
1267 that assumes an older version of @acronym{POSIX} and uses @samp{sort +1}
1268 or @samp{tail +10}, you can work around any compatibility problems by setting
1269 @samp{_POSIX2_VERSION=199209} in your environment.
1271 @node Output of entire files
1272 @chapter Output of entire files
1274 @cindex output of entire files
1275 @cindex entire files, output of
1277 These commands read and write entire files, possibly transforming them
1281 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
1282 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
1283 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
1284 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
1285 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1288 @node cat invocation
1289 @section @command{cat}: Concatenate and write files
1292 @cindex concatenate and write files
1293 @cindex copying files
1295 @command{cat} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1296 standard input if none are given, to standard output. Synopsis:
1299 cat [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
1302 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1310 Equivalent to @option{-vET}.
1313 @itemx --number-nonblank
1315 @opindex --number-nonblank
1316 Number all nonempty output lines, starting with 1.
1320 Equivalent to @option{-vE}.
1325 @opindex --show-ends
1326 Display a @samp{$} after the end of each line.
1332 Number all output lines, starting with 1.
1335 @itemx --squeeze-blank
1337 @opindex --squeeze-blank
1338 @cindex squeezing empty lines
1339 Suppress repeated adjacent empty lines; output just one empty line
1344 Equivalent to @option{-vT}.
1349 @opindex --show-tabs
1350 Display TAB characters as @samp{^I}.
1354 Ignored; for @acronym{POSIX} compatibility.
1357 @itemx --show-nonprinting
1359 @opindex --show-nonprinting
1360 Display control characters except for LFD and TAB using
1361 @samp{^} notation and precede characters that have the high bit set with
1366 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1367 @command{cat} normally reads and writes in binary mode. However,
1368 @command{cat} reads in text mode if one of the options
1369 @option{-bensAE} is used or if @command{cat} is reading from standard
1370 input and standard input is a terminal. Similarly, @command{cat}
1371 writes in text mode if one of the options @option{-bensAE} is used or
1372 if standard output is a terminal.
1379 # Output f's contents, then standard input, then g's contents.
1382 # Copy standard input to standard output.
1387 @node tac invocation
1388 @section @command{tac}: Concatenate and write files in reverse
1391 @cindex reversing files
1393 @command{tac} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1394 standard input if none are given, to standard output, reversing the
1395 records (lines by default) in each separately. Synopsis:
1398 tac [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1401 @dfn{Records} are separated by instances of a string (newline by
1402 default). By default, this separator string is attached to the end of
1403 the record that it follows in the file.
1405 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1413 The separator is attached to the beginning of the record that it
1414 precedes in the file.
1420 Treat the separator string as a regular expression. Users of @command{tac}
1421 on MS-DOS/MS-Windows should note that, since @command{tac} reads files in
1422 binary mode, each line of a text file might end with a CR/LF pair
1423 instead of the Unix-style LF.
1425 @item -s @var{separator}
1426 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
1428 @opindex --separator
1429 Use @var{separator} as the record separator, instead of newline.
1437 @section @command{nl}: Number lines and write files
1440 @cindex numbering lines
1441 @cindex line numbering
1443 @command{nl} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1444 standard input if none are given, to standard output, with line numbers
1445 added to some or all of the lines. Synopsis:
1448 nl [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1451 @cindex logical pages, numbering on
1452 @command{nl} decomposes its input into (logical) pages; by default, the
1453 line number is reset to 1 at the top of each logical page. @command{nl}
1454 treats all of the input files as a single document; it does not reset
1455 line numbers or logical pages between files.
1457 @cindex headers, numbering
1458 @cindex body, numbering
1459 @cindex footers, numbering
1460 A logical page consists of three sections: header, body, and footer.
1461 Any of the sections can be empty. Each can be numbered in a different
1462 style from the others.
1464 The beginnings of the sections of logical pages are indicated in the
1465 input file by a line containing exactly one of these delimiter strings:
1476 The two characters from which these strings are made can be changed from
1477 @samp{\} and @samp{:} via options (see below), but the pattern and
1478 length of each string cannot be changed.
1480 A section delimiter is replaced by an empty line on output. Any text
1481 that comes before the first section delimiter string in the input file
1482 is considered to be part of a body section, so @command{nl} treats a
1483 file that contains no section delimiters as a single body section.
1485 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1489 @item -b @var{style}
1490 @itemx --body-numbering=@var{style}
1492 @opindex --body-numbering
1493 Select the numbering style for lines in the body section of each
1494 logical page. When a line is not numbered, the current line number
1495 is not incremented, but the line number separator character is still
1496 prepended to the line. The styles are:
1502 number only nonempty lines (default for body),
1504 do not number lines (default for header and footer),
1506 number only lines that contain a match for the basic regular
1507 expression @var{bre}.
1508 @xref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}.
1512 @itemx --section-delimiter=@var{cd}
1514 @opindex --section-delimiter
1515 @cindex section delimiters of pages
1516 Set the section delimiter characters to @var{cd}; default is
1517 @samp{\:}. If only @var{c} is given, the second remains @samp{:}.
1518 (Remember to protect @samp{\} or other metacharacters from shell
1519 expansion with quotes or extra backslashes.)
1521 @item -f @var{style}
1522 @itemx --footer-numbering=@var{style}
1524 @opindex --footer-numbering
1525 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1527 @item -h @var{style}
1528 @itemx --header-numbering=@var{style}
1530 @opindex --header-numbering
1531 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1533 @item -i @var{number}
1534 @itemx --page-increment=@var{number}
1536 @opindex --page-increment
1537 Increment line numbers by @var{number} (default 1).
1539 @item -l @var{number}
1540 @itemx --join-blank-lines=@var{number}
1542 @opindex --join-blank-lines
1543 @cindex empty lines, numbering
1544 @cindex blank lines, numbering
1545 Consider @var{number} (default 1) consecutive empty lines to be one
1546 logical line for numbering, and only number the last one. Where fewer
1547 than @var{number} consecutive empty lines occur, do not number them.
1548 An empty line is one that contains no characters, not even spaces
1551 @item -n @var{format}
1552 @itemx --number-format=@var{format}
1554 @opindex --number-format
1555 Select the line numbering format (default is @code{rn}):
1559 @opindex ln @r{format for @command{nl}}
1560 left justified, no leading zeros;
1562 @opindex rn @r{format for @command{nl}}
1563 right justified, no leading zeros;
1565 @opindex rz @r{format for @command{nl}}
1566 right justified, leading zeros.
1570 @itemx --no-renumber
1572 @opindex --no-renumber
1573 Do not reset the line number at the start of a logical page.
1575 @item -s @var{string}
1576 @itemx --number-separator=@var{string}
1578 @opindex --number-separator
1579 Separate the line number from the text line in the output with
1580 @var{string} (default is the TAB character).
1582 @item -v @var{number}
1583 @itemx --starting-line-number=@var{number}
1585 @opindex --starting-line-number
1586 Set the initial line number on each logical page to @var{number} (default 1).
1588 @item -w @var{number}
1589 @itemx --number-width=@var{number}
1591 @opindex --number-width
1592 Use @var{number} characters for line numbers (default 6).
1600 @section @command{od}: Write files in octal or other formats
1603 @cindex octal dump of files
1604 @cindex hex dump of files
1605 @cindex ASCII dump of files
1606 @cindex file contents, dumping unambiguously
1608 @command{od} writes an unambiguous representation of each @var{file}
1609 (@samp{-} means standard input), or standard input if none are given.
1613 od [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1614 od [-abcdfilosx]@dots{} [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b]]
1615 od [@var{option}]@dots{} --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1618 Each line of output consists of the offset in the input, followed by
1619 groups of data from the file. By default, @command{od} prints the offset in
1620 octal, and each group of file data is a C @code{short int}'s worth of input
1621 printed as a single octal number.
1623 If @var{offset} is given, it specifies how many input bytes to skip
1624 before formatting and writing. By default, it is interpreted as an
1625 octal number, but the optional trailing decimal point causes it to be
1626 interpreted as decimal. If no decimal is specified and the offset
1627 begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} it is interpreted as a hexadecimal
1628 number. If there is a trailing @samp{b}, the number of bytes skipped
1629 will be @var{offset} multiplied by 512.
1631 If a command is of both the first and second forms, the second form is
1632 assumed if the last operand begins with @samp{+} or (if there are two
1633 operands) a digit. For example, in @samp{od foo 10} and @samp{od +10}
1634 the @samp{10} is an offset, whereas in @samp{od 10} the @samp{10} is a
1637 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1641 @item -A @var{radix}
1642 @itemx --address-radix=@var{radix}
1644 @opindex --address-radix
1645 @cindex radix for file offsets
1646 @cindex file offset radix
1647 Select the base in which file offsets are printed. @var{radix} can
1648 be one of the following:
1658 none (do not print offsets).
1661 The default is octal.
1663 @item -j @var{bytes}
1664 @itemx --skip-bytes=@var{bytes}
1666 @opindex --skip-bytes
1667 Skip @var{bytes} input bytes before formatting and writing. If
1668 @var{bytes} begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, it is interpreted in
1669 hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0}, in octal; otherwise,
1670 in decimal. Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{bytes} by 512,
1671 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
1672 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
1673 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{G} by 1024*1024*1024,
1674 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
1676 @item -N @var{bytes}
1677 @itemx --read-bytes=@var{bytes}
1679 @opindex --read-bytes
1680 Output at most @var{bytes} bytes of the input. Prefixes and suffixes on
1681 @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the @option{-j} option.
1683 @item -S @var{bytes}
1684 @itemx --strings[=@var{bytes}]
1687 @cindex string constants, outputting
1688 Instead of the normal output, output only @dfn{string constants}: at
1689 least @var{bytes} consecutive @acronym{ASCII} graphic characters,
1690 followed by a null (zero) byte.
1691 Prefixes and suffixes on @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the
1694 If @var{n} is omitted with @option{--strings}, the default is 3.
1697 @itemx --format=@var{type}
1700 Select the format in which to output the file data. @var{type} is a
1701 string of one or more of the below type indicator characters. If you
1702 include more than one type indicator character in a single @var{type}
1703 string, or use this option more than once, @command{od} writes one copy
1704 of each output line using each of the data types that you specified,
1705 in the order that you specified.
1707 Adding a trailing ``z'' to any type specification appends a display
1708 of the @acronym{ASCII} character representation of the printable characters
1709 to the output line generated by the type specification.
1713 named character, ignoring high-order bit
1715 @acronym{ASCII} character or backslash escape,
1728 The type @code{a} outputs things like @samp{sp} for space, @samp{nl} for
1729 newline, and @samp{nul} for a null (zero) byte. Only the least significant
1730 seven bits of each byte is used; the high-order bit is ignored.
1731 Type @code{c} outputs
1732 @samp{ }, @samp{\n}, and @code{\0}, respectively.
1735 Except for types @samp{a} and @samp{c}, you can specify the number
1736 of bytes to use in interpreting each number in the given data type
1737 by following the type indicator character with a decimal integer.
1738 Alternately, you can specify the size of one of the C compiler's
1739 built-in data types by following the type indicator character with
1740 one of the following characters. For integers (@samp{d}, @samp{o},
1741 @samp{u}, @samp{x}):
1754 For floating point (@code{f}):
1766 @itemx --output-duplicates
1768 @opindex --output-duplicates
1769 Output consecutive lines that are identical. By default, when two or
1770 more consecutive output lines would be identical, @command{od} outputs only
1771 the first line, and puts just an asterisk on the following line to
1772 indicate the elision.
1775 @itemx --width[=@var{n}]
1778 Dump @code{n} input bytes per output line. This must be a multiple of
1779 the least common multiple of the sizes associated with the specified
1782 If this option is not given at all, the default is 16. If @var{n} is
1783 omitted, the default is 32.
1787 The next several options are shorthands for format specifications.
1788 @sc{gnu} @command{od} accepts any combination of shorthands and format
1789 specification options. These options accumulate.
1795 Output as named characters. Equivalent to @samp{-t a}.
1799 Output as octal bytes. Equivalent to @samp{-t o1}.
1803 Output as @acronym{ASCII} characters or backslash escapes. Equivalent to
1808 Output as unsigned decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t u2}.
1812 Output as floats. Equivalent to @samp{-t fF}.
1816 Output as decimal ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dI}.
1820 Output as decimal long ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dL}.
1824 Output as octal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t o2}.
1828 Output as decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t d2}.
1832 Output as hexadecimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t x2}.
1835 @opindex --traditional
1836 Recognize the non-option label argument that traditional @command{od}
1837 accepted. The following syntax:
1840 od --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1844 can be used to specify at most one file and optional arguments
1845 specifying an offset and a pseudo-start address, @var{label}.
1846 The @var{label} argument is interpreted
1847 just like @var{offset}, but it specifies an initial pseudo-address. The
1848 pseudo-addresses are displayed in parentheses following any normal
1855 @node base64 invocation
1856 @section @command{base64}: Transform data into printable data.
1859 @cindex base64 encoding
1861 @command{base64} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
1862 into (or from) base64 encoded form. The base64 encoded form uses
1863 printable @acronym{ASCII} characters to represent binary data.
1867 base64 [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
1868 base64 --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
1871 The base64 encoding expands data to roughly 133% of the original.
1872 The format conforms to
1873 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc4648.txt, RFC 4648}.
1875 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1880 @itemx --wrap=@var{COLS}
1884 @cindex column to wrap data after
1885 During encoding, wrap lines after @var{COLS} characters. This must be
1888 The default is to wrap after 76 characters. Use the value 0 to
1889 disable line wrapping altogether.
1895 @cindex Decode base64 data
1896 @cindex Base64 decoding
1897 Change the mode of operation, from the default of encoding data, to
1898 decoding data. Input is expected to be base64 encoded data, and the
1899 output will be the original data.
1902 @itemx --ignore-garbage
1904 @opindex --ignore-garbage
1905 @cindex Ignore garbage in base64 stream
1906 When decoding, newlines are always accepted.
1907 During decoding, ignore unrecognized bytes,
1908 to permit distorted data to be decoded.
1915 @node Formatting file contents
1916 @chapter Formatting file contents
1918 @cindex formatting file contents
1920 These commands reformat the contents of files.
1923 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
1924 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
1925 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
1929 @node fmt invocation
1930 @section @command{fmt}: Reformat paragraph text
1933 @cindex reformatting paragraph text
1934 @cindex paragraphs, reformatting
1935 @cindex text, reformatting
1937 @command{fmt} fills and joins lines to produce output lines of (at most)
1938 a given number of characters (75 by default). Synopsis:
1941 fmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1944 @command{fmt} reads from the specified @var{file} arguments (or standard
1945 input if none are given), and writes to standard output.
1947 By default, blank lines, spaces between words, and indentation are
1948 preserved in the output; successive input lines with different
1949 indentation are not joined; tabs are expanded on input and introduced on
1952 @cindex line-breaking
1953 @cindex sentences and line-breaking
1954 @cindex Knuth, Donald E.
1955 @cindex Plass, Michael F.
1956 @command{fmt} prefers breaking lines at the end of a sentence, and tries to
1957 avoid line breaks after the first word of a sentence or before the last
1958 word of a sentence. A @dfn{sentence break} is defined as either the end
1959 of a paragraph or a word ending in any of @samp{.?!}, followed by two
1960 spaces or end of line, ignoring any intervening parentheses or quotes.
1961 Like @TeX{}, @command{fmt} reads entire ``paragraphs'' before choosing line
1962 breaks; the algorithm is a variant of that given by Donald E. Knuth
1963 and Michael F. Plass in ``Breaking Paragraphs Into Lines'',
1964 @cite{Software---Practice & Experience} @b{11}, 11 (November 1981),
1967 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1972 @itemx --crown-margin
1974 @opindex --crown-margin
1975 @cindex crown margin
1976 @dfn{Crown margin} mode: preserve the indentation of the first two
1977 lines within a paragraph, and align the left margin of each subsequent
1978 line with that of the second line.
1981 @itemx --tagged-paragraph
1983 @opindex --tagged-paragraph
1984 @cindex tagged paragraphs
1985 @dfn{Tagged paragraph} mode: like crown margin mode, except that if
1986 indentation of the first line of a paragraph is the same as the
1987 indentation of the second, the first line is treated as a one-line
1993 @opindex --split-only
1994 Split lines only. Do not join short lines to form longer ones. This
1995 prevents sample lines of code, and other such ``formatted'' text from
1996 being unduly combined.
1999 @itemx --uniform-spacing
2001 @opindex --uniform-spacing
2002 Uniform spacing. Reduce spacing between words to one space, and spacing
2003 between sentences to two spaces.
2006 @itemx -w @var{width}
2007 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2008 @opindex -@var{width}
2011 Fill output lines up to @var{width} characters (default 75). @command{fmt}
2012 initially tries to make lines about 7% shorter than this, to give it
2013 room to balance line lengths.
2015 @item -p @var{prefix}
2016 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2017 Only lines beginning with @var{prefix} (possibly preceded by whitespace)
2018 are subject to formatting. The prefix and any preceding whitespace are
2019 stripped for the formatting and then re-attached to each formatted output
2020 line. One use is to format certain kinds of program comments, while
2021 leaving the code unchanged.
2029 @section @command{pr}: Paginate or columnate files for printing
2032 @cindex printing, preparing files for
2033 @cindex multicolumn output, generating
2034 @cindex merging files in parallel
2036 @command{pr} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
2037 standard input if none are given, to standard output, paginating and
2038 optionally outputting in multicolumn format; optionally merges all
2039 @var{file}s, printing all in parallel, one per column. Synopsis:
2042 pr [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2046 By default, a 5-line header is printed at each page: two blank lines;
2047 a line with the date, the file name, and the page count; and two more
2048 blank lines. A footer of five blank lines is also printed.
2049 The default @var{page_length} is 66
2050 lines. The default number of text lines is therefore 56.
2051 The text line of the header takes the form
2052 @samp{@var{date} @var{string} @var{page}}, with spaces inserted around
2053 @var{string} so that the line takes up the full @var{page_width}. Here,
2054 @var{date} is the date (see the @option{-D} or @option{--date-format}
2055 option for details), @var{string} is the centered header string, and
2056 @var{page} identifies the page number. The @env{LC_MESSAGES} locale
2057 category affects the spelling of @var{page}; in the default C locale, it
2058 is @samp{Page @var{number}} where @var{number} is the decimal page
2061 Form feeds in the input cause page breaks in the output. Multiple form
2062 feeds produce empty pages.
2064 Columns are of equal width, separated by an optional string (default
2065 is @samp{space}). For multicolumn output, lines will always be truncated to
2066 @var{page_width} (default 72), unless you use the @option{-J} option.
2068 column output no line truncation occurs by default. Use @option{-W} option to
2069 truncate lines in that case.
2071 The following changes were made in version 1.22i and apply to later
2072 versions of @command{pr}:
2073 @c FIXME: this whole section here sounds very awkward to me. I
2074 @c made a few small changes, but really it all needs to be redone. - Brian
2075 @c OK, I fixed another sentence or two, but some of it I just don't understand.
2080 Some small @var{letter options} (@option{-s}, @option{-w}) have been
2081 redefined for better @acronym{POSIX} compliance. The output of some further
2082 cases has been adapted to other Unix systems. These changes are not
2083 compatible with earlier versions of the program.
2086 Some @var{new capital letter} options (@option{-J}, @option{-S}, @option{-W})
2087 have been introduced to turn off unexpected interferences of small letter
2088 options. The @option{-N} option and the second argument @var{last_page}
2089 of @samp{+FIRST_PAGE} offer more flexibility. The detailed handling of
2090 form feeds set in the input files requires the @option{-T} option.
2093 Capital letter options override small letter ones.
2096 Some of the option-arguments (compare @option{-s}, @option{-e},
2097 @option{-i}, @option{-n}) cannot be specified as separate arguments from the
2098 preceding option letter (already stated in the @acronym{POSIX} specification).
2101 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2105 @item +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2106 @itemx --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2107 @c The two following @opindex lines evoke warnings because they contain `:'
2108 @c The `info' spec does not permit that. If we use those lines, we end
2109 @c up with truncated index entries that don't work.
2110 @c @opindex +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2111 @c @opindex --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2112 @opindex +@var{page_range}
2113 @opindex --pages=@var{page_range}
2114 Begin printing with page @var{first_page} and stop with @var{last_page}.
2115 Missing @samp{:@var{last_page}} implies end of file. While estimating
2116 the number of skipped pages each form feed in the input file results
2117 in a new page. Page counting with and without @samp{+@var{first_page}}
2118 is identical. By default, counting starts with the first page of input
2119 file (not first page printed). Line numbering may be altered by @option{-N}
2123 @itemx --columns=@var{column}
2124 @opindex -@var{column}
2126 @cindex down columns
2127 With each single @var{file}, produce @var{column} columns of output
2128 (default is 1) and print columns down, unless @option{-a} is used. The
2129 column width is automatically decreased as @var{column} increases; unless
2130 you use the @option{-W/-w} option to increase @var{page_width} as well.
2131 This option might well cause some lines to be truncated. The number of
2132 lines in the columns on each page are balanced. The options @option{-e}
2133 and @option{-i} are on for multiple text-column output. Together with
2134 @option{-J} option column alignment and line truncation is turned off.
2135 Lines of full length are joined in a free field format and @option{-S}
2136 option may set field separators. @option{-@var{column}} may not be used
2137 with @option{-m} option.
2143 @cindex across columns
2144 With each single @var{file}, print columns across rather than down. The
2145 @option{-@var{column}} option must be given with @var{column} greater than one.
2146 If a line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated.
2149 @itemx --show-control-chars
2151 @opindex --show-control-chars
2152 Print control characters using hat notation (e.g., @samp{^G}); print
2153 other nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation. By default,
2154 nonprinting characters are not changed.
2157 @itemx --double-space
2159 @opindex --double-space
2160 @cindex double spacing
2161 Double space the output.
2163 @item -D @var{format}
2164 @itemx --date-format=@var{format}
2165 @cindex time formats
2166 @cindex formatting times
2167 Format header dates using @var{format}, using the same conventions as
2168 for the command @samp{date +@var{format}}; @xref{date invocation}.
2169 Except for directives, which start with
2170 @samp{%}, characters in @var{format} are printed unchanged. You can use
2171 this option to specify an arbitrary string in place of the header date,
2172 e.g., @option{--date-format="Monday morning"}.
2174 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2176 The default date format is @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M} (for example,
2177 @samp{2001-12-04 23:59});
2178 but if the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set
2179 and the @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the @acronym{POSIX}
2180 locale, the default is @samp{%b %e %H:%M %Y} (for example,
2181 @samp{Dec@ @ 4 23:59 2001}.
2184 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
2185 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
2186 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
2187 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
2189 @item -e[@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2190 @itemx --expand-tabs[=@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2192 @opindex --expand-tabs
2194 Expand @var{tab}s to spaces on input. Optional argument @var{in-tabchar} is
2195 the input tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2196 argument @var{in-tabwidth} is the input tab character's width (default
2204 @opindex --form-feed
2205 Use a form feed instead of newlines to separate output pages. This does
2206 not alter the default page length of 66 lines.
2208 @item -h @var{HEADER}
2209 @itemx --header=@var{HEADER}
2212 Replace the file name in the header with the centered string @var{header}.
2213 When using the shell, @var{header} should be quoted and should be
2214 separated from @option{-h} by a space.
2216 @item -i[@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2217 @itemx --output-tabs[=@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2219 @opindex --output-tabs
2221 Replace spaces with @var{tab}s on output. Optional argument @var{out-tabchar}
2222 is the output tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2223 argument @var{out-tabwidth} is the output tab character's width (default
2229 @opindex --join-lines
2230 Merge lines of full length. Used together with the column options
2231 @option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}. Turns off
2232 @option{-W/-w} line truncation;
2233 no column alignment used; may be used with
2234 @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]}. @option{-J} has been introduced
2235 (together with @option{-W} and @option{--sep-string})
2236 to disentangle the old (@acronym{POSIX}-compliant) options @option{-w} and
2237 @option{-s} along with the three column options.
2240 @item -l @var{page_length}
2241 @itemx --length=@var{page_length}
2244 Set the page length to @var{page_length} (default 66) lines, including
2245 the lines of the header [and the footer]. If @var{page_length} is less
2246 than or equal to 10, the header and footer are omitted, as if the
2247 @option{-t} option had been given.
2253 Merge and print all @var{file}s in parallel, one in each column. If a
2254 line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated, unless the @option{-J}
2255 option is used. @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]} may be used.
2257 some @var{file}s (form feeds set) produce empty columns, still marked
2258 by @var{string}. The result is a continuous line numbering and column
2259 marking throughout the whole merged file. Completely empty merged pages
2260 show no separators or line numbers. The default header becomes
2261 @samp{@var{date} @var{page}} with spaces inserted in the middle; this
2262 may be used with the @option{-h} or @option{--header} option to fill up
2263 the middle blank part.
2265 @item -n[@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2266 @itemx --number-lines[=@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2268 @opindex --number-lines
2269 Provide @var{digits} digit line numbering (default for @var{digits} is
2270 5). With multicolumn output the number occupies the first @var{digits}
2271 column positions of each text column or only each line of @option{-m}
2272 output. With single column output the number precedes each line just as
2273 @option{-m} does. Default counting of the line numbers starts with the
2274 first line of the input file (not the first line printed, compare the
2275 @option{--page} option and @option{-N} option).
2276 Optional argument @var{number-separator} is the character appended to
2277 the line number to separate it from the text followed. The default
2278 separator is the TAB character. In a strict sense a TAB is always
2279 printed with single column output only. The @var{TAB}-width varies
2280 with the @var{TAB}-position, e.g., with the left @var{margin} specified
2281 by @option{-o} option. With multicolumn output priority is given to
2282 @samp{equal width of output columns} (a @acronym{POSIX} specification).
2283 The @var{TAB}-width is fixed to the value of the first column and does
2284 not change with different values of left @var{margin}. That means a
2285 fixed number of spaces is always printed in the place of the
2286 @var{number-separator tab}. The tabification depends upon the output
2289 @item -N @var{line_number}
2290 @itemx --first-line-number=@var{line_number}
2292 @opindex --first-line-number
2293 Start line counting with the number @var{line_number} at first line of
2294 first page printed (in most cases not the first line of the input file).
2296 @item -o @var{margin}
2297 @itemx --indent=@var{margin}
2300 @cindex indenting lines
2302 Indent each line with a margin @var{margin} spaces wide (default is zero).
2303 The total page width is the size of the margin plus the @var{page_width}
2304 set with the @option{-W/-w} option. A limited overflow may occur with
2305 numbered single column output (compare @option{-n} option).
2308 @itemx --no-file-warnings
2310 @opindex --no-file-warnings
2311 Do not print a warning message when an argument @var{file} cannot be
2312 opened. (The exit status will still be nonzero, however.)
2314 @item -s[@var{char}]
2315 @itemx --separator[=@var{char}]
2317 @opindex --separator
2318 Separate columns by a single character @var{char}. The default for
2319 @var{char} is the TAB character without @option{-w} and @samp{no
2320 character} with @option{-w}. Without @option{-s} the default separator
2321 @samp{space} is set. @option{-s[char]} turns off line truncation of all
2322 three column options (@option{-COLUMN}|@option{-a -COLUMN}|@option{-m}) unless
2323 @option{-w} is set. This is a @acronym{POSIX}-compliant formulation.
2326 @item -S@var{string}
2327 @itemx --sep-string[=@var{string}]
2329 @opindex --sep-string
2330 Use @var{string} to separate output columns. The @option{-S} option doesn't
2331 affect the @option{-W/-w} option, unlike the @option{-s} option which does. It
2332 does not affect line truncation or column alignment.
2333 Without @option{-S}, and with @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses the default output
2335 Without @option{-S} or @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses a @samp{space}
2336 (same as @option{-S"@w{ }"}). @option{--sep-string} with no
2337 @samp{=@var{string}} is equivalent to @option{--sep-string=""}.
2340 @itemx --omit-header
2342 @opindex --omit-header
2343 Do not print the usual header [and footer] on each page, and do not fill
2344 out the bottom of pages (with blank lines or a form feed). No page
2345 structure is produced, but form feeds set in the input files are retained.
2346 The predefined pagination is not changed. @option{-t} or @option{-T} may be
2347 useful together with other options; e.g.: @option{-t -e4}, expand TAB characters
2348 in the input file to 4 spaces but don't make any other changes. Use of
2349 @option{-t} overrides @option{-h}.
2352 @itemx --omit-pagination
2354 @opindex --omit-pagination
2355 Do not print header [and footer]. In addition eliminate all form feeds
2356 set in the input files.
2359 @itemx --show-nonprinting
2361 @opindex --show-nonprinting
2362 Print nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation.
2364 @item -w @var{page_width}
2365 @itemx --width=@var{page_width}
2368 Set page width to @var{page_width} characters for multiple text-column
2369 output only (default for @var{page_width} is 72). @option{-s[CHAR]} turns
2370 off the default page width and any line truncation and column alignment.
2371 Lines of full length are merged, regardless of the column options
2372 set. No @var{page_width} setting is possible with single column output.
2373 A @acronym{POSIX}-compliant formulation.
2375 @item -W @var{page_width}
2376 @itemx --page_width=@var{page_width}
2378 @opindex --page_width
2379 Set the page width to @var{page_width} characters. That's valid with and
2380 without a column option. Text lines are truncated, unless @option{-J}
2381 is used. Together with one of the three column options
2382 (@option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}) column
2383 alignment is always used. The separator options @option{-S} or @option{-s}
2384 don't affect the @option{-W} option. Default is 72 characters. Without
2385 @option{-W @var{page_width}} and without any of the column options NO line
2386 truncation is used (defined to keep downward compatibility and to meet
2387 most frequent tasks). That's equivalent to @option{-W 72 -J}. The header
2388 line is never truncated.
2395 @node fold invocation
2396 @section @command{fold}: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
2399 @cindex wrapping long input lines
2400 @cindex folding long input lines
2402 @command{fold} writes each @var{file} (@option{-} means standard input), or
2403 standard input if none are given, to standard output, breaking long
2407 fold [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2410 By default, @command{fold} breaks lines wider than 80 columns. The output
2411 is split into as many lines as necessary.
2413 @cindex screen columns
2414 @command{fold} counts screen columns by default; thus, a tab may count more
2415 than one column, backspace decreases the column count, and carriage
2416 return sets the column to zero.
2418 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2426 Count bytes rather than columns, so that tabs, backspaces, and carriage
2427 returns are each counted as taking up one column, just like other
2434 Break at word boundaries: the line is broken after the last blank before
2435 the maximum line length. If the line contains no such blanks, the line
2436 is broken at the maximum line length as usual.
2438 @item -w @var{width}
2439 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2442 Use a maximum line length of @var{width} columns instead of 80.
2444 For compatibility @command{fold} supports an obsolete option syntax
2445 @option{-@var{width}}. New scripts should use @option{-w @var{width}}
2453 @node Output of parts of files
2454 @chapter Output of parts of files
2456 @cindex output of parts of files
2457 @cindex parts of files, output of
2459 These commands output pieces of the input.
2462 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
2463 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
2464 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces.
2465 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
2468 @node head invocation
2469 @section @command{head}: Output the first part of files
2472 @cindex initial part of files, outputting
2473 @cindex first part of files, outputting
2475 @command{head} prints the first part (10 lines by default) of each
2476 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2477 when given a @var{file} of @option{-}. Synopsis:
2480 head [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2483 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{head} prints a
2484 one-line header consisting of:
2487 ==> @var{file name} <==
2491 before the output for each @var{file}.
2493 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2498 @itemx --bytes=@var{n}
2501 Print the first @var{n} bytes, instead of initial lines.
2502 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{-},
2503 print all but the last @var{n} bytes of each file.
2504 Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{n} by 512,
2505 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
2506 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
2507 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{G} by 1024*1024*1024,
2508 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2511 @itemx --lines=@var{n}
2514 Output the first @var{n} lines.
2515 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{-},
2516 print all but the last @var{n} lines of each file.
2517 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2525 Never print file name headers.
2531 Always print file name headers.
2535 For compatibility @command{head} also supports an obsolete option syntax
2536 @option{-@var{count}@var{options}}, which is recognized only if it is
2537 specified first. @var{count} is a decimal number optionally followed
2538 by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{k}, @samp{m}) as in @option{-c}, or
2539 @samp{l} to mean count by lines, or other option letters (@samp{cqv}).
2540 Scripts intended for standard hosts should use @option{-c @var{count}}
2541 or @option{-n @var{count}} instead. If your script must also run on
2542 hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, it is usually simpler to
2543 avoid @command{head}, e.g., by using @samp{sed 5q} instead of
2549 @node tail invocation
2550 @section @command{tail}: Output the last part of files
2553 @cindex last part of files, outputting
2555 @command{tail} prints the last part (10 lines by default) of each
2556 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2557 when given a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
2560 tail [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2563 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{tail} prints a
2564 one-line header consisting of:
2567 ==> @var{file name} <==
2571 before the output for each @var{file}.
2573 @cindex BSD @command{tail}
2574 @sc{gnu} @command{tail} can output any amount of data (some other versions of
2575 @command{tail} cannot). It also has no @option{-r} option (print in
2576 reverse), since reversing a file is really a different job from printing
2577 the end of a file; BSD @command{tail} (which is the one with @option{-r}) can
2578 only reverse files that are at most as large as its buffer, which is
2579 typically 32 KiB@. A more reliable and versatile way to reverse files is
2580 the @sc{gnu} @command{tac} command.
2582 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2586 @item -c @var{bytes}
2587 @itemx --bytes=@var{bytes}
2590 Output the last @var{bytes} bytes, instead of final lines.
2591 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2592 @var{n}th byte from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2593 Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{bytes} by 512,
2594 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
2595 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
2596 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{G} by 1024*1024*1024,
2597 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2600 @itemx --follow[=@var{how}]
2603 @cindex growing files
2604 @vindex name @r{follow option}
2605 @vindex descriptor @r{follow option}
2606 Loop forever trying to read more characters at the end of the file,
2607 presumably because the file is growing.
2608 If more than one file is given, @command{tail} prints a header whenever it
2609 gets output from a different file, to indicate which file that output is
2612 There are two ways to specify how you'd like to track files with this option,
2613 but that difference is noticeable only when a followed file is removed or
2615 If you'd like to continue to track the end of a growing file even after
2616 it has been unlinked, use @option{--follow=descriptor}. This is the default
2617 behavior, but it is not useful if you're tracking a log file that may be
2618 rotated (removed or renamed, then reopened). In that case, use
2619 @option{--follow=name} to track the named file by reopening it periodically
2620 to see if it has been removed and recreated by some other program.
2622 No matter which method you use, if the tracked file is determined to have
2623 shrunk, @command{tail} prints a message saying the file has been truncated
2624 and resumes tracking the end of the file from the newly-determined endpoint.
2626 When a file is removed, @command{tail}'s behavior depends on whether it is
2627 following the name or the descriptor. When following by name, tail can
2628 detect that a file has been removed and gives a message to that effect,
2629 and if @option{--retry} has been specified it will continue checking
2630 periodically to see if the file reappears.
2631 When following a descriptor, tail does not detect that the file has
2632 been unlinked or renamed and issues no message; even though the file
2633 may no longer be accessible via its original name, it may still be
2636 The option values @samp{descriptor} and @samp{name} may be specified only
2637 with the long form of the option, not with @option{-f}.
2639 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2640 If @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, the @option{-f} option is ignored if
2641 no @var{file} operand is specified and standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2645 This option is the same as @option{--follow=name --retry}. That is, tail
2646 will attempt to reopen a file when it is removed. Should this fail, tail
2647 will keep trying until it becomes accessible again.
2651 This option is useful mainly when following by name (i.e., with
2652 @option{--follow=name}).
2653 Without this option, when tail encounters a file that doesn't
2654 exist or is otherwise inaccessible, it reports that fact and
2655 never checks it again.
2657 @itemx --sleep-interval=@var{number}
2658 @opindex --sleep-interval
2659 Change the number of seconds to wait between iterations (the default is 1.0).
2660 During one iteration, every specified file is checked to see if it has
2662 Historical implementations of @command{tail} have required that
2663 @var{number} be an integer. However, GNU @command{tail} accepts
2664 an arbitrary floating point number (using a period before any
2667 @itemx --pid=@var{pid}
2669 When following by name or by descriptor, you may specify the process ID,
2670 @var{pid}, of the sole writer of all @var{file} arguments. Then, shortly
2671 after that process terminates, tail will also terminate. This will
2672 work properly only if the writer and the tailing process are running on
2673 the same machine. For example, to save the output of a build in a file
2674 and to watch the file grow, if you invoke @command{make} and @command{tail}
2675 like this then the tail process will stop when your build completes.
2676 Without this option, you would have had to kill the @code{tail -f}
2680 $ make >& makerr & tail --pid=$! -f makerr
2683 If you specify a @var{pid} that is not in use or that does not correspond
2684 to the process that is writing to the tailed files, then @command{tail}
2685 may terminate long before any @var{file}s stop growing or it may not
2686 terminate until long after the real writer has terminated.
2687 Note that @option{--pid} cannot be supported on some systems; @command{tail}
2688 will print a warning if this is the case.
2690 @itemx --max-unchanged-stats=@var{n}
2691 @opindex --max-unchanged-stats
2692 When tailing a file by name, if there have been @var{n} (default
2693 n=@value{DEFAULT_MAX_N_UNCHANGED_STATS_BETWEEN_OPENS}) consecutive
2694 iterations for which the file has not changed, then
2695 @code{open}/@code{fstat} the file to determine if that file name is
2696 still associated with the same device/inode-number pair as before.
2697 When following a log file that is rotated, this is approximately the
2698 number of seconds between when tail prints the last pre-rotation lines
2699 and when it prints the lines that have accumulated in the new log file.
2700 This option is meaningful only when following by name.
2703 @itemx --lines=@var{n}
2706 Output the last @var{n} lines.
2707 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2708 @var{n}th line from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2709 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2717 Never print file name headers.
2723 Always print file name headers.
2727 For compatibility @command{tail} also supports an obsolete usage
2728 @samp{tail -[@var{count}][bcl][f] [@var{file}]}, which is recognized
2729 only if it does not conflict with the usage described
2730 above. This obsolete form uses exactly one option and at most one
2731 file. In the option, @var{count} is an optional decimal number optionally
2732 followed by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{c}, @samp{l}) to mean count
2733 by 512-byte blocks, bytes, or lines, optionally followed by @samp{f}
2734 which has the same meaning as @option{-f}.
2736 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
2737 On older systems, the leading @samp{-} can be replaced by @samp{+} in
2738 the obsolete option syntax with the same meaning as in counts, and
2739 obsolete usage overrides normal usage when the two conflict.
2740 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
2741 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
2744 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
2745 syntax and should use @option{-c @var{count}[b]}, @option{-n
2746 @var{count}}, and/or @option{-f} instead. If your script must also
2747 run on hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, you can often
2748 rewrite it to avoid problematic usages, e.g., by using @samp{sed -n
2749 '$p'} rather than @samp{tail -1}. If that's not possible, the script
2750 can use a test like @samp{if tail -c +1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1;
2751 then @dots{}} to decide which syntax to use.
2753 Even if your script assumes the standard behavior, you should still
2754 beware usages whose behaviors differ depending on the @acronym{POSIX}
2755 version. For example, avoid @samp{tail - main.c}, since it might be
2756 interpreted as either @samp{tail main.c} or as @samp{tail -- -
2757 main.c}; avoid @samp{tail -c 4}, since it might mean either @samp{tail
2758 -c4} or @samp{tail -c 10 4}; and avoid @samp{tail +4}, since it might
2759 mean either @samp{tail ./+4} or @samp{tail -n +4}.
2764 @node split invocation
2765 @section @command{split}: Split a file into fixed-size pieces
2768 @cindex splitting a file into pieces
2769 @cindex pieces, splitting a file into
2771 @command{split} creates output files containing consecutive sections of
2772 @var{input} (standard input if none is given or @var{input} is
2773 @samp{-}). Synopsis:
2776 split [@var{option}] [@var{input} [@var{prefix}]]
2779 By default, @command{split} puts 1000 lines of @var{input} (or whatever is
2780 left over for the last section), into each output file.
2782 @cindex output file name prefix
2783 The output files' names consist of @var{prefix} (@samp{x} by default)
2784 followed by a group of characters (@samp{aa}, @samp{ab}, @dots{} by
2785 default), such that concatenating the output files in traditional
2786 sorted order by file name produces
2787 the original input file. If the output file names are exhausted,
2788 @command{split} reports an error without deleting the output files
2791 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2795 @item -l @var{lines}
2796 @itemx --lines=@var{lines}
2799 Put @var{lines} lines of @var{input} into each output file.
2801 For compatibility @command{split} also supports an obsolete
2802 option syntax @option{-@var{lines}}. New scripts should use @option{-l
2803 @var{lines}} instead.
2806 @itemx --bytes=@var{size}
2809 Put @var{size} bytes of @var{input} into each output file.
2810 @var{size} is a number which may be followed by one of these
2811 multiplicative suffixes:
2813 @samp{b} => 512 ("blocks")
2814 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
2815 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
2816 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
2817 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
2819 and so on for @samp{G}, @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2822 @itemx --line-bytes=@var{size}
2824 @opindex --line-bytes
2825 Put into each output file as many complete lines of @var{input} as
2826 possible without exceeding @var{size} bytes. Individual lines longer than
2827 @var{size} bytes are broken into multiple files.
2828 @var{size} has the same format as for the @option{--bytes} option.
2830 @item -a @var{length}
2831 @itemx --suffix-length=@var{length}
2833 @opindex --suffix-length
2834 Use suffixes of length @var{length}. The default @var{length} is 2.
2837 @itemx --numeric-suffixes
2839 @opindex --numeric-suffixes
2840 Use digits in suffixes rather than lower-case letters.
2844 Write a diagnostic just before each output file is opened.
2851 @node csplit invocation
2852 @section @command{csplit}: Split a file into context-determined pieces
2855 @cindex context splitting
2856 @cindex splitting a file into pieces by context
2858 @command{csplit} creates zero or more output files containing sections of
2859 @var{input} (standard input if @var{input} is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
2862 csplit [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{input} @var{pattern}@dots{}
2865 The contents of the output files are determined by the @var{pattern}
2866 arguments, as detailed below. An error occurs if a @var{pattern}
2867 argument refers to a nonexistent line of the input file (e.g., if no
2868 remaining line matches a given regular expression). After every
2869 @var{pattern} has been matched, any remaining input is copied into one
2872 By default, @command{csplit} prints the number of bytes written to each
2873 output file after it has been created.
2875 The types of pattern arguments are:
2880 Create an output file containing the input up to but not including line
2881 @var{n} (a positive integer). If followed by a repeat count, also
2882 create an output file containing the next @var{n} lines of the input
2883 file once for each repeat.
2885 @item /@var{regexp}/[@var{offset}]
2886 Create an output file containing the current line up to (but not
2887 including) the next line of the input file that contains a match for
2888 @var{regexp}. The optional @var{offset} is an integer.
2889 If it is given, the input up to (but not including) the
2890 matching line plus or minus @var{offset} is put into the output file,
2891 and the line after that begins the next section of input.
2893 @item %@var{regexp}%[@var{offset}]
2894 Like the previous type, except that it does not create an output
2895 file, so that section of the input file is effectively ignored.
2897 @item @{@var{repeat-count}@}
2898 Repeat the previous pattern @var{repeat-count} additional
2899 times. The @var{repeat-count} can either be a positive integer or an
2900 asterisk, meaning repeat as many times as necessary until the input is
2905 The output files' names consist of a prefix (@samp{xx} by default)
2906 followed by a suffix. By default, the suffix is an ascending sequence
2907 of two-digit decimal numbers from @samp{00} to @samp{99}. In any case,
2908 concatenating the output files in sorted order by file name produces the
2909 original input file.
2911 By default, if @command{csplit} encounters an error or receives a hangup,
2912 interrupt, quit, or terminate signal, it removes any output files
2913 that it has created so far before it exits.
2915 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2919 @item -f @var{prefix}
2920 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2923 @cindex output file name prefix
2924 Use @var{prefix} as the output file name prefix.
2926 @item -b @var{suffix}
2927 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
2930 @cindex output file name suffix
2931 Use @var{suffix} as the output file name suffix. When this option is
2932 specified, the suffix string must include exactly one
2933 @code{printf(3)}-style conversion specification, possibly including
2934 format specification flags, a field width, a precision specifications,
2935 or all of these kinds of modifiers. The format letter must convert a
2936 binary integer argument to readable form; thus, only @samp{d}, @samp{i},
2937 @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{x}, and @samp{X} conversions are allowed. The
2938 entire @var{suffix} is given (with the current output file number) to
2939 @code{sprintf(3)} to form the file name suffixes for each of the
2940 individual output files in turn. If this option is used, the
2941 @option{--digits} option is ignored.
2943 @item -n @var{digits}
2944 @itemx --digits=@var{digits}
2947 Use output file names containing numbers that are @var{digits} digits
2948 long instead of the default 2.
2953 @opindex --keep-files
2954 Do not remove output files when errors are encountered.
2957 @itemx --elide-empty-files
2959 @opindex --elide-empty-files
2960 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. (In cases where
2961 the section delimiters of the input file are supposed to mark the first
2962 lines of each of the sections, the first output file will generally be a
2963 zero-length file unless you use this option.) The output file sequence
2964 numbers always run consecutively starting from 0, even when this option
2975 Do not print counts of output file sizes.
2982 @node Summarizing files
2983 @chapter Summarizing files
2985 @cindex summarizing files
2987 These commands generate just a few numbers representing entire
2991 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
2992 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
2993 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
2994 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
2995 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
2996 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
3001 @section @command{wc}: Print newline, word, and byte counts
3005 @cindex character count
3009 @command{wc} counts the number of bytes, characters, whitespace-separated
3010 words, and newlines in each given @var{file}, or standard input if none
3011 are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3014 wc [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3017 @cindex total counts
3018 @command{wc} prints one line of counts for each file, and if the file was
3019 given as an argument, it prints the file name following the counts. If
3020 more than one @var{file} is given, @command{wc} prints a final line
3021 containing the cumulative counts, with the file name @file{total}. The
3022 counts are printed in this order: newlines, words, characters, bytes,
3023 maximum line length.
3024 Each count is printed right-justified in a field with at least one
3025 space between fields so that the numbers and file names normally line
3026 up nicely in columns. The width of the count fields varies depending
3027 on the inputs, so you should not depend on a particular field width.
3028 However, as a @acronym{GNU} extension, if only one count is printed,
3029 it is guaranteed to be printed without leading spaces.
3031 By default, @command{wc} prints three counts: the newline, words, and byte
3032 counts. Options can specify that only certain counts be printed.
3033 Options do not undo others previously given, so
3040 prints both the byte counts and the word counts.
3042 With the @option{--max-line-length} option, @command{wc} prints the length
3043 of the longest line per file, and if there is more than one file it
3044 prints the maximum (not the sum) of those lengths.
3046 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3054 Print only the byte counts.
3060 Print only the character counts.
3066 Print only the word counts.
3072 Print only the newline counts.
3075 @itemx --max-line-length
3077 @opindex --max-line-length
3078 Print only the maximum line lengths.
3080 @macro filesZeroFromOption{cmd,withTotalOption}
3081 @itemx --files0-from=@var{FILE}
3082 @opindex --files0-from=@var{FILE}
3083 @c This is commented out to avoid a texi2dvi failure.
3084 @c texi2dvi (GNU Texinfo 4.11) 1.104
3085 @c @cindex including files from @command{\cmd\}
3086 Rather than processing files named on the command line, process those
3087 named in file @var{FILE}; each name is terminated by a null byte.
3088 This is useful \withTotalOption\
3089 when the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
3091 In such cases, running @command{\cmd\} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
3092 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{\cmd\} print a
3093 total for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
3094 One way to produce a list of null-byte-terminated file names is with @sc{gnu}
3095 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate.
3096 Do not specify any @var{FILE} on the command line when using this option.
3098 @filesZeroFromOption{wc,}
3100 For example, to find the length of the longest line in any @file{.c} or
3101 @file{.h} file in the current hierarchy, do this:
3104 find . -name '*.[ch]' -print0 |
3105 wc -L --files0-from=- | tail -n1
3113 @node sum invocation
3114 @section @command{sum}: Print checksum and block counts
3117 @cindex 16-bit checksum
3118 @cindex checksum, 16-bit
3120 @command{sum} computes a 16-bit checksum for each given @var{file}, or
3121 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3124 sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3127 @command{sum} prints the checksum for each @var{file} followed by the
3128 number of blocks in the file (rounded up). If more than one @var{file}
3129 is given, file names are also printed (by default). (With the
3130 @option{--sysv} option, corresponding file names are printed when there is
3131 at least one file argument.)
3133 By default, @sc{gnu} @command{sum} computes checksums using an algorithm
3134 compatible with BSD @command{sum} and prints file sizes in units of
3137 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3143 @cindex BSD @command{sum}
3144 Use the default (BSD compatible) algorithm. This option is included for
3145 compatibility with the System V @command{sum}. Unless @option{-s} was also
3146 given, it has no effect.
3152 @cindex System V @command{sum}
3153 Compute checksums using an algorithm compatible with System V
3154 @command{sum}'s default, and print file sizes in units of 512-byte blocks.
3158 @command{sum} is provided for compatibility; the @command{cksum} program (see
3159 next section) is preferable in new applications.
3164 @node cksum invocation
3165 @section @command{cksum}: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
3168 @cindex cyclic redundancy check
3169 @cindex CRC checksum
3171 @command{cksum} computes a cyclic redundancy check (CRC) checksum for each
3172 given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given or for a
3173 @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3176 cksum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3179 @command{cksum} prints the CRC checksum for each file along with the number
3180 of bytes in the file, and the file name unless no arguments were given.
3182 @command{cksum} is typically used to ensure that files
3183 transferred by unreliable means (e.g., netnews) have not been corrupted,
3184 by comparing the @command{cksum} output for the received files with the
3185 @command{cksum} output for the original files (typically given in the
3188 The CRC algorithm is specified by the @acronym{POSIX} standard. It is not
3189 compatible with the BSD or System V @command{sum} algorithms (see the
3190 previous section); it is more robust.
3192 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
3198 @node md5sum invocation
3199 @section @command{md5sum}: Print or check MD5 digests
3203 @cindex 128-bit checksum
3204 @cindex checksum, 128-bit
3205 @cindex fingerprint, 128-bit
3206 @cindex message-digest, 128-bit
3208 @command{md5sum} computes a 128-bit checksum (or @dfn{fingerprint} or
3209 @dfn{message-digest}) for each specified @var{file}.
3211 Note: The MD5 digest is more reliable than a simple CRC (provided by
3212 the @command{cksum} command) for detecting accidental file corruption,
3213 as the chances of accidentally having two files with identical MD5
3214 are vanishingly small. However, it should not be considered truly
3215 secure against malicious tampering: although finding a file with a
3216 given MD5 fingerprint, or modifying a file so as to retain its MD5 are
3217 considered infeasible at the moment, it is known how to produce
3218 different files with identical MD5 (a ``collision''), something which
3219 can be a security issue in certain contexts. For more secure hashes,
3220 consider using SHA-1 or SHA-2. @xref{sha1sum invocation}, and
3221 @ref{sha2 utilities}.
3223 If a @var{file} is specified as @samp{-} or if no files are given
3224 @command{md5sum} computes the checksum for the standard input.
3225 @command{md5sum} can also determine whether a file and checksum are
3226 consistent. Synopsis:
3229 md5sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3232 For each @var{file}, @samp{md5sum} outputs the MD5 checksum, a flag
3233 indicating a binary or text input file, and the file name.
3234 If @var{file} contains a backslash or newline, the
3235 line is started with a backslash, and each problematic character in
3236 the file name is escaped with a backslash, making the output
3237 unambiguous even in the presence of arbitrary file names.
3238 If @var{file} is omitted or specified as @samp{-}, standard input is read.
3240 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3248 @cindex binary input files
3249 Treat each input file as binary, by reading it in binary mode and
3250 outputting a @samp{*} flag. This is the inverse of @option{--text}.
3251 On systems like @acronym{GNU} that do not distinguish between binary
3252 and text files, this option merely flags each input file as binary:
3253 the MD5 checksum is unaffected. This option is the default on systems
3254 like MS-DOS that distinguish between binary and text files, except
3255 for reading standard input when standard input is a terminal.
3259 Read file names and checksum information (not data) from each
3260 @var{file} (or from stdin if no @var{file} was specified) and report
3261 whether the checksums match the contents of the named files.
3262 The input to this mode of @command{md5sum} is usually the output of
3263 a prior, checksum-generating run of @samp{md5sum}.
3264 Each valid line of input consists of an MD5 checksum, a binary/text
3265 flag, and then a file name.
3266 Binary files are marked with @samp{*}, text with @samp{ }.
3267 For each such line, @command{md5sum} reads the named file and computes its
3268 MD5 checksum. Then, if the computed message digest does not match the
3269 one on the line with the file name, the file is noted as having
3270 failed the test. Otherwise, the file passes the test.
3271 By default, for each valid line, one line is written to standard
3272 output indicating whether the named file passed the test.
3273 After all checks have been performed, if there were any failures,
3274 a warning is issued to standard error.
3275 Use the @option{--status} option to inhibit that output.
3276 If any listed file cannot be opened or read, if any valid line has
3277 an MD5 checksum inconsistent with the associated file, or if no valid
3278 line is found, @command{md5sum} exits with nonzero status. Otherwise,
3279 it exits successfully.
3283 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3284 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3285 When verifying checksums, don't generate an 'OK' message per successfully
3286 checked file. Files that fail the verification are reported in the
3287 default one-line-per-file format. If there is any checksum mismatch,
3288 print a warning summarizing the failures to standard error.
3292 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3293 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3294 When verifying checksums, don't generate the default one-line-per-file
3295 diagnostic and don't output the warning summarizing any failures.
3296 Failures to open or read a file still evoke individual diagnostics to
3298 If all listed files are readable and are consistent with the associated
3299 MD5 checksums, exit successfully. Otherwise exit with a status code
3300 indicating there was a failure.
3306 @cindex text input files
3307 Treat each input file as text, by reading it in text mode and
3308 outputting a @samp{ } flag. This is the inverse of @option{--binary}.
3309 This option is the default on systems like @acronym{GNU} that do not
3310 distinguish between binary and text files. On other systems, it is
3311 the default for reading standard input when standard input is a
3318 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3319 When verifying checksums, warn about improperly formatted MD5 checksum lines.
3320 This option is useful only if all but a few lines in the checked input
3328 @node sha1sum invocation
3329 @section @command{sha1sum}: Print or check SHA-1 digests
3333 @cindex 160-bit checksum
3334 @cindex checksum, 160-bit
3335 @cindex fingerprint, 160-bit
3336 @cindex message-digest, 160-bit
3338 @command{sha1sum} computes a 160-bit checksum for each specified
3339 @var{file}. The usage and options of this command are precisely the
3340 same as for @command{md5sum}. @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3342 Note: The SHA-1 digest is more secure than MD5, and no collisions of
3343 it are known (different files having the same fingerprint). However,
3344 it is known that they can be produced with considerable, but not
3345 unreasonable, resources. For this reason, it is generally considered
3346 that SHA-1 should be gradually phased out in favor of the more secure
3347 SHA-2 hash algorithms. @xref{sha2 utilities}.
3350 @node sha2 utilities
3351 @section sha2 utilities: Print or check SHA-2 digests
3358 @cindex 224-bit checksum
3359 @cindex 256-bit checksum
3360 @cindex 384-bit checksum
3361 @cindex 512-bit checksum
3362 @cindex checksum, 224-bit
3363 @cindex checksum, 256-bit
3364 @cindex checksum, 384-bit
3365 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
3366 @cindex fingerprint, 224-bit
3367 @cindex fingerprint, 256-bit
3368 @cindex fingerprint, 384-bit
3369 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
3370 @cindex message-digest, 224-bit
3371 @cindex message-digest, 256-bit
3372 @cindex message-digest, 384-bit
3373 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
3375 The commands @command{sha224sum}, @command{sha256sum},
3376 @command{sha384sum} and @command{sha512sum} compute checksums of
3377 various lengths (respectively 224, 256, 384 and 512 bits),
3378 collectively known as the SHA-2 hashes. The usage and options of
3379 these commands are precisely the same as for @command{md5sum}.
3380 @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3382 Note: The SHA384 and SHA512 digests are considerably slower to
3383 compute, especially on 32-bit computers, than SHA224 or SHA256.
3386 @node Operating on sorted files
3387 @chapter Operating on sorted files
3389 @cindex operating on sorted files
3390 @cindex sorted files, operations on
3392 These commands work with (or produce) sorted files.
3395 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
3396 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
3397 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
3398 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
3399 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
3400 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
3401 * tsort background:: Where tsort came from.
3405 @node sort invocation
3406 @section @command{sort}: Sort text files
3409 @cindex sorting files
3411 @command{sort} sorts, merges, or compares all the lines from the given
3412 files, or standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of
3413 @samp{-}. By default, @command{sort} writes the results to standard
3417 sort [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3420 @command{sort} has three modes of operation: sort (the default), merge,
3421 and check for sortedness. The following options change the operation
3428 @itemx --check=diagnose-first
3431 @cindex checking for sortedness
3432 Check whether the given file is already sorted: if it is not all
3433 sorted, print a diagnostic containing the first out-of-order line and
3434 exit with a status of 1.
3435 Otherwise, exit successfully.
3436 At most one input file can be given.
3439 @itemx --check=quiet
3440 @itemx --check=silent
3443 @cindex checking for sortedness
3444 Exit successfully if the given file is already sorted, and
3445 exit with status 1 otherwise.
3446 At most one input file can be given.
3447 This is like @option{-c}, except it does not print a diagnostic.
3453 @cindex merging sorted files
3454 Merge the given files by sorting them as a group. Each input file must
3455 always be individually sorted. It always works to sort instead of
3456 merge; merging is provided because it is faster, in the case where it
3461 @cindex sort stability
3462 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
3463 A pair of lines is compared as follows:
3464 @command{sort} compares each pair of fields, in the
3465 order specified on the command line, according to the associated
3466 ordering options, until a difference is found or no fields are left.
3467 If no key fields are specified, @command{sort} uses a default key of
3468 the entire line. Finally, as a last resort when all keys compare
3469 equal, @command{sort} compares entire lines as if no ordering options
3470 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) were specified. The
3471 @option{--stable} (@option{-s}) option disables this @dfn{last-resort
3472 comparison} so that lines in which all fields compare equal are left
3473 in their original relative order. The @option{--unique}
3474 (@option{-u}) option also disables the last-resort comparison.
3478 Unless otherwise specified, all comparisons use the character collating
3479 sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.@footnote{If you
3480 use a non-@acronym{POSIX} locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL}
3481 to @samp{en_US}), then @command{sort} may produce output that is sorted
3482 differently than you're accustomed to. In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL}
3483 environment variable to @samp{C}. Note that setting only @env{LC_COLLATE}
3484 has two problems. First, it is ineffective if @env{LC_ALL} is also set.
3485 Second, it has undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} (or @env{LANG}, if
3486 @env{LC_CTYPE} is unset) is set to an incompatible value. For example,
3487 you get undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} is @code{ja_JP.PCK} but
3488 @env{LC_COLLATE} is @code{en_US.UTF-8}.}
3490 @sc{gnu} @command{sort} (as specified for all @sc{gnu} utilities) has no
3491 limit on input line length or restrictions on bytes allowed within lines.
3492 In addition, if the final byte of an input file is not a newline, @sc{gnu}
3493 @command{sort} silently supplies one. A line's trailing newline is not
3494 part of the line for comparison purposes.
3496 @cindex exit status of @command{sort}
3500 0 if no error occurred
3501 1 if invoked with @option{-c} or @option{-C} and the input is not sorted
3502 2 if an error occurred
3506 If the environment variable @env{TMPDIR} is set, @command{sort} uses its
3507 value as the directory for temporary files instead of @file{/tmp}. The
3508 @option{--temporary-directory} (@option{-T}) option in turn overrides
3509 the environment variable.
3511 The following options affect the ordering of output lines. They may be
3512 specified globally or as part of a specific key field. If no key
3513 fields are specified, global options apply to comparison of entire
3514 lines; otherwise the global options are inherited by key fields that do
3515 not specify any special options of their own. In pre-@acronym{POSIX}
3516 versions of @command{sort}, global options affect only later key fields,
3517 so portable shell scripts should specify global options first.
3522 @itemx --ignore-leading-blanks
3524 @opindex --ignore-leading-blanks
3525 @cindex blanks, ignoring leading
3527 Ignore leading blanks when finding sort keys in each line.
3528 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3532 @itemx --dictionary-order
3534 @opindex --dictionary-order
3535 @cindex dictionary order
3536 @cindex phone directory order
3537 @cindex telephone directory order
3539 Sort in @dfn{phone directory} order: ignore all characters except
3540 letters, digits and blanks when sorting.
3541 By default letters and digits are those of @acronym{ASCII} and a blank
3542 is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale can change this.
3545 @itemx --ignore-case
3547 @opindex --ignore-case
3548 @cindex ignoring case
3549 @cindex case folding
3551 Fold lowercase characters into the equivalent uppercase characters when
3552 comparing so that, for example, @samp{b} and @samp{B} sort as equal.
3553 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
3556 @itemx --general-numeric-sort
3557 @itemx --sort=general-numeric
3559 @opindex --general-numeric-sort
3561 @cindex general numeric sort
3563 Sort numerically, using the standard C function @code{strtod} to convert
3564 a prefix of each line to a double-precision floating point number.
3565 This allows floating point numbers to be specified in scientific notation,
3566 like @code{1.0e-34} and @code{10e100}.
3567 The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale determines the decimal-point character.
3568 Do not report overflow, underflow, or conversion errors.
3569 Use the following collating sequence:
3573 Lines that do not start with numbers (all considered to be equal).
3575 NaNs (``Not a Number'' values, in IEEE floating point arithmetic)
3576 in a consistent but machine-dependent order.
3580 Finite numbers in ascending numeric order (with @math{-0} and @math{+0} equal).
3585 Use this option only if there is no alternative; it is much slower than
3586 @option{--numeric-sort} (@option{-n}) and it can lose information when
3587 converting to floating point.
3590 @itemx --ignore-nonprinting
3592 @opindex --ignore-nonprinting
3593 @cindex nonprinting characters, ignoring
3594 @cindex unprintable characters, ignoring
3596 Ignore nonprinting characters.
3597 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
3598 This option has no effect if the stronger @option{--dictionary-order}
3599 (@option{-d}) option is also given.
3605 @opindex --month-sort
3607 @cindex months, sorting by
3609 An initial string, consisting of any amount of blanks, followed
3610 by a month name abbreviation, is folded to UPPER case and
3611 compared in the order @samp{JAN} < @samp{FEB} < @dots{} < @samp{DEC}.
3612 Invalid names compare low to valid names. The @env{LC_TIME} locale
3613 category determines the month spellings.
3614 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3618 @itemx --numeric-sort
3619 @itemx --sort=numeric
3621 @opindex --numeric-sort
3623 @cindex numeric sort
3625 Sort numerically. The number begins each line and consists
3626 of optional blanks, an optional @samp{-} sign, and zero or more
3627 digits possibly separated by thousands separators, optionally followed
3628 by a decimal-point character and zero or more digits. An empty
3629 number is treated as @samp{0}. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
3630 locale specifies the decimal-point character and thousands separator.
3631 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3634 Comparison is exact; there is no rounding error.
3636 Neither a leading @samp{+} nor exponential notation is recognized.
3637 To compare such strings numerically, use the
3638 @option{--general-numeric-sort} (@option{-g}) option.
3644 @cindex reverse sorting
3645 Reverse the result of comparison, so that lines with greater key values
3646 appear earlier in the output instead of later.
3649 @itemx --random-sort
3650 @itemx --sort=random
3652 @opindex --random-sort
3655 Sort by hashing the input keys and then sorting the hash values.
3656 Choose the hash function at random, ensuring that it is free of
3657 collisions so that differing keys have differing hash values. This is
3658 like a random permutation of the inputs (@pxref{shuf invocation}),
3659 except that keys with the same value sort together.
3661 If multiple random sort fields are specified, the same random hash
3662 function is used for all fields. To use different random hash
3663 functions for different fields, you can invoke @command{sort} more
3666 The choice of hash function is affected by the
3667 @option{--random-source} option.
3675 @item --compress-program=@var{prog}
3676 Compress any temporary files with the program @var{prog}.
3678 With no arguments, @var{prog} must compress standard input to standard
3679 output, and when given the @option{-d} option it must decompress
3680 standard input to standard output.
3682 Terminate with an error if @var{prog} exits with nonzero status.
3684 White space and the backslash character should not appear in
3685 @var{prog}; they are reserved for future use.
3687 @item -k @var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
3688 @itemx --key=@var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
3692 Specify a sort field that consists of the part of the line between
3693 @var{pos1} and @var{pos2} (or the end of the line, if @var{pos2} is
3694 omitted), @emph{inclusive}.
3696 Each @var{pos} has the form @samp{@var{f}[.@var{c}][@var{opts}]},
3697 where @var{f} is the number of the field to use, and @var{c} is the number
3698 of the first character from the beginning of the field. Fields and character
3699 positions are numbered starting with 1; a character position of zero in
3700 @var{pos2} indicates the field's last character. If @samp{.@var{c}} is
3701 omitted from @var{pos1}, it defaults to 1 (the beginning of the field);
3702 if omitted from @var{pos2}, it defaults to 0 (the end of the field).
3703 @var{opts} are ordering options, allowing individual keys to be sorted
3704 according to different rules; see below for details. Keys can span
3707 Example: To sort on the second field, use @option{--key=2,2}
3708 (@option{-k 2,2}). See below for more examples.
3710 @item -o @var{output-file}
3711 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
3714 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
3715 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
3716 Normally, @command{sort} reads all input before opening
3717 @var{output-file}, so you can safely sort a file in place by using
3718 commands like @code{sort -o F F} and @code{cat F | sort -o F}.
3719 However, @command{sort} with @option{--merge} (@option{-m}) can open
3720 the output file before reading all input, so a command like @code{cat
3721 F | sort -m -o F - G} is not safe as @command{sort} might start
3722 writing @file{F} before @command{cat} is done reading it.
3724 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
3725 On newer systems, @option{-o} cannot appear after an input file if
3726 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, e.g., @samp{sort F -o F}. Portable
3727 scripts should specify @option{-o @var{output-file}} before any input
3730 @item --random-source=@var{file}
3731 @opindex --random-source
3732 @cindex random source for sorting
3733 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
3734 random hash function to use with the @option{-R} option. @xref{Random
3741 @cindex sort stability
3742 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
3744 Make @command{sort} stable by disabling its last-resort comparison.
3745 This option has no effect if no fields or global ordering options
3746 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) are specified.
3749 @itemx --buffer-size=@var{size}
3751 @opindex --buffer-size
3752 @cindex size for main memory sorting
3753 Use a main-memory sort buffer of the given @var{size}. By default,
3754 @var{size} is in units of 1024 bytes. Appending @samp{%} causes
3755 @var{size} to be interpreted as a percentage of physical memory.
3756 Appending @samp{K} multiplies @var{size} by 1024 (the default),
3757 @samp{M} by 1,048,576, @samp{G} by 1,073,741,824, and so on for
3758 @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}. Appending
3759 @samp{b} causes @var{size} to be interpreted as a byte count, with no
3762 This option can improve the performance of @command{sort} by causing it
3763 to start with a larger or smaller sort buffer than the default.
3764 However, this option affects only the initial buffer size. The buffer
3765 grows beyond @var{size} if @command{sort} encounters input lines larger
3768 @item -t @var{separator}
3769 @itemx --field-separator=@var{separator}
3771 @opindex --field-separator
3772 @cindex field separator character
3773 Use character @var{separator} as the field separator when finding the
3774 sort keys in each line. By default, fields are separated by the empty
3775 string between a non-blank character and a blank character.
3776 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3779 That is, given the input line @w{@samp{ foo bar}}, @command{sort} breaks it
3780 into fields @w{@samp{ foo}} and @w{@samp{ bar}}. The field separator is
3781 not considered to be part of either the field preceding or the field
3782 following, so with @samp{sort @w{-t " "}} the same input line has
3783 three fields: an empty field, @samp{foo}, and @samp{bar}.
3784 However, fields that extend to the end of the line,
3785 as @option{-k 2}, or fields consisting of a range, as @option{-k 2,3},
3786 retain the field separators present between the endpoints of the range.
3788 To specify a null character (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) as
3789 the field separator, use the two-character string @samp{\0}, e.g.,
3790 @samp{sort -t '\0'}.
3792 @item -T @var{tempdir}
3793 @itemx --temporary-directory=@var{tempdir}
3795 @opindex --temporary-directory
3796 @cindex temporary directory
3798 Use directory @var{tempdir} to store temporary files, overriding the
3799 @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. If this option is given more than
3800 once, temporary files are stored in all the directories given. If you
3801 have a large sort or merge that is I/O-bound, you can often improve
3802 performance by using this option to specify directories on different
3803 disks and controllers.
3809 @cindex uniquifying output
3811 Normally, output only the first of a sequence of lines that compare
3812 equal. For the @option{--check} (@option{-c} or @option{-C}) option,
3813 check that no pair of consecutive lines compares equal.
3815 This option also disables the default last-resort comparison.
3817 The commands @code{sort -u} and @code{sort | uniq} are equivalent, but
3818 this equivalence does not extend to arbitrary @command{sort} options.
3819 For example, @code{sort -n -u} inspects only the value of the initial
3820 numeric string when checking for uniqueness, whereas @code{sort -n |
3821 uniq} inspects the entire line. @xref{uniq invocation}.
3824 @itemx --zero-terminated
3826 @opindex --zero-terminated
3827 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
3828 Treat the input as a set of lines, each terminated by a null character
3829 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) instead of a line feed
3830 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf}).
3831 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
3832 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
3833 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
3834 or other special characters).
3838 Historical (BSD and System V) implementations of @command{sort} have
3839 differed in their interpretation of some options, particularly
3840 @option{-b}, @option{-f}, and @option{-n}. @sc{gnu} sort follows the @acronym{POSIX}
3841 behavior, which is usually (but not always!) like the System V behavior.
3842 According to @acronym{POSIX}, @option{-n} no longer implies @option{-b}. For
3843 consistency, @option{-M} has been changed in the same way. This may
3844 affect the meaning of character positions in field specifications in
3845 obscure cases. The only fix is to add an explicit @option{-b}.
3847 A position in a sort field specified with @option{-k} may have any
3848 of the option letters @samp{Mbdfinr} appended to it, in which case the
3849 global ordering options are not used for that particular field. The
3850 @option{-b} option may be independently attached to either or both of
3851 the start and end positions of a field specification, and if it is
3852 inherited from the global options it will be attached to both.
3853 If input lines can contain leading or adjacent blanks and @option{-t}
3854 is not used, then @option{-k} is typically combined with @option{-b},
3855 @option{-g}, @option{-M}, or @option{-n}; otherwise the varying
3856 numbers of leading blanks in fields can cause confusing results.
3858 If the start position in a sort field specifier falls after the end of
3859 the line or after the end field, the field is empty. If the @option{-b}
3860 option was specified, the @samp{.@var{c}} part of a field specification
3861 is counted from the first nonblank character of the field.
3863 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
3864 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
3865 On older systems, @command{sort} supports an obsolete origin-zero
3866 syntax @samp{+@var{pos1} [-@var{pos2}]} for specifying sort keys.
3867 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
3868 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
3869 conformance}); it can also be enabled when @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is
3870 not set by using the obsolete syntax with @samp{-@var{pos2}} present.
3872 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
3873 syntax and should use @option{-k} instead. For example, avoid
3874 @samp{sort +2}, since it might be interpreted as either @samp{sort
3875 ./+2} or @samp{sort -k 3}. If your script must also run on hosts that
3876 support only the obsolete syntax, it can use a test like @samp{if sort
3877 -k 1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then @dots{}} to decide which syntax
3880 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options.
3885 Sort in descending (reverse) numeric order.
3892 Sort alphabetically, omitting the first and second fields
3893 and the blanks at the start of the third field.
3894 This uses a single key composed of the characters beginning
3895 at the start of the first nonblank character in field three
3896 and extending to the end of each line.
3903 Sort numerically on the second field and resolve ties by sorting
3904 alphabetically on the third and fourth characters of field five.
3905 Use @samp{:} as the field delimiter.
3908 sort -t : -k 2,2n -k 5.3,5.4
3911 Note that if you had written @option{-k 2n} instead of @option{-k 2,2n}
3912 @command{sort} would have used all characters beginning in the second field
3913 and extending to the end of the line as the primary @emph{numeric}
3914 key. For the large majority of applications, treating keys spanning
3915 more than one field as numeric will not do what you expect.
3917 Also note that the @samp{n} modifier was applied to the field-end
3918 specifier for the first key. It would have been equivalent to
3919 specify @option{-k 2n,2} or @option{-k 2n,2n}. All modifiers except
3920 @samp{b} apply to the associated @emph{field}, regardless of whether
3921 the modifier character is attached to the field-start and/or the
3922 field-end part of the key specifier.
3925 Sort the password file on the fifth field and ignore any
3926 leading blanks. Sort lines with equal values in field five
3927 on the numeric user ID in field three. Fields are separated
3931 sort -t : -k 5b,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
3932 sort -t : -n -k 5b,5 -k 3,3 /etc/passwd
3933 sort -t : -b -k 5,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
3936 These three commands have equivalent effect. The first specifies that
3937 the first key's start position ignores leading blanks and the second
3938 key is sorted numerically. The other two commands rely on global
3939 options being inherited by sort keys that lack modifiers. The inheritance
3940 works in this case because @option{-k 5b,5b} and @option{-k 5b,5} are
3941 equivalent, as the location of a field-end lacking a @samp{.@var{c}}
3942 character position is not affected by whether initial blanks are
3946 Sort a set of log files, primarily by IPv4 address and secondarily by
3947 time stamp. If two lines' primary and secondary keys are identical,
3948 output the lines in the same order that they were input. The log
3949 files contain lines that look like this:
3952 4.150.156.3 - - [01/Apr/2004:06:31:51 +0000] message 1
3953 211.24.3.231 - - [24/Apr/2004:20:17:39 +0000] message 2
3956 Fields are separated by exactly one space. Sort IPv4 addresses
3957 lexicographically, e.g., 212.61.52.2 sorts before 212.129.233.201
3958 because 61 is less than 129.
3961 sort -s -t ' ' -k 4.9n -k 4.5M -k 4.2n -k 4.14,4.21 file*.log |
3962 sort -s -t '.' -k 1,1n -k 2,2n -k 3,3n -k 4,4n
3965 This example cannot be done with a single @command{sort} invocation,
3966 since IPv4 address components are separated by @samp{.} while dates
3967 come just after a space. So it is broken down into two invocations of
3968 @command{sort}: the first sorts by time stamp and the second by IPv4
3969 address. The time stamp is sorted by year, then month, then day, and
3970 finally by hour-minute-second field, using @option{-k} to isolate each
3971 field. Except for hour-minute-second there's no need to specify the
3972 end of each key field, since the @samp{n} and @samp{M} modifiers sort
3973 based on leading prefixes that cannot cross field boundaries. The
3974 IPv4 addresses are sorted lexicographically. The second sort uses
3975 @samp{-s} so that ties in the primary key are broken by the secondary
3976 key; the first sort uses @samp{-s} so that the combination of the two
3980 Generate a tags file in case-insensitive sorted order.
3983 find src -type f -print0 | sort -z -f | xargs -0 etags --append
3986 The use of @option{-print0}, @option{-z}, and @option{-0} in this case means
3987 that file names that contain blanks or other special characters are
3989 by the sort operation.
3991 @c This example is a bit contrived and needs more explanation.
3993 @c Sort records separated by an arbitrary string by using a pipe to convert
3994 @c each record delimiter string to @samp{\0}, then using sort's -z option,
3995 @c and converting each @samp{\0} back to the original record delimiter.
3998 @c printf 'c\n\nb\n\na\n'|perl -0pe 's/\n\n/\n\0/g'|sort -z|perl -0pe 's/\0/\n/g'
4002 Shuffle a list of directories, but preserve the order of files within
4003 each directory. For instance, one could use this to generate a music
4004 playlist in which albums are shuffled but the songs of each album are
4008 ls */* | sort -t / -k 1,1R -k 2,2
4014 @node shuf invocation
4015 @section @command{shuf}: Shuffling text
4018 @cindex shuffling files
4020 @command{shuf} shuffles its input by outputting a random permutation
4021 of its input lines. Each output permutation is equally likely.
4025 shuf [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
4026 shuf -e [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
4027 shuf -i @var{lo}-@var{hi} [@var{option}]@dots{}
4030 @command{shuf} has three modes of operation that affect where it
4031 obtains its input lines. By default, it reads lines from standard
4032 input. The following options change the operation mode:
4040 @cindex command-line operands to shuffle
4041 Treat each command-line operand as an input line.
4043 @item -i @var{lo}-@var{hi}
4044 @itemx --input-range=@var{lo}-@var{hi}
4046 @opindex --input-range
4047 @cindex input range to shuffle
4048 Act as if input came from a file containing the range of unsigned
4049 decimal integers @var{lo}@dots{}@var{hi}, one per line.
4053 @command{shuf}'s other options can affect its behavior in all
4058 @item -n @var{lines}
4059 @itemx --head-lines=@var{lines}
4061 @opindex --head-lines
4062 @cindex head of output
4063 Output at most @var{lines} lines. By default, all input lines are
4066 @item -o @var{output-file}
4067 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4070 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4071 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4072 @command{shuf} reads all input before opening
4073 @var{output-file}, so you can safely shuffle a file in place by using
4074 commands like @code{shuf -o F <F} and @code{cat F | shuf -o F}.
4076 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4077 @opindex --random-source
4078 @cindex random source for shuffling
4079 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4080 permutation to generate. @xref{Random sources}.
4083 @itemx --zero-terminated
4085 @opindex --zero-terminated
4086 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
4087 Treat the input and output as a set of lines, each terminated by a zero byte
4088 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (Null) character) instead of an
4089 @acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf} (Line Feed).
4090 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
4091 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
4092 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
4093 or other special characters).
4109 might produce the output
4119 Similarly, the command:
4122 shuf -e clubs hearts diamonds spades
4136 and the command @samp{shuf -i 1-4} might output:
4146 These examples all have four input lines, so @command{shuf} might
4147 produce any of the twenty-four possible permutations of the input. In
4148 general, if there are @var{N} input lines, there are @var{N}! (i.e.,
4149 @var{N} factorial, or @var{N} * (@var{N} - 1) * @dots{} * 1) possible
4150 output permutations.
4155 @node uniq invocation
4156 @section @command{uniq}: Uniquify files
4159 @cindex uniquify files
4161 @command{uniq} writes the unique lines in the given @file{input}, or
4162 standard input if nothing is given or for an @var{input} name of
4166 uniq [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4169 By default, @command{uniq} prints its input lines, except that
4170 it discards all but the first of adjacent repeated lines, so that
4171 no output lines are repeated. Optionally, it can instead discard
4172 lines that are not repeated, or all repeated lines.
4174 The input need not be sorted, but repeated input lines are detected
4175 only if they are adjacent. If you want to discard non-adjacent
4176 duplicate lines, perhaps you want to use @code{sort -u}.
4177 @xref{sort invocation}.
4180 Comparisons use the character collating sequence specified by the
4181 @env{LC_COLLATE} locale category.
4183 If no @var{output} file is specified, @command{uniq} writes to standard
4186 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4191 @itemx --skip-fields=@var{n}
4193 @opindex --skip-fields
4194 Skip @var{n} fields on each line before checking for uniqueness. Use
4195 a null string for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} fields. Fields
4196 are sequences of non-space non-tab characters that are separated from
4197 each other by at least one space or tab.
4199 For compatibility @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4200 @option{-@var{n}}. New scripts should use @option{-f @var{n}} instead.
4203 @itemx --skip-chars=@var{n}
4205 @opindex --skip-chars
4206 Skip @var{n} characters before checking for uniqueness. Use a null string
4207 for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} characters. If you use both
4208 the field and character skipping options, fields are skipped over first.
4210 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4211 On older systems, @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4213 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
4214 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4215 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
4216 behavior depends on this variable.
4217 For example, use @samp{uniq ./+10} or @samp{uniq -s 10} rather than
4218 the ambiguous @samp{uniq +10}.
4224 Print the number of times each line occurred along with the line.
4227 @itemx --ignore-case
4229 @opindex --ignore-case
4230 Ignore differences in case when comparing lines.
4236 @cindex repeated lines, outputting
4237 Discard lines that are not repeated. When used by itself, this option
4238 causes @command{uniq} to print the first copy of each repeated line,
4242 @itemx --all-repeated[=@var{delimit-method}]
4244 @opindex --all-repeated
4245 @cindex all repeated lines, outputting
4246 Do not discard the second and subsequent repeated input lines,
4247 but discard lines that are not repeated.
4248 This option is useful mainly in conjunction with other options e.g.,
4249 to ignore case or to compare only selected fields.
4250 The optional @var{delimit-method} tells how to delimit
4251 groups of repeated lines, and must be one of the following:
4256 Do not delimit groups of repeated lines.
4257 This is equivalent to @option{--all-repeated} (@option{-D}).
4260 Output a newline before each group of repeated lines.
4261 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use
4262 an @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (zero) byte instead of a newline.
4265 Separate groups of repeated lines with a single newline.
4266 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use
4267 an @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (zero) byte instead of a newline.
4268 This is the same as using @samp{prepend}, except that
4269 no delimiter is inserted before the first group, and hence
4270 may be better suited for output direct to users.
4273 Note that when groups are delimited and the input stream contains
4274 two or more consecutive blank lines, then the output is ambiguous.
4275 To avoid that, filter the input through @samp{tr -s '\n'} to replace
4276 each sequence of consecutive newlines with a single newline.
4278 This is a @sc{gnu} extension.
4279 @c FIXME: give an example showing *how* it's useful
4285 @cindex unique lines, outputting
4286 Discard the first repeated line. When used by itself, this option
4287 causes @command{uniq} to print unique lines, and nothing else.
4290 @itemx --check-chars=@var{n}
4292 @opindex --check-chars
4293 Compare at most @var{n} characters on each line (after skipping any specified
4294 fields and characters). By default the entire rest of the lines are
4298 @itemx --zero-terminated
4300 @opindex --zero-terminated
4301 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
4302 Treat the input as a set of lines, each terminated by a null character
4303 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) instead of a line feed
4304 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf}).
4305 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{sort -z}, @samp{perl -0} or
4306 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
4307 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
4308 or other special characters).
4315 @node comm invocation
4316 @section @command{comm}: Compare two sorted files line by line
4319 @cindex line-by-line comparison
4320 @cindex comparing sorted files
4322 @command{comm} writes to standard output lines that are common, and lines
4323 that are unique, to two input files; a file name of @samp{-} means
4324 standard input. Synopsis:
4327 comm [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
4331 Before @command{comm} can be used, the input files must be sorted using the
4332 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
4333 If an input file ends in a non-newline
4334 character, a newline is silently appended. The @command{sort} command with
4335 no options always outputs a file that is suitable input to @command{comm}.
4337 @cindex differing lines
4338 @cindex common lines
4339 With no options, @command{comm} produces three-column output. Column one
4340 contains lines unique to @var{file1}, column two contains lines unique
4341 to @var{file2}, and column three contains lines common to both files.
4342 Columns are separated by a single TAB character.
4343 @c FIXME: when there's an option to supply an alternative separator
4344 @c string, append `by default' to the above sentence.
4349 The options @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and @option{-3} suppress printing of
4350 the corresponding columns. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4352 Unlike some other comparison utilities, @command{comm} has an exit
4353 status that does not depend on the result of the comparison.
4354 Upon normal completion @command{comm} produces an exit code of zero.
4355 If there is an error it exits with nonzero status.
4358 @node tsort invocation
4359 @section @command{tsort}: Topological sort
4362 @cindex topological sort
4364 @command{tsort} performs a topological sort on the given @var{file}, or
4365 standard input if no input file is given or for a @var{file} of
4366 @samp{-}. For more details and some history, see @ref{tsort background}.
4370 tsort [@var{option}] [@var{file}]
4373 @command{tsort} reads its input as pairs of strings, separated by blanks,
4374 indicating a partial ordering. The output is a total ordering that
4375 corresponds to the given partial ordering.
4389 will produce the output
4400 Consider a more realistic example.
4401 You have a large set of functions all in one file, and they may all be
4402 declared static except one. Currently that one (say @code{main}) is the
4403 first function defined in the file, and the ones it calls directly follow
4404 it, followed by those they call, etc. Let's say that you are determined
4405 to take advantage of prototypes, so you have to choose between declaring
4406 all of those functions (which means duplicating a lot of information from
4407 the definitions) and rearranging the functions so that as many as possible
4408 are defined before they are used. One way to automate the latter process
4409 is to get a list for each function of the functions it calls directly.
4410 Many programs can generate such lists. They describe a call graph.
4411 Consider the following list, in which a given line indicates that the
4412 function on the left calls the one on the right directly.
4418 tail_file pretty_name
4419 tail_file write_header
4421 tail_forever recheck
4422 tail_forever pretty_name
4423 tail_forever write_header
4424 tail_forever dump_remainder
4427 tail_lines start_lines
4428 tail_lines dump_remainder
4429 tail_lines file_lines
4430 tail_lines pipe_lines
4432 tail_bytes start_bytes
4433 tail_bytes dump_remainder
4434 tail_bytes pipe_bytes
4435 file_lines dump_remainder
4439 then you can use @command{tsort} to produce an ordering of those
4440 functions that satisfies your requirement.
4443 example$ tsort call-graph | tac
4463 @command{tsort} detects any cycles in the input and writes the first cycle
4464 encountered to standard error.
4466 Note that for a given partial ordering, generally there is no unique
4467 total ordering. In the context of the call graph above, the function
4468 @code{parse_options} may be placed anywhere in the list as long as it
4469 precedes @code{main}.
4471 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
4474 @node tsort background
4475 @section @command{tsort}: Background
4477 @command{tsort} exists because very early versions of the Unix linker processed
4478 an archive file exactly once, and in order. As @command{ld} read each object
4479 in the archive, it decided whether it was needed in the program based on
4480 whether it defined any symbols which were undefined at that point in
4483 This meant that dependencies within the archive had to be handled
4484 specially. For example, @code{scanf} probably calls @code{read}. That means
4485 that in a single pass through an archive, it was important for @code{scanf.o}
4486 to appear before read.o, because otherwise a program which calls
4487 @code{scanf} but not @code{read} might end up with an unexpected unresolved
4488 reference to @code{read}.
4490 The way to address this problem was to first generate a set of
4491 dependencies of one object file on another. This was done by a shell
4492 script called @command{lorder}. The GNU tools don't provide a version of
4493 lorder, as far as I know, but you can still find it in BSD
4496 Then you ran @command{tsort} over the @command{lorder} output, and you used the
4497 resulting sort to define the order in which you added objects to the archive.
4499 This whole procedure has been obsolete since about 1980, because
4500 Unix archives now contain a symbol table (traditionally built by
4501 @command{ranlib}, now generally built by @command{ar} itself), and the Unix
4502 linker uses the symbol table to effectively make multiple passes over
4505 Anyhow, that's where tsort came from. To solve an old problem with
4506 the way the linker handled archive files, which has since been solved
4512 @node ptx invocation
4513 @section @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
4517 @command{ptx} reads a text file and essentially produces a permuted index, with
4518 each keyword in its context. The calling sketch is either one of:
4521 ptx [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{file} @dots{}]
4522 ptx -G [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4525 The @option{-G} (or its equivalent: @option{--traditional}) option disables
4526 all @sc{gnu} extensions and reverts to traditional mode, thus introducing some
4527 limitations and changing several of the program's default option values.
4528 When @option{-G} is not specified, @sc{gnu} extensions are always enabled.
4529 @sc{gnu} extensions to @command{ptx} are documented wherever appropriate in this
4530 document. For the full list, see @xref{Compatibility in ptx}.
4532 Individual options are explained in the following sections.
4534 When @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, there may be zero, one or several
4535 @var{file}s after the options. If there is no @var{file}, the program
4536 reads the standard input. If there is one or several @var{file}s, they
4537 give the name of input files which are all read in turn, as if all the
4538 input files were concatenated. However, there is a full contextual
4539 break between each file and, when automatic referencing is requested,
4540 file names and line numbers refer to individual text input files. In
4541 all cases, the program outputs the permuted index to the standard
4544 When @sc{gnu} extensions are @emph{not} enabled, that is, when the program
4545 operates in traditional mode, there may be zero, one or two parameters
4546 besides the options. If there are no parameters, the program reads the
4547 standard input and outputs the permuted index to the standard output.
4548 If there is only one parameter, it names the text @var{input} to be read
4549 instead of the standard input. If two parameters are given, they give
4550 respectively the name of the @var{input} file to read and the name of
4551 the @var{output} file to produce. @emph{Be very careful} to note that,
4552 in this case, the contents of file given by the second parameter is
4553 destroyed. This behavior is dictated by System V @command{ptx}
4554 compatibility; @sc{gnu} Standards normally discourage output parameters not
4555 introduced by an option.
4557 Note that for @emph{any} file named as the value of an option or as an
4558 input text file, a single dash @kbd{-} may be used, in which case
4559 standard input is assumed. However, it would not make sense to use this
4560 convention more than once per program invocation.
4563 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
4564 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
4565 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
4566 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
4567 * Compatibility in ptx::
4571 @node General options in ptx
4572 @subsection General options
4577 @itemx --traditional
4578 As already explained, this option disables all @sc{gnu} extensions to
4579 @command{ptx} and switches to traditional mode.
4582 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
4586 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
4594 @node Charset selection in ptx
4595 @subsection Charset selection
4597 @c FIXME: People don't necessarily know what an IBM-PC was these days.
4598 As it is set up now, the program assumes that the input file is coded
4599 using 8-bit @acronym{ISO} 8859-1 code, also known as Latin-1 character set,
4600 @emph{unless} it is compiled for MS-DOS, in which case it uses the
4601 character set of the IBM-PC@. (@sc{gnu} @command{ptx} is not known to work on
4602 smaller MS-DOS machines anymore.) Compared to 7-bit @acronym{ASCII}, the set
4603 of characters which are letters is different; this alters the behavior
4604 of regular expression matching. Thus, the default regular expression
4605 for a keyword allows foreign or diacriticized letters. Keyword sorting,
4606 however, is still crude; it obeys the underlying character set ordering
4612 @itemx --ignore-case
4613 Fold lower case letters to upper case for sorting.
4618 @node Input processing in ptx
4619 @subsection Word selection and input processing
4624 @itemx --break-file=@var{file}
4626 This option provides an alternative (to @option{-W}) method of describing
4627 which characters make up words. It introduces the name of a
4628 file which contains a list of characters which can@emph{not} be part of
4629 one word; this file is called the @dfn{Break file}. Any character which
4630 is not part of the Break file is a word constituent. If both options
4631 @option{-b} and @option{-W} are specified, then @option{-W} has precedence and
4632 @option{-b} is ignored.
4634 When @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, the only way to avoid newline as a
4635 break character is to write all the break characters in the file with no
4636 newline at all, not even at the end of the file. When @sc{gnu} extensions
4637 are disabled, spaces, tabs and newlines are always considered as break
4638 characters even if not included in the Break file.
4641 @itemx --ignore-file=@var{file}
4643 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
4644 never be taken as keywords in concordance output. It is called the
4645 @dfn{Ignore file}. The file contains exactly one word in each line; the
4646 end of line separation of words is not subject to the value of the
4650 @itemx --only-file=@var{file}
4652 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
4653 be retained in concordance output; any word not mentioned in this file
4654 is ignored. The file is called the @dfn{Only file}. The file contains
4655 exactly one word in each line; the end of line separation of words is
4656 not subject to the value of the @option{-S} option.
4658 There is no default for the Only file. When both an Only file and an
4659 Ignore file are specified, a word is considered a keyword only
4660 if it is listed in the Only file and not in the Ignore file.
4665 On each input line, the leading sequence of non-white space characters will be
4666 taken to be a reference that has the purpose of identifying this input
4667 line in the resulting permuted index. For more information about reference
4668 production, see @xref{Output formatting in ptx}.
4669 Using this option changes the default value for option @option{-S}.
4671 Using this option, the program does not try very hard to remove
4672 references from contexts in output, but it succeeds in doing so
4673 @emph{when} the context ends exactly at the newline. If option
4674 @option{-r} is used with @option{-S} default value, or when @sc{gnu} extensions
4675 are disabled, this condition is always met and references are completely
4676 excluded from the output contexts.
4678 @item -S @var{regexp}
4679 @itemx --sentence-regexp=@var{regexp}
4681 This option selects which regular expression will describe the end of a
4682 line or the end of a sentence. In fact, this regular expression is not
4683 the only distinction between end of lines or end of sentences, and input
4684 line boundaries have no special significance outside this option. By
4685 default, when @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled and if @option{-r} option is not
4686 used, end of sentences are used. In this case, this @var{regex} is
4687 imported from @sc{gnu} Emacs:
4690 [.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\|\t\\| \\)[ \t\n]*
4693 Whenever @sc{gnu} extensions are disabled or if @option{-r} option is used, end
4694 of lines are used; in this case, the default @var{regexp} is just:
4700 Using an empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to completely disabling end of
4701 line or end of sentence recognition. In this case, the whole file is
4702 considered to be a single big line or sentence. The user might want to
4703 disallow all truncation flag generation as well, through option @option{-F
4704 ""}. @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
4707 When the keywords happen to be near the beginning of the input line or
4708 sentence, this often creates an unused area at the beginning of the
4709 output context line; when the keywords happen to be near the end of the
4710 input line or sentence, this often creates an unused area at the end of
4711 the output context line. The program tries to fill those unused areas
4712 by wrapping around context in them; the tail of the input line or
4713 sentence is used to fill the unused area on the left of the output line;
4714 the head of the input line or sentence is used to fill the unused area
4715 on the right of the output line.
4717 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4718 sequences from the C language are recognized and converted to the
4719 corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4721 @item -W @var{regexp}
4722 @itemx --word-regexp=@var{regexp}
4724 This option selects which regular expression will describe each keyword.
4725 By default, if @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, a word is a sequence of
4726 letters; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{\w+}. When @sc{gnu} extensions are
4727 disabled, a word is by default anything which ends with a space, a tab
4728 or a newline; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{[^ \t\n]+}.
4730 An empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to not using this option.
4731 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
4734 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4735 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
4736 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4741 @node Output formatting in ptx
4742 @subsection Output formatting
4744 Output format is mainly controlled by the @option{-O} and @option{-T} options
4745 described in the table below. When neither @option{-O} nor @option{-T} are
4746 selected, and if @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, the program chooses an
4747 output format suitable for a dumb terminal. Each keyword occurrence is
4748 output to the center of one line, surrounded by its left and right
4749 contexts. Each field is properly justified, so the concordance output
4750 can be readily observed. As a special feature, if automatic
4751 references are selected by option @option{-A} and are output before the
4752 left context, that is, if option @option{-R} is @emph{not} selected, then
4753 a colon is added after the reference; this nicely interfaces with @sc{gnu}
4754 Emacs @code{next-error} processing. In this default output format, each
4755 white space character, like newline and tab, is merely changed to
4756 exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress consecutive
4757 spaces. This might change in the future. Except for those white space
4758 characters, every other character of the underlying set of 256
4759 characters is transmitted verbatim.
4761 Output format is further controlled by the following options.
4765 @item -g @var{number}
4766 @itemx --gap-size=@var{number}
4768 Select the size of the minimum white space gap between the fields on the
4771 @item -w @var{number}
4772 @itemx --width=@var{number}
4774 Select the maximum output width of each final line. If references are
4775 used, they are included or excluded from the maximum output width
4776 depending on the value of option @option{-R}. If this option is not
4777 selected, that is, when references are output before the left context,
4778 the maximum output width takes into account the maximum length of all
4779 references. If this option is selected, that is, when references are
4780 output after the right context, the maximum output width does not take
4781 into account the space taken by references, nor the gap that precedes
4785 @itemx --auto-reference
4787 Select automatic references. Each input line will have an automatic
4788 reference made up of the file name and the line ordinal, with a single
4789 colon between them. However, the file name will be empty when standard
4790 input is being read. If both @option{-A} and @option{-r} are selected, then
4791 the input reference is still read and skipped, but the automatic
4792 reference is used at output time, overriding the input reference.
4795 @itemx --right-side-refs
4797 In the default output format, when option @option{-R} is not used, any
4798 references produced by the effect of options @option{-r} or @option{-A} are
4799 placed to the far right of output lines, after the right context. With
4800 default output format, when the @option{-R} option is specified, references
4801 are rather placed at the beginning of each output line, before the left
4802 context. For any other output format, option @option{-R} is
4803 ignored, with one exception: with @option{-R} the width of references
4804 is @emph{not} taken into account in total output width given by @option{-w}.
4806 This option is automatically selected whenever @sc{gnu} extensions are
4809 @item -F @var{string}
4810 @itemx --flac-truncation=@var{string}
4812 This option will request that any truncation in the output be reported
4813 using the string @var{string}. Most output fields theoretically extend
4814 towards the beginning or the end of the current line, or current
4815 sentence, as selected with option @option{-S}. But there is a maximum
4816 allowed output line width, changeable through option @option{-w}, which is
4817 further divided into space for various output fields. When a field has
4818 to be truncated because it cannot extend beyond the beginning or the end of
4819 the current line to fit in, then a truncation occurs. By default,
4820 the string used is a single slash, as in @option{-F /}.
4822 @var{string} may have more than one character, as in @option{-F ...}.
4823 Also, in the particular case when @var{string} is empty (@option{-F ""}),
4824 truncation flagging is disabled, and no truncation marks are appended in
4827 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4828 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
4829 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4831 @item -M @var{string}
4832 @itemx --macro-name=@var{string}
4834 Select another @var{string} to be used instead of @samp{xx}, while
4835 generating output suitable for @command{nroff}, @command{troff} or @TeX{}.
4838 @itemx --format=roff
4840 Choose an output format suitable for @command{nroff} or @command{troff}
4841 processing. Each output line will look like:
4844 .xx "@var{tail}" "@var{before}" "@var{keyword_and_after}" "@var{head}" "@var{ref}"
4847 so it will be possible to write a @samp{.xx} roff macro to take care of
4848 the output typesetting. This is the default output format when @sc{gnu}
4849 extensions are disabled. Option @option{-M} can be used to change
4850 @samp{xx} to another macro name.
4852 In this output format, each non-graphical character, like newline and
4853 tab, is merely changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to
4854 compress consecutive spaces. Each quote character: @kbd{"} is doubled
4855 so it will be correctly processed by @command{nroff} or @command{troff}.
4860 Choose an output format suitable for @TeX{} processing. Each output
4861 line will look like:
4864 \xx @{@var{tail}@}@{@var{before}@}@{@var{keyword}@}@{@var{after}@}@{@var{head}@}@{@var{ref}@}
4868 so it will be possible to write a @code{\xx} definition to take care of
4869 the output typesetting. Note that when references are not being
4870 produced, that is, neither option @option{-A} nor option @option{-r} is
4871 selected, the last parameter of each @code{\xx} call is inhibited.
4872 Option @option{-M} can be used to change @samp{xx} to another macro
4875 In this output format, some special characters, like @kbd{$}, @kbd{%},
4876 @kbd{&}, @kbd{#} and @kbd{_} are automatically protected with a
4877 backslash. Curly brackets @kbd{@{}, @kbd{@}} are protected with a
4878 backslash and a pair of dollar signs (to force mathematical mode). The
4879 backslash itself produces the sequence @code{\backslash@{@}}.
4880 Circumflex and tilde diacritical marks produce the sequence @code{^\@{ @}} and
4881 @code{~\@{ @}} respectively. Other diacriticized characters of the
4882 underlying character set produce an appropriate @TeX{} sequence as far
4883 as possible. The other non-graphical characters, like newline and tab,
4884 and all other characters which are not part of @acronym{ASCII}, are merely
4885 changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress
4886 consecutive spaces. Let me know how to improve this special character
4887 processing for @TeX{}.
4892 @node Compatibility in ptx
4893 @subsection The @sc{gnu} extensions to @command{ptx}
4895 This version of @command{ptx} contains a few features which do not exist in
4896 System V @command{ptx}. These extra features are suppressed by using the
4897 @option{-G} command line option, unless overridden by other command line
4898 options. Some @sc{gnu} extensions cannot be recovered by overriding, so the
4899 simple rule is to avoid @option{-G} if you care about @sc{gnu} extensions.
4900 Here are the differences between this program and System V @command{ptx}.
4905 This program can read many input files at once, it always writes the
4906 resulting concordance on standard output. On the other hand, System V
4907 @command{ptx} reads only one file and sends the result to standard output
4908 or, if a second @var{file} parameter is given on the command, to that
4911 Having output parameters not introduced by options is a dangerous
4912 practice which @sc{gnu} avoids as far as possible. So, for using @command{ptx}
4913 portably between @sc{gnu} and System V, you should always use it with a
4914 single input file, and always expect the result on standard output. You
4915 might also want to automatically configure in a @option{-G} option to
4916 @command{ptx} calls in products using @command{ptx}, if the configurator finds
4917 that the installed @command{ptx} accepts @option{-G}.
4920 The only options available in System V @command{ptx} are options @option{-b},
4921 @option{-f}, @option{-g}, @option{-i}, @option{-o}, @option{-r}, @option{-t} and
4922 @option{-w}. All other options are @sc{gnu} extensions and are not repeated in
4923 this enumeration. Moreover, some options have a slightly different
4924 meaning when @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, as explained below.
4927 By default, concordance output is not formatted for @command{troff} or
4928 @command{nroff}. It is rather formatted for a dumb terminal. @command{troff}
4929 or @command{nroff} output may still be selected through option @option{-O}.
4932 Unless @option{-R} option is used, the maximum reference width is
4933 subtracted from the total output line width. With @sc{gnu} extensions
4934 disabled, width of references is not taken into account in the output
4935 line width computations.
4938 All 256 bytes, even null bytes, are always read and processed from
4939 input file with no adverse effect, even if @sc{gnu} extensions are disabled.
4940 However, System V @command{ptx} does not accept 8-bit characters, a few
4941 control characters are rejected, and the tilde @kbd{~} is also rejected.
4944 Input line length is only limited by available memory, even if @sc{gnu}
4945 extensions are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} processes only
4946 the first 200 characters in each line.
4949 The break (non-word) characters default to be every character except all
4950 letters of the underlying character set, diacriticized or not. When @sc{gnu}
4951 extensions are disabled, the break characters default to space, tab and
4955 The program makes better use of output line width. If @sc{gnu} extensions
4956 are disabled, the program rather tries to imitate System V @command{ptx},
4957 but still, there are some slight disposition glitches this program does
4958 not completely reproduce.
4961 The user can specify both an Ignore file and an Only file. This is not
4962 allowed with System V @command{ptx}.
4967 @node Operating on fields within a line
4968 @chapter Operating on fields within a line
4971 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
4972 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
4973 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
4977 @node cut invocation
4978 @section @command{cut}: Print selected parts of lines
4981 @command{cut} writes to standard output selected parts of each line of each
4982 input file, or standard input if no files are given or for a file name of
4986 cut @var{option}@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4989 In the table which follows, the @var{byte-list}, @var{character-list},
4990 and @var{field-list} are one or more numbers or ranges (two numbers
4991 separated by a dash) separated by commas. Bytes, characters, and
4992 fields are numbered starting at 1. Incomplete ranges may be
4993 given: @option{-@var{m}} means @samp{1-@var{m}}; @samp{@var{n}-} means
4994 @samp{@var{n}} through end of line or last field. The list elements
4995 can be repeated, can overlap, and can be specified in any order; but
4996 the selected input is written in the same order that it is read, and
4997 is written exactly once.
4999 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common
5004 @item -b @var{byte-list}
5005 @itemx --bytes=@var{byte-list}
5008 Select for printing only the bytes in positions listed in
5009 @var{byte-list}. Tabs and backspaces are treated like any other
5010 character; they take up 1 byte. If an output delimiter is specified,
5011 (see the description of @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that
5012 string between ranges of selected bytes.
5014 @item -c @var{character-list}
5015 @itemx --characters=@var{character-list}
5017 @opindex --characters
5018 Select for printing only the characters in positions listed in
5019 @var{character-list}. The same as @option{-b} for now, but
5020 internationalization will change that. Tabs and backspaces are
5021 treated like any other character; they take up 1 character. If an
5022 output delimiter is specified, (see the description of
5023 @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that string between ranges
5026 @item -f @var{field-list}
5027 @itemx --fields=@var{field-list}
5030 Select for printing only the fields listed in @var{field-list}.
5031 Fields are separated by a TAB character by default. Also print any
5032 line that contains no delimiter character, unless the
5033 @option{--only-delimited} (@option{-s}) option is specified
5035 @item -d @var{input_delim_byte}
5036 @itemx --delimiter=@var{input_delim_byte}
5038 @opindex --delimiter
5039 With @option{-f}, use the first byte of @var{input_delim_byte} as
5040 the input fields separator (default is TAB).
5044 Do not split multi-byte characters (no-op for now).
5047 @itemx --only-delimited
5049 @opindex --only-delimited
5050 For @option{-f}, do not print lines that do not contain the field separator
5051 character. Normally, any line without a field separator is printed verbatim.
5053 @item --output-delimiter=@var{output_delim_string}
5054 @opindex --output-delimiter
5055 With @option{-f}, output fields are separated by @var{output_delim_string}.
5056 The default with @option{-f} is to use the input delimiter.
5057 When using @option{-b} or @option{-c} to select ranges of byte or
5058 character offsets (as opposed to ranges of fields),
5059 output @var{output_delim_string} between non-overlapping
5060 ranges of selected bytes.
5063 @opindex --complement
5064 This option is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
5065 Select for printing the complement of the bytes, characters or fields
5066 selected with the @option{-b}, @option{-c} or @option{-f} options.
5067 In other words, do @emph{not} print the bytes, characters or fields
5068 specified via those options. This option is useful when you have
5069 many fields and want to print all but a few of them.
5076 @node paste invocation
5077 @section @command{paste}: Merge lines of files
5080 @cindex merging files
5082 @command{paste} writes to standard output lines consisting of sequentially
5083 corresponding lines of each given file, separated by a TAB character.
5084 Standard input is used for a file name of @samp{-} or if no input files
5106 paste [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5109 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5117 Paste the lines of one file at a time rather than one line from each
5118 file. Using the above example data:
5121 $ paste -s num2 let3
5126 @item -d @var{delim-list}
5127 @itemx --delimiters=@var{delim-list}
5129 @opindex --delimiters
5130 Consecutively use the characters in @var{delim-list} instead of
5131 TAB to separate merged lines. When @var{delim-list} is
5132 exhausted, start again at its beginning. Using the above example data:
5135 $ paste -d '%_' num2 let3 num2
5146 @node join invocation
5147 @section @command{join}: Join lines on a common field
5150 @cindex common field, joining on
5152 @command{join} writes to standard output a line for each pair of input
5153 lines that have identical join fields. Synopsis:
5156 join [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5159 Either @var{file1} or @var{file2} (but not both) can be @samp{-},
5160 meaning standard input. @var{file1} and @var{file2} should be
5161 sorted on the join fields.
5164 Normally, the sort order is that of the
5165 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale. Unless
5166 the @option{-t} option is given, the sort comparison ignores blanks at
5167 the start of the join field, as in @code{sort -b}. If the
5168 @option{--ignore-case} option is given, the sort comparison ignores
5169 the case of characters in the join field, as in @code{sort -f}.
5171 The @command{sort} and @command{join} commands should use consistent
5172 locales and options if the output of @command{sort} is fed to
5173 @command{join}. You can use a command like @samp{sort -k 1b,1} to
5174 sort a file on its default join field, but if you select a non-default
5175 locale, join field, separator, or comparison options, then you should
5176 do so consistently between @command{join} and @command{sort}.
5178 If the input has no unpairable lines, a @acronym{GNU} extension is
5179 available; the sort order can be any order that considers two fields
5180 to be equal if and only if the sort comparison described above
5181 considers them to be equal. For example:
5198 If the @option{--check-order} option is given, unsorted inputs will
5199 cause a fatal error message. If the option @option{--nocheck-order}
5200 is given, unsorted inputs will never cause an error message. If
5201 neither of these options is given, wrongly sorted inputs are diagnosed
5202 only if an input file is found to contain unpairable lines. If an
5203 input file is diagnosed as being unsorted, the @command{join} command
5204 will exit with a nonzero status (and the output should not be used).
5206 Forcing @command{join} to process wrongly sorted input files
5207 containing unpairable lines by specifying @option{--nocheck-order} is
5208 not guaranteed to produce any particular output. The output will
5209 probably not correspond with whatever you hoped it would be.
5213 @item the join field is the first field in each line;
5214 @item fields in the input are separated by one or more blanks, with leading
5215 blanks on the line ignored;
5216 @item fields in the output are separated by a space;
5217 @item each output line consists of the join field, the remaining
5218 fields from @var{file1}, then the remaining fields from @var{file2}.
5221 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5225 @item -a @var{file-number}
5227 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number} (either
5228 @samp{1} or @samp{2}), in addition to the normal output.
5231 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
5233 @item --nocheck-order
5234 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order. This is the default.
5236 @item -e @var{string}
5238 Replace those output fields that are missing in the input with
5242 @itemx --ignore-case
5244 @opindex --ignore-case
5245 Ignore differences in case when comparing keys.
5246 With this option, the lines of the input files must be ordered in the same way.
5247 Use @samp{sort -f} to produce this ordering.
5249 @item -1 @var{field}
5251 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 1.
5253 @item -2 @var{field}
5255 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 2.
5257 @item -j @var{field}
5258 Equivalent to @option{-1 @var{field} -2 @var{field}}.
5260 @item -o @var{field-list}
5261 Construct each output line according to the format in @var{field-list}.
5262 Each element in @var{field-list} is either the single character @samp{0} or
5263 has the form @var{m.n} where the file number, @var{m}, is @samp{1} or
5264 @samp{2} and @var{n} is a positive field number.
5266 A field specification of @samp{0} denotes the join field.
5267 In most cases, the functionality of the @samp{0} field spec
5268 may be reproduced using the explicit @var{m.n} that corresponds
5269 to the join field. However, when printing unpairable lines
5270 (using either of the @option{-a} or @option{-v} options), there is no way
5271 to specify the join field using @var{m.n} in @var{field-list}
5272 if there are unpairable lines in both files.
5273 To give @command{join} that functionality, @acronym{POSIX} invented the @samp{0}
5274 field specification notation.
5276 The elements in @var{field-list}
5277 are separated by commas or blanks.
5278 Blank separators typically need to be quoted for the shell. For
5279 example, the commands @samp{join -o 1.2,2.2} and @samp{join -o '1.2
5280 2.2'} are equivalent.
5282 All output lines---including those printed because of any -a or -v
5283 option---are subject to the specified @var{field-list}.
5286 Use character @var{char} as the input and output field separator.
5287 Treat as significant each occurrence of @var{char} in the input file.
5288 Use @samp{sort -t @var{char}}, without the @option{-b} option of
5289 @samp{sort}, to produce this ordering.
5291 @item -v @var{file-number}
5292 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number}
5293 (either @samp{1} or @samp{2}), instead of the normal output.
5300 @node Operating on characters
5301 @chapter Operating on characters
5303 @cindex operating on characters
5305 This commands operate on individual characters.
5308 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
5309 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
5310 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
5315 @section @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
5322 tr [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{set1} [@var{set2}]
5325 @command{tr} copies standard input to standard output, performing
5326 one of the following operations:
5330 translate, and optionally squeeze repeated characters in the result,
5332 squeeze repeated characters,
5336 delete characters, then squeeze repeated characters from the result.
5339 The @var{set1} and (if given) @var{set2} arguments define ordered
5340 sets of characters, referred to below as @var{set1} and @var{set2}. These
5341 sets are the characters of the input that @command{tr} operates on.
5342 The @option{--complement} (@option{-c}, @option{-C}) option replaces
5344 complement (all of the characters that are not in @var{set1}).
5346 Currently @command{tr} fully supports only single-byte characters.
5347 Eventually it will support multibyte characters; when it does, the
5348 @option{-C} option will cause it to complement the set of characters,
5349 whereas @option{-c} will cause it to complement the set of values.
5350 This distinction will matter only when some values are not characters,
5351 and this is possible only in locales using multibyte encodings when
5352 the input contains encoding errors.
5354 The program accepts the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
5355 options. @xref{Common options}. Options must precede operands.
5360 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
5361 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
5362 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
5366 @node Character sets
5367 @subsection Specifying sets of characters
5369 @cindex specifying sets of characters
5371 The format of the @var{set1} and @var{set2} arguments resembles
5372 the format of regular expressions; however, they are not regular
5373 expressions, only lists of characters. Most characters simply
5374 represent themselves in these strings, but the strings can contain
5375 the shorthands listed below, for convenience. Some of them can be
5376 used only in @var{set1} or @var{set2}, as noted below.
5380 @item Backslash escapes
5381 @cindex backslash escapes
5383 The following backslash escape sequences are recognized:
5401 The character with the value given by @var{ooo}, which is 1 to 3
5407 While a backslash followed by a character not listed above is
5408 interpreted as that character, the backslash also effectively
5409 removes any special significance, so it is useful to escape
5410 @samp{[}, @samp{]}, @samp{*}, and @samp{-}.
5415 The notation @samp{@var{m}-@var{n}} expands to all of the characters
5416 from @var{m} through @var{n}, in ascending order. @var{m} should
5417 collate before @var{n}; if it doesn't, an error results. As an example,
5418 @samp{0-9} is the same as @samp{0123456789}.
5420 @sc{gnu} @command{tr} does not support the System V syntax that uses square
5421 brackets to enclose ranges. Translations specified in that format
5422 sometimes work as expected, since the brackets are often transliterated
5423 to themselves. However, they should be avoided because they sometimes
5424 behave unexpectedly. For example, @samp{tr -d '[0-9]'} deletes brackets
5427 Many historically common and even accepted uses of ranges are not
5428 portable. For example, on @acronym{EBCDIC} hosts using the @samp{A-Z}
5429 range will not do what most would expect because @samp{A} through @samp{Z}
5430 are not contiguous as they are in @acronym{ASCII}.
5431 If you can rely on a @acronym{POSIX} compliant version of @command{tr}, then
5432 the best way to work around this is to use character classes (see below).
5433 Otherwise, it is most portable (and most ugly) to enumerate the members
5436 @item Repeated characters
5437 @cindex repeated characters
5439 The notation @samp{[@var{c}*@var{n}]} in @var{set2} expands to @var{n}
5440 copies of character @var{c}. Thus, @samp{[y*6]} is the same as
5441 @samp{yyyyyy}. The notation @samp{[@var{c}*]} in @var{string2} expands
5442 to as many copies of @var{c} as are needed to make @var{set2} as long as
5443 @var{set1}. If @var{n} begins with @samp{0}, it is interpreted in
5444 octal, otherwise in decimal.
5446 @item Character classes
5447 @cindex character classes
5449 The notation @samp{[:@var{class}:]} expands to all of the characters in
5450 the (predefined) class @var{class}. The characters expand in no
5451 particular order, except for the @code{upper} and @code{lower} classes,
5452 which expand in ascending order. When the @option{--delete} (@option{-d})
5453 and @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) options are both given, any
5454 character class can be used in @var{set2}. Otherwise, only the
5455 character classes @code{lower} and @code{upper} are accepted in
5456 @var{set2}, and then only if the corresponding character class
5457 (@code{upper} and @code{lower}, respectively) is specified in the same
5458 relative position in @var{set1}. Doing this specifies case conversion.
5459 The class names are given below; an error results when an invalid class
5471 Horizontal whitespace.
5480 Printable characters, not including space.
5486 Printable characters, including space.
5489 Punctuation characters.
5492 Horizontal or vertical whitespace.
5501 @item Equivalence classes
5502 @cindex equivalence classes
5504 The syntax @samp{[=@var{c}=]} expands to all of the characters that are
5505 equivalent to @var{c}, in no particular order. Equivalence classes are
5506 a relatively recent invention intended to support non-English alphabets.
5507 But there seems to be no standard way to define them or determine their
5508 contents. Therefore, they are not fully implemented in @sc{gnu} @command{tr};
5509 each character's equivalence class consists only of that character,
5510 which is of no particular use.
5516 @subsection Translating
5518 @cindex translating characters
5520 @command{tr} performs translation when @var{set1} and @var{set2} are
5521 both given and the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option is not given.
5522 @command{tr} translates each character of its input that is in @var{set1}
5523 to the corresponding character in @var{set2}. Characters not in
5524 @var{set1} are passed through unchanged. When a character appears more
5525 than once in @var{set1} and the corresponding characters in @var{set2}
5526 are not all the same, only the final one is used. For example, these
5527 two commands are equivalent:
5534 A common use of @command{tr} is to convert lowercase characters to
5535 uppercase. This can be done in many ways. Here are three of them:
5538 tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
5540 tr '[:lower:]' '[:upper:]'
5544 But note that using ranges like @code{a-z} above is not portable.
5546 When @command{tr} is performing translation, @var{set1} and @var{set2}
5547 typically have the same length. If @var{set1} is shorter than
5548 @var{set2}, the extra characters at the end of @var{set2} are ignored.
5550 On the other hand, making @var{set1} longer than @var{set2} is not
5551 portable; @acronym{POSIX} says that the result is undefined. In this situation,
5552 BSD @command{tr} pads @var{set2} to the length of @var{set1} by repeating
5553 the last character of @var{set2} as many times as necessary. System V
5554 @command{tr} truncates @var{set1} to the length of @var{set2}.
5556 By default, @sc{gnu} @command{tr} handles this case like BSD @command{tr}.
5557 When the @option{--truncate-set1} (@option{-t}) option is given,
5558 @sc{gnu} @command{tr} handles this case like the System V @command{tr}
5559 instead. This option is ignored for operations other than translation.
5561 Acting like System V @command{tr} in this case breaks the relatively common
5565 tr -cs A-Za-z0-9 '\012'
5569 because it converts only zero bytes (the first element in the
5570 complement of @var{set1}), rather than all non-alphanumerics, to
5574 By the way, the above idiom is not portable because it uses ranges, and
5575 it assumes that the octal code for newline is 012.
5576 Assuming a @acronym{POSIX} compliant @command{tr}, here is a better way to write it:
5579 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
5584 @subsection Squeezing repeats and deleting
5586 @cindex squeezing repeat characters
5587 @cindex deleting characters
5589 When given just the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option, @command{tr}
5590 removes any input characters that are in @var{set1}.
5592 When given just the @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) option,
5593 @command{tr} replaces each input sequence of a repeated character that
5594 is in @var{set1} with a single occurrence of that character.
5596 When given both @option{--delete} and @option{--squeeze-repeats}, @command{tr}
5597 first performs any deletions using @var{set1}, then squeezes repeats
5598 from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
5600 The @option{--squeeze-repeats} option may also be used when translating,
5601 in which case @command{tr} first performs translation, then squeezes
5602 repeats from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
5604 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options:
5609 Remove all zero bytes:
5616 Put all words on lines by themselves. This converts all
5617 non-alphanumeric characters to newlines, then squeezes each string
5618 of repeated newlines into a single newline:
5621 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
5625 Convert each sequence of repeated newlines to a single newline:
5632 Find doubled occurrences of words in a document.
5633 @c Separate the following two "the"s, so typo checkers don't complain.
5634 For example, people often write ``the @w{}the'' with the repeated words
5635 separated by a newline. The Bourne shell script below works first
5636 by converting each sequence of punctuation and blank characters to a
5637 single newline. That puts each ``word'' on a line by itself.
5638 Next it maps all uppercase characters to lower case, and finally it
5639 runs @command{uniq} with the @option{-d} option to print out only the words
5645 | tr -s '[:punct:][:blank:]' '[\n*]' \
5646 | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' \
5651 Deleting a small set of characters is usually straightforward. For example,
5652 to remove all @samp{a}s, @samp{x}s, and @samp{M}s you would do this:
5658 However, when @samp{-} is one of those characters, it can be tricky because
5659 @samp{-} has special meanings. Performing the same task as above but also
5660 removing all @samp{-} characters, we might try @code{tr -d -axM}, but
5661 that would fail because @command{tr} would try to interpret @option{-a} as
5662 a command-line option. Alternatively, we could try putting the hyphen
5663 inside the string, @code{tr -d a-xM}, but that wouldn't work either because
5664 it would make @command{tr} interpret @code{a-x} as the range of characters
5665 @samp{a}@dots{}@samp{x} rather than the three.
5666 One way to solve the problem is to put the hyphen at the end of the list
5673 Or you can use @samp{--} to terminate option processing:
5679 More generally, use the character class notation @code{[=c=]}
5680 with @samp{-} (or any other character) in place of the @samp{c}:
5686 Note how single quotes are used in the above example to protect the
5687 square brackets from interpretation by a shell.
5692 @node expand invocation
5693 @section @command{expand}: Convert tabs to spaces
5696 @cindex tabs to spaces, converting
5697 @cindex converting tabs to spaces
5699 @command{expand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or standard
5700 input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to standard
5701 output, with tab characters converted to the appropriate number of
5705 expand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5708 By default, @command{expand} converts all tabs to spaces. It preserves
5709 backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column count for
5710 tab calculations. The default action is equivalent to @option{-t 8} (set
5711 tabs every 8 columns).
5713 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5717 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5718 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5721 @cindex tab stops, setting
5722 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} spaces apart
5723 (default is 8). Otherwise, set the tabs at columns @var{tab1},
5724 @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and replace any tabs beyond the
5725 last tab stop given with single spaces. Tab stops can be separated by
5726 blanks as well as by commas.
5728 For compatibility, GNU @command{expand} also accepts the obsolete
5729 option syntax, @option{-@var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}}. New scripts
5730 should use @option{-t @var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}} instead.
5736 @cindex initial tabs, converting
5737 Only convert initial tabs (those that precede all non-space or non-tab
5738 characters) on each line to spaces.
5745 @node unexpand invocation
5746 @section @command{unexpand}: Convert spaces to tabs
5750 @command{unexpand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or
5751 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to
5752 standard output, converting blanks at the beginning of each line into
5753 as many tab characters as needed. In the default @acronym{POSIX}
5754 locale, a @dfn{blank} is a space or a tab; other locales may specify
5755 additional blank characters. Synopsis:
5758 unexpand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5761 By default, @command{unexpand} converts only initial blanks (those
5762 that precede all non-blank characters) on each line. It
5763 preserves backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column
5764 count for tab calculations. By default, tabs are set at every 8th
5767 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5771 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5772 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5775 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} columns apart
5776 instead of the default 8. Otherwise, set the tabs at columns
5777 @var{tab1}, @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and leave blanks
5778 beyond the tab stops given unchanged. Tab stops can be separated by
5779 blanks as well as by commas. This option implies the @option{-a} option.
5781 For compatibility, GNU @command{unexpand} supports the obsolete option syntax,
5782 @option{-@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}}, where tab stops must be
5783 separated by commas. (Unlike @option{-t}, this obsolete option does
5784 not imply @option{-a}.) New scripts should use @option{--first-only -t
5785 @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}} instead.
5791 Also convert all sequences of two or more blanks just before a tab stop,
5792 even if they occur after non-blank characters in a line.
5799 @node Directory listing
5800 @chapter Directory listing
5802 This chapter describes the @command{ls} command and its variants @command{dir}
5803 and @command{vdir}, which list information about files.
5806 * ls invocation:: List directory contents.
5807 * dir invocation:: Briefly ls.
5808 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely ls.
5809 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for ls, etc.
5814 @section @command{ls}: List directory contents
5817 @cindex directory listing
5819 The @command{ls} program lists information about files (of any type,
5820 including directories). Options and file arguments can be intermixed
5821 arbitrarily, as usual.
5823 For non-option command-line arguments that are directories, by default
5824 @command{ls} lists the contents of directories, not recursively, and
5825 omitting files with names beginning with @samp{.}. For other non-option
5826 arguments, by default @command{ls} lists just the file name. If no
5827 non-option argument is specified, @command{ls} operates on the current
5828 directory, acting as if it had been invoked with a single argument of @samp{.}.
5831 By default, the output is sorted alphabetically, according to the locale
5832 settings in effect.@footnote{If you use a non-@acronym{POSIX}
5833 locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL} to @samp{en_US}), then @command{ls} may
5834 produce output that is sorted differently than you're accustomed to.
5835 In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable to @samp{C}.}
5836 If standard output is
5837 a terminal, the output is in columns (sorted vertically) and control
5838 characters are output as question marks; otherwise, the output is listed
5839 one per line and control characters are output as-is.
5841 Because @command{ls} is such a fundamental program, it has accumulated many
5842 options over the years. They are described in the subsections below;
5843 within each section, options are listed alphabetically (ignoring case).
5844 The division of options into the subsections is not absolute, since some
5845 options affect more than one aspect of @command{ls}'s operation.
5847 @cindex exit status of @command{ls}
5852 1 minor problems (e.g., a subdirectory was not found)
5853 2 serious trouble (e.g., memory exhausted)
5856 Also see @ref{Common options}.
5859 * Which files are listed::
5860 * What information is listed::
5861 * Sorting the output::
5862 * More details about version sort::
5863 * General output formatting::
5864 * Formatting file timestamps::
5865 * Formatting the file names::
5869 @node Which files are listed
5870 @subsection Which files are listed
5872 These options determine which files @command{ls} lists information for.
5873 By default, @command{ls} lists files and the contents of any
5874 directories on the command line, except that in directories it ignores
5875 files whose names start with @samp{.}.
5883 In directories, do not ignore file names that start with @samp{.}.
5888 @opindex --almost-all
5889 In directories, do not ignore all file names that start with @samp{.};
5890 ignore only @file{.} and @file{..}. The @option{--all} (@option{-a})
5891 option overrides this option.
5894 @itemx --ignore-backups
5896 @opindex --ignore-backups
5897 @cindex backup files, ignoring
5898 In directories, ignore files that end with @samp{~}. This option is
5899 equivalent to @samp{--ignore='*~' --ignore='.*~'}.
5904 @opindex --directory
5905 List just the names of directories, as with other types of files, rather
5906 than listing their contents.
5907 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -F.
5908 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
5909 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
5910 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
5911 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
5914 @itemx --dereference-command-line
5916 @opindex --dereference-command-line
5917 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
5918 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, show information
5919 for the file the link references rather than for the link itself.
5921 @itemx --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
5922 @opindex --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
5923 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
5924 Do not dereference symbolic links, with one exception:
5925 if a command line argument specifies a symbolic link that refers to
5926 a directory, show information for that directory rather than for the
5928 This is the default behavior when no other dereferencing-related
5929 option has been specified (@option{--classify} (@option{-F}),
5930 @option{--directory} (@option{-d}),
5932 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
5933 @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H})).
5935 @item --group-directories-first
5936 @opindex --group-directories-first
5937 Group all the directories before the files and then sort the
5938 directories and the files separately using the selected sort key
5939 (see --sort option).
5940 That is, this option specifies a primary sort key,
5941 and the --sort option specifies a secondary key.
5942 However, any use of @option{--sort=none}
5943 (@option{-U}) disables this option altogether.
5945 @item --hide=PATTERN
5946 @opindex --hide=@var{pattern}
5947 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
5948 @var{pattern}, unless the @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or
5949 @option{--almost-all} (@option{-A}) is also given. This
5950 option acts like @option{--ignore=@var{pattern}} except that it has no
5951 effect if @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or @option{--almost-all}
5952 (@option{-A}) is also given.
5954 This option can be useful in shell aliases. For example, if
5955 @command{lx} is an alias for @samp{ls --hide='*~'} and @command{ly} is
5956 an alias for @samp{ls --ignore='*~'}, then the command @samp{lx -A}
5957 lists the file @file{README~} even though @samp{ly -A} would not.
5959 @item -I @var{pattern}
5960 @itemx --ignore=@var{pattern}
5962 @opindex --ignore=@var{pattern}
5963 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
5964 (not regular expression) @var{pattern}. As
5965 in the shell, an initial @samp{.} in a file name does not match a
5966 wildcard at the start of @var{pattern}. Sometimes it is useful
5967 to give this option several times. For example,
5970 $ ls --ignore='.??*' --ignore='.[^.]' --ignore='#*'
5973 The first option ignores names of length 3 or more that start with @samp{.},
5974 the second ignores all two-character names that start with @samp{.}
5975 except @samp{..}, and the third ignores names that start with @samp{#}.
5978 @itemx --dereference
5980 @opindex --dereference
5981 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
5982 When showing file information for a symbolic link, show information
5983 for the file the link references rather than the link itself.
5984 However, even with this option, @command{ls} still prints the name
5985 of the link itself, not the name of the file that the link points to.
5990 @opindex --recursive
5991 @cindex recursive directory listing
5992 @cindex directory listing, recursive
5993 List the contents of all directories recursively.
5998 @node What information is listed
5999 @subsection What information is listed
6001 These options affect the information that @command{ls} displays. By
6002 default, only file names are shown.
6008 @cindex hurd, author, printing
6009 List each file's author when producing long format directory listings.
6010 In GNU/Hurd, file authors can differ from their owners, but in other
6011 operating systems the two are the same.
6017 @cindex dired Emacs mode support
6018 With the long listing (@option{-l}) format, print an additional line after
6022 //DIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @var{beg2} @var{end2} @dots{}
6026 The @var{begN} and @var{endN} are unsigned integers that record the
6027 byte position of the beginning and end of each file name in the output.
6028 This makes it easy for Emacs to find the names, even when they contain
6029 unusual characters such as space or newline, without fancy searching.
6031 If directories are being listed recursively (@option{-R}), output a similar
6032 line with offsets for each subdirectory name:
6035 //SUBDIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @dots{}
6038 Finally, output a line of the form:
6041 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=@var{word}
6045 where @var{word} is the quoting style (@pxref{Formatting the file names}).
6047 Here is an actual example:
6050 $ mkdir -p a/sub/deeper a/sub2
6052 $ touch a/sub/deeper/file
6053 $ ls -gloRF --dired a
6056 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f1
6057 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f2
6058 drwxr-xr-x 3 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub/
6059 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub2/
6063 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 deeper/
6067 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 file
6071 //DIRED// 48 50 84 86 120 123 158 162 217 223 282 286
6072 //SUBDIRED// 2 3 167 172 228 240 290 296
6073 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=literal
6076 Note that the pairs of offsets on the @samp{//DIRED//} line above delimit
6077 these names: @file{f1}, @file{f2}, @file{sub}, @file{sub2}, @file{deeper},
6079 The offsets on the @samp{//SUBDIRED//} line delimit the following
6080 directory names: @file{a}, @file{a/sub}, @file{a/sub/deeper}, @file{a/sub2}.
6082 Here is an example of how to extract the fifth entry name, @samp{deeper},
6083 corresponding to the pair of offsets, 222 and 228:
6086 $ ls -gloRF --dired a > out
6087 $ dd bs=1 skip=222 count=6 < out 2>/dev/null; echo
6091 Note that although the listing above includes a trailing slash
6092 for the @samp{deeper} entry, the offsets select the name without
6093 the trailing slash. However, if you invoke @command{ls} with @option{--dired}
6094 along with an option like @option{--escape} (aka @option{-b}) and operate
6095 on a file whose name contains special characters, notice that the backslash
6100 $ ls -blog --dired 'a b'
6101 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:28 a\ b
6103 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=escape
6106 If you use a quoting style that adds quote marks
6107 (e.g., @option{--quoting-style=c}), then the offsets include the quote marks.
6108 So beware that the user may select the quoting style via the environment
6109 variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}. Hence, applications using @option{--dired}
6110 should either specify an explicit @option{--quoting-style=literal} option
6111 (aka @option{-N} or @option{--literal}) on the command line, or else be
6112 prepared to parse the escaped names.
6115 @opindex --full-time
6116 Produce long format directory listings, and list times in full. It is
6117 equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with
6118 @option{--time-style=full-iso} (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}).
6122 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display owner information.
6128 Inhibit display of group information in a long format directory listing.
6129 (This is the default in some non-@sc{gnu} versions of @command{ls}, so we
6130 provide this option for compatibility.)
6138 @cindex inode number, printing
6139 Print the inode number (also called the file serial number and index
6140 number) of each file to the left of the file name. (This number
6141 uniquely identifies each file within a particular file system.)
6144 @itemx --format=long
6145 @itemx --format=verbose
6148 @opindex long ls @r{format}
6149 @opindex verbose ls @r{format}
6150 In addition to the name of each file, print the file type, file mode bits,
6151 number of hard links, owner name, group name, size, and
6152 timestamp (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}), normally
6153 the modification time. Print question marks for information that
6154 cannot be determined.
6156 Normally the size is printed as a byte count without punctuation, but
6157 this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}). For example, @option{-h}
6158 prints an abbreviated, human-readable count, and
6159 @samp{--block-size="'1"} prints a byte count with the thousands
6160 separator of the current locale.
6162 For each directory that is listed, preface the files with a line
6163 @samp{total @var{blocks}}, where @var{blocks} is the total disk allocation
6164 for all files in that directory. The block size currently defaults to 1024
6165 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6166 The @var{blocks} computed counts each hard link separately;
6167 this is arguably a deficiency.
6169 The file type is one of the following characters:
6171 @c The commented-out entries are ones we're not sure about.
6179 character special file
6181 high performance (``contiguous data'') file
6185 door (Solaris 2.5 and up)
6187 @c semaphore, if this is a distinct file type
6191 @c multiplexed file (7th edition Unix; obsolete)
6193 off-line (``migrated'') file (Cray DMF)
6195 network special file (HP-UX)
6199 port (Solaris 10 and up)
6201 @c message queue, if this is a distinct file type
6205 @c shared memory object, if this is a distinct file type
6207 @c typed memory object, if this is a distinct file type
6209 @c whiteout (4.4BSD; not implemented)
6211 some other file type
6214 @cindex permissions, output by @command{ls}
6215 The file mode bits listed are similar to symbolic mode specifications
6216 (@pxref{Symbolic Modes}). But @command{ls} combines multiple bits into the
6217 third character of each set of permissions as follows:
6221 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit and the corresponding executable bit
6225 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit is set but the corresponding
6226 executable bit is not set.
6229 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit, and the
6230 other-executable bit, are both set. The restricted deletion flag is
6231 another name for the sticky bit. @xref{Mode Structure}.
6234 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit is set but the
6235 other-executable bit is not set.
6238 If the executable bit is set and none of the above apply.
6244 Following the file mode bits is a single character that specifies
6245 whether an alternate access method such as an access control list
6246 applies to the file. When the character following the file mode bits is a
6247 space, there is no alternate access method. When it is a printing
6248 character, then there is such a method.
6250 For a file with an extended access control list, a @samp{+} character is
6251 listed. Basic access control lists are equivalent to the permissions
6252 listed, and are not considered an alternate access method.
6255 @itemx --numeric-uid-gid
6257 @opindex --numeric-uid-gid
6258 @cindex numeric uid and gid
6259 @cindex numeric user and group IDs
6260 Produce long format directory listings, but
6261 display numeric user and group IDs instead of the owner and group names.
6265 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display group information.
6266 It is equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with @option{--no-group} .
6272 @cindex disk allocation
6273 @cindex size of files, reporting
6274 Print the disk allocation of each file to the left of the file name.
6275 This is the amount of disk space used by the file, which is usually a
6276 bit more than the file's size, but it can be less if the file has holes.
6278 Normally the disk allocation is printed in units of
6279 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6281 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
6282 For files that are NFS-mounted from an HP-UX system to a BSD system,
6283 this option reports sizes that are half the correct values. On HP-UX
6284 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for files
6285 that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw in HP-UX;
6286 it also affects the HP-UX @command{ls} program.
6293 @node Sorting the output
6294 @subsection Sorting the output
6296 @cindex sorting @command{ls} output
6297 These options change the order in which @command{ls} sorts the information
6298 it outputs. By default, sorting is done by character code
6299 (e.g., @acronym{ASCII} order).
6305 @itemx --time=status
6308 @opindex ctime@r{, printing or sorting by}
6309 @opindex status time@r{, printing or sorting by}
6310 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6311 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{-l}, @option{-o}) is being used,
6312 print the status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) instead of
6313 the modification time.
6314 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
6315 or when not using a long listing format,
6316 sort according to the status change time.
6320 @cindex unsorted directory listing
6321 @cindex directory order, listing by
6322 Primarily, like @option{-U}---do not sort; list the files in whatever
6323 order they are stored in the directory. But also enable @option{-a} (list
6324 all files) and disable @option{-l}, @option{--color}, and @option{-s} (if they
6325 were specified before the @option{-f}).
6331 @cindex reverse sorting
6332 Reverse whatever the sorting method is---e.g., list files in reverse
6333 alphabetical order, youngest first, smallest first, or whatever.
6339 @opindex size of files@r{, sorting files by}
6340 Sort by file size, largest first.
6346 @opindex modification time@r{, sorting files by}
6347 Sort by modification time (the @samp{mtime} in the inode), newest first.
6351 @itemx --time=access
6355 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6356 @opindex atime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6357 @opindex access time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6358 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{--format=long}) is being used,
6359 print the last access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode).
6360 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
6361 or when not using a long listing format, sort according to the access time.
6367 @opindex none@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
6368 Do not sort; list the files in whatever order they are
6369 stored in the directory. (Do not do any of the other unrelated things
6370 that @option{-f} does.) This is especially useful when listing very large
6371 directories, since not doing any sorting can be noticeably faster.
6374 @itemx --sort=version
6377 @opindex version@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
6378 Sort by version name and number, lowest first. It behaves like a default
6379 sort, except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
6380 as an index/version number. (@xref{More details about version sort}.)
6383 @itemx --sort=extension
6386 @opindex extension@r{, sorting files by}
6387 Sort directory contents alphabetically by file extension (characters
6388 after the last @samp{.}); files with no extension are sorted first.
6393 @node More details about version sort
6394 @subsection More details about version sort
6396 The version sort takes into account the fact that file names frequently include
6397 indices or version numbers. Standard sorting functions usually do not produce
6398 the ordering that people expect because comparisons are made on a
6399 character-by-character basis. The version
6400 sort addresses this problem, and is especially useful when browsing
6401 directories that contain many files with indices/version numbers in their
6406 foo.zml-1.gz foo.zml-1.gz
6407 foo.zml-100.gz foo.zml-2.gz
6408 foo.zml-12.gz foo.zml-6.gz
6409 foo.zml-13.gz foo.zml-12.gz
6410 foo.zml-2.gz foo.zml-13.gz
6411 foo.zml-25.gz foo.zml-25.gz
6412 foo.zml-6.gz foo.zml-100.gz
6415 Note also that numeric parts with leading zeros are considered as
6420 abc-1.007.tgz abc-1.007.tgz
6421 abc-1.012b.tgz abc-1.01a.tgz
6422 abc-1.01a.tgz abc-1.012b.tgz
6425 This functionality is implemented using the @code{strverscmp} function.
6426 @xref{String/Array Comparison, , , libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
6427 One result of that implementation decision is that @code{ls -v} does not
6428 use the locale category, @env{LC_COLLATE}. As a result, non-numeric prefixes
6429 are sorted as if @env{LC_COLLATE} were set to @code{C}.
6431 @node General output formatting
6432 @subsection General output formatting
6434 These options affect the appearance of the overall output.
6439 @itemx --format=single-column
6442 @opindex single-column @r{output of files}
6443 List one file per line. This is the default for @command{ls} when standard
6444 output is not a terminal.
6447 @itemx --format=vertical
6450 @opindex vertical @r{sorted files in columns}
6451 List files in columns, sorted vertically. This is the default for
6452 @command{ls} if standard output is a terminal. It is always the default
6453 for the @command{dir} program.
6454 @sc{gnu} @command{ls} uses variable width columns to display as many files as
6455 possible in the fewest lines.
6457 @item --color [=@var{when}]
6459 @cindex color, distinguishing file types with
6460 Specify whether to use color for distinguishing file types. @var{when}
6461 may be omitted, or one of:
6464 @vindex none @r{color option}
6465 - Do not use color at all. This is the default.
6467 @vindex auto @r{color option}
6468 @cindex terminal, using color iff
6469 - Only use color if standard output is a terminal.
6471 @vindex always @r{color option}
6474 Specifying @option{--color} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
6475 @option{--color=always}.
6476 Piping a colorized listing through a pager like @command{more} or
6477 @command{less} usually produces unreadable results. However, using
6478 @code{more -f} does seem to work.
6482 @itemx --indicator-style=classify
6485 @opindex --indicator-style
6486 @cindex file type and executables, marking
6487 @cindex executables and file type, marking
6488 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. Also,
6489 for regular files that are executable, append @samp{*}. The file type
6490 indicators are @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links,
6491 @samp{|} for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, @samp{>} for doors,
6492 and nothing for regular files.
6493 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -d.
6494 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
6495 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
6496 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6497 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
6500 @itemx --indicator-style=file-type
6501 @opindex --file-type
6502 @opindex --indicator-style
6503 @cindex file type, marking
6504 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. This is
6505 like @option{-F}, except that executables are not marked.
6507 @item --indicator-style=@var{word}
6508 @opindex --indicator-style
6509 Append a character indicator with style @var{word} to entry names,
6514 Do not append any character indicator; this is the default.
6516 Append @samp{/} for directories. This is the same as the @option{-p}
6519 Append @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links, @samp{|}
6520 for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, and nothing for regular files. This is
6521 the same as the @option{--file-type} option.
6523 Append @samp{*} for executable regular files, otherwise behave as for
6524 @samp{file-type}. This is the same as the @option{-F} or
6525 @option{--classify} option.
6530 Print file sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block
6531 size (@pxref{Block size}).
6532 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
6535 @itemx --format=commas
6538 @opindex commas@r{, outputting between files}
6539 List files horizontally, with as many as will fit on each line,
6540 separated by @samp{, } (a comma and a space).
6543 @itemx --indicator-style=slash
6545 @opindex --indicator-style
6546 @cindex file type, marking
6547 Append a @samp{/} to directory names.
6550 @itemx --format=across
6551 @itemx --format=horizontal
6554 @opindex across@r{, listing files}
6555 @opindex horizontal@r{, listing files}
6556 List the files in columns, sorted horizontally.
6559 @itemx --tabsize=@var{cols}
6562 Assume that each tab stop is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is 8.
6563 @command{ls} uses tabs where possible in the output, for efficiency. If
6564 @var{cols} is zero, do not use tabs at all.
6566 @c FIXME: remove in 2009, if Apple Terminal has been fixed for long enough.
6567 Some terminal emulators (at least Apple Terminal 1.5 (133) from Mac OS X 10.4.8)
6568 do not properly align columns to the right of a TAB following a
6569 non-@acronym{ASCII} byte. If you use such a terminal emulator, use the
6570 @option{-T0} option or put @code{TABSIZE=0} in your environment to tell
6571 @command{ls} to align using spaces, not tabs.
6574 @itemx --width=@var{cols}
6578 Assume the screen is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is taken
6579 from the terminal settings if possible; otherwise the environment
6580 variable @env{COLUMNS} is used if it is set; otherwise the default
6586 @node Formatting file timestamps
6587 @subsection Formatting file timestamps
6589 By default, file timestamps are listed in abbreviated form. Most
6590 locales use a timestamp like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. However, the
6591 default @acronym{POSIX} locale uses a date like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002}
6592 for non-recent timestamps, and a date-without-year and time like
6593 @samp{Mar 30 23:45} for recent timestamps.
6595 A timestamp is considered to be @dfn{recent} if it is less than six
6596 months old, and is not dated in the future. If a timestamp dated
6597 today is not listed in recent form, the timestamp is in the future,
6598 which means you probably have clock skew problems which may break
6599 programs like @command{make} that rely on file timestamps.
6602 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
6603 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
6604 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
6605 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
6607 The following option changes how file timestamps are printed.
6610 @item --time-style=@var{style}
6611 @opindex --time-style
6613 List timestamps in style @var{style}. The @var{style} should
6614 be one of the following:
6619 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
6620 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
6621 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
6622 @command{ls} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
6623 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
6624 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
6626 If @var{format} contains two format strings separated by a newline,
6627 the former is used for non-recent files and the latter for recent
6628 files; if you want output columns to line up, you may need to insert
6629 spaces in one of the two formats.
6632 List timestamps in full using @acronym{ISO} 8601 date, time, and time zone
6633 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
6634 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
6635 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
6637 This is useful because the time output includes all the information that
6638 is available from the operating system. For example, this can help
6639 explain @command{make}'s behavior, since @acronym{GNU} @command{make}
6640 uses the full timestamp to determine whether a file is out of date.
6643 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
6644 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
6645 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
6646 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
6649 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 dates for non-recent timestamps (e.g.,
6650 @samp{2002-03-30@ }), and @acronym{ISO} 8601 month, day, hour, and
6651 minute for recent timestamps (e.g., @samp{03-30 23:45}). These
6652 timestamps are uglier than @samp{long-iso} timestamps, but they carry
6653 nearly the same information in a smaller space and their brevity helps
6654 @command{ls} output fit within traditional 80-column output lines.
6655 The following two @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
6660 ls -l --time-style="+%Y-%m-%d $newline%m-%d %H:%M"
6661 ls -l --time-style="iso"
6666 List timestamps in a locale-dependent form. For example, a Finnish
6667 locale might list non-recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30@ @ 2002}
6668 and recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30 23:45}. Locale-dependent
6669 timestamps typically consume more space than @samp{iso} timestamps and
6670 are harder for programs to parse because locale conventions vary so
6671 widely, but they are easier for many people to read.
6673 The @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the timestamp format. The
6674 default @acronym{POSIX} locale uses timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@
6675 @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45}; in this locale, the following two
6676 @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
6681 ls -l --time-style="+%b %e %Y$newline%b %e %H:%M"
6682 ls -l --time-style="locale"
6685 Other locales behave differently. For example, in a German locale,
6686 @option{--time-style="locale"} might be equivalent to
6687 @option{--time-style="+%e. %b %Y $newline%e. %b %H:%M"}
6688 and might generate timestamps like @samp{30. M@"ar 2002@ } and
6689 @samp{30. M@"ar 23:45}.
6691 @item posix-@var{style}
6693 List @acronym{POSIX}-locale timestamps if the @env{LC_TIME} locale
6694 category is @acronym{POSIX}, @var{style} timestamps otherwise. For
6695 example, the @samp{posix-long-iso} style lists
6696 timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45} when in
6697 the @acronym{POSIX} locale, and like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45} otherwise.
6702 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
6703 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
6704 the default style is @samp{locale}. @acronym{GNU} Emacs 21.3 and
6705 later use the @option{--dired} option and therefore can parse any date
6706 format, but if you are using Emacs 21.1 or 21.2 and specify a
6707 non-@acronym{POSIX} locale you may need to set
6708 @samp{TIME_STYLE="posix-long-iso"}.
6710 To avoid certain denial-of-service attacks, timestamps that would be
6711 longer than 1000 bytes may be treated as errors.
6714 @node Formatting the file names
6715 @subsection Formatting the file names
6717 These options change how file names themselves are printed.
6723 @itemx --quoting-style=escape
6726 @opindex --quoting-style
6727 @cindex backslash sequences for file names
6728 Quote nongraphic characters in file names using alphabetic and octal
6729 backslash sequences like those used in C.
6733 @itemx --quoting-style=literal
6736 @opindex --quoting-style
6737 Do not quote file names. However, with @command{ls} nongraphic
6738 characters are still printed as question marks if the output is a
6739 terminal and you do not specify the @option{--show-control-chars}
6743 @itemx --hide-control-chars
6745 @opindex --hide-control-chars
6746 Print question marks instead of nongraphic characters in file names.
6747 This is the default if the output is a terminal and the program is
6752 @itemx --quoting-style=c
6754 @opindex --quote-name
6755 @opindex --quoting-style
6756 Enclose file names in double quotes and quote nongraphic characters as
6759 @item --quoting-style=@var{word}
6760 @opindex --quoting-style
6761 @cindex quoting style
6762 Use style @var{word} to quote file names and other strings that may
6763 contain arbitrary characters. The @var{word} should
6764 be one of the following:
6768 Output strings as-is; this is the same as the @option{-N} or
6769 @option{--literal} option.
6771 Quote strings for the shell if they contain shell metacharacters or would
6772 cause ambiguous output.
6773 The quoting is suitable for @acronym{POSIX}-compatible shells like
6774 @command{bash}, but it does not always work for incompatible shells
6777 Quote strings for the shell, even if they would normally not require quoting.
6779 Quote strings as for C character string literals, including the
6780 surrounding double-quote characters; this is the same as the
6781 @option{-Q} or @option{--quote-name} option.
6783 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except omit the
6784 surrounding double-quote
6785 characters; this is the same as the @option{-b} or @option{--escape} option.
6787 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
6788 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the
6791 @c Use @t instead of @samp to avoid duplicate quoting in some output styles.
6792 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
6793 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the locale, and quote
6794 @t{`like this'} instead of @t{"like
6795 this"} in the default C locale. This looks nicer on many displays.
6798 You can specify the default value of the @option{--quoting-style} option
6799 with the environment variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}. If that environment
6800 variable is not set, the default value is @samp{literal}, but this
6801 default may change to @samp{shell} in a future version of this package.
6803 @item --show-control-chars
6804 @opindex --show-control-chars
6805 Print nongraphic characters as-is in file names.
6806 This is the default unless the output is a terminal and the program is
6812 @node dir invocation
6813 @section @command{dir}: Briefly list directory contents
6816 @cindex directory listing, brief
6818 @command{dir} is equivalent to @code{ls -C
6819 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in columns, sorted vertically,
6820 and special characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
6822 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
6825 @node vdir invocation
6826 @section @command{vdir}: Verbosely list directory contents
6829 @cindex directory listing, verbose
6831 @command{vdir} is equivalent to @code{ls -l
6832 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in long format and special
6833 characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
6835 @node dircolors invocation
6836 @section @command{dircolors}: Color setup for @command{ls}
6840 @cindex setup for color
6842 @command{dircolors} outputs a sequence of shell commands to set up the
6843 terminal for color output from @command{ls} (and @command{dir}, etc.).
6847 eval "`dircolors [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]`"
6850 If @var{file} is specified, @command{dircolors} reads it to determine which
6851 colors to use for which file types and extensions. Otherwise, a
6852 precompiled database is used. For details on the format of these files,
6853 run @samp{dircolors --print-database}.
6856 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
6857 The output is a shell command to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment
6858 variable. You can specify the shell syntax to use on the command line,
6859 or @command{dircolors} will guess it from the value of the @env{SHELL}
6860 environment variable.
6862 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6867 @itemx --bourne-shell
6870 @opindex --bourne-shell
6871 @cindex Bourne shell syntax for color setup
6872 @cindex @command{sh} syntax for color setup
6873 Output Bourne shell commands. This is the default if the @env{SHELL}
6874 environment variable is set and does not end with @samp{csh} or
6883 @cindex C shell syntax for color setup
6884 @cindex @command{csh} syntax for color setup
6885 Output C shell commands. This is the default if @code{SHELL} ends with
6886 @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}.
6889 @itemx --print-database
6891 @opindex --print-database
6892 @cindex color database, printing
6893 @cindex database for color setup, printing
6894 @cindex printing color database
6895 Print the (compiled-in) default color configuration database. This
6896 output is itself a valid configuration file, and is fairly descriptive
6897 of the possibilities.
6904 @node Basic operations
6905 @chapter Basic operations
6907 @cindex manipulating files
6909 This chapter describes the commands for basic file manipulation:
6910 copying, moving (renaming), and deleting (removing).
6913 * cp invocation:: Copy files.
6914 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file.
6915 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes.
6916 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files.
6917 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories.
6918 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely.
6923 @section @command{cp}: Copy files and directories
6926 @cindex copying files and directories
6927 @cindex files, copying
6928 @cindex directories, copying
6930 @command{cp} copies files (or, optionally, directories). The copy is
6931 completely independent of the original. You can either copy one file to
6932 another, or copy arbitrarily many files to a destination directory.
6936 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
6937 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
6938 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
6943 If two file names are given, @command{cp} copies the first file to the
6947 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
6948 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
6949 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
6950 @command{cp} copies each @var{source} file to the specified directory,
6951 using the @var{source}s' names.
6954 Generally, files are written just as they are read. For exceptions,
6955 see the @option{--sparse} option below.
6957 By default, @command{cp} does not copy directories. However, the
6958 @option{-R}, @option{-a}, and @option{-r} options cause @command{cp} to
6959 copy recursively by descending into source directories and copying files
6960 to corresponding destination directories.
6962 When copying from a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
6963 link only when not copying
6964 recursively. This default can be overridden with the
6965 @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d}, @option{--dereference}
6966 (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-P}), and
6967 @option{-H} options. If more than one of these options is specified,
6968 the last one silently overrides the others.
6970 When copying to a symbolic link, @command{cp} follows the
6971 link only when it refers to an existing regular file.
6972 However, when copying to a dangling symbolic link, @command{cp}
6973 refuses by default, and fails with a diagnostic, since the operation
6974 is inherently dangerous. This behavior is contrary to historical
6975 practice and to @acronym{POSIX}.
6976 Set @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} to make @command{cp} attempt to create
6977 the target of a dangling destination symlink, in spite of the possible risk.
6978 Also, when an option like
6979 @option{--backup} or @option{--link} acts to rename or remove the
6980 destination before copying, @command{cp} renames or removes the
6981 symbolic link rather than the file it points to.
6983 By default, @command{cp} copies the contents of special files only
6984 when not copying recursively. This default can be overridden with the
6985 @option{--copy-contents} option.
6987 @cindex self-backups
6988 @cindex backups, making only
6989 @command{cp} generally refuses to copy a file onto itself, with the
6990 following exception: if @option{--force --backup} is specified with
6991 @var{source} and @var{dest} identical, and referring to a regular file,
6992 @command{cp} will make a backup file, either regular or numbered, as
6993 specified in the usual ways (@pxref{Backup options}). This is useful when
6994 you simply want to make a backup of an existing file before changing it.
6996 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7003 Preserve as much as possible of the structure and attributes of the
7004 original files in the copy (but do not attempt to preserve internal
7005 directory structure; i.e., @samp{ls -U} may list the entries in a copied
7006 directory in a different order).
7007 Equivalent to @option{-dpR}.
7010 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
7013 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
7014 @cindex backups, making
7015 @xref{Backup options}.
7016 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
7017 As a special case, @command{cp} makes a backup of @var{source} when the force
7018 and backup options are given and @var{source} and @var{dest} are the same
7019 name for an existing, regular file. One useful application of this
7020 combination of options is this tiny Bourne shell script:
7024 # Usage: backup FILE...
7025 # Create a @sc{gnu}-style backup of each listed FILE.
7027 cp --backup --force -- "$i" "$i"
7031 @item --copy-contents
7032 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7033 @cindex copying directories recursively
7034 @cindex recursively copying directories
7035 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7036 If copying recursively, copy the contents of any special files (e.g.,
7037 FIFOs and device files) as if they were regular files. This means
7038 trying to read the data in each source file and writing it to the
7039 destination. It is usually a mistake to use this option, as it
7040 normally has undesirable effects on special files like FIFOs and the
7041 ones typically found in the @file{/dev} directory. In most cases,
7042 @code{cp -R --copy-contents} will hang indefinitely trying to read
7043 from FIFOs and special files like @file{/dev/console}, and it will
7044 fill up your destination disk if you use it to copy @file{/dev/zero}.
7045 This option has no effect unless copying recursively, and it does not
7046 affect the copying of symbolic links.
7050 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7051 @cindex hard links, preserving
7052 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7053 they point to, and preserve hard links between source files in the copies.
7054 Equivalent to @option{--no-dereference --preserve=links}.
7060 When copying without this option and an existing destination file cannot
7061 be opened for writing, the copy fails. However, with @option{--force}),
7062 when a destination file cannot be opened, @command{cp} then removes it and
7063 tries to open it again. Contrast this behavior with that enabled by
7064 @option{--link} and @option{--symbolic-link}, whereby the destination file
7065 is never opened but rather is removed unconditionally. Also see the
7066 description of @option{--remove-destination}.
7068 This option is independent of the @option{--interactive} or
7069 @option{-i} option: neither cancels the effect of the other.
7073 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, then copy the
7074 file it points to rather than the symbolic link itself. However,
7075 copy (preserving its nature) any symbolic link that is encountered
7076 via recursive traversal.
7079 @itemx --interactive
7081 @opindex --interactive
7082 When copying a file other than a directory, prompt whether to
7083 overwrite an existing destination file.
7089 Make hard links instead of copies of non-directories.
7092 @itemx --dereference
7094 @opindex --dereference
7095 Follow symbolic links when copying from them.
7098 @itemx --no-dereference
7100 @opindex --no-dereference
7101 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7102 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7103 they point to. This option affects only symbolic links in the source;
7104 symbolic links in the destination are always followed if possible.
7107 @itemx @w{@kbd{--preserve}[=@var{attribute_list}]}
7110 @cindex file information, preserving
7111 Preserve the specified attributes of the original files.
7112 If specified, the @var{attribute_list} must be a comma-separated list
7113 of one or more of the following strings:
7117 Preserve the file mode bits and access control lists.
7119 Preserve the owner and group. On most modern systems,
7120 only users with appropriate privileges may change the owner of a file,
7122 may preserve the group ownership of a file only if they happen to be
7123 a member of the desired group.
7125 Preserve the times of last access and last modification, when possible.
7126 In general, it is not possible to preserve these attributes
7127 when the affected file is a symbolic link.
7128 However, FreeBSD now provides the @code{lutimes} function, which makes
7129 it possible even for symbolic links. However, this implementation does
7130 not yet take advantage of that.
7131 @c FIXME: once we provide lutimes support, update the above.
7133 Preserve in the destination files
7134 any links between corresponding source files.
7135 @c Give examples illustrating how hard links are preserved.
7136 @c Also, show how soft links map to hard links with -L and -H.
7138 Preserve all file attributes.
7139 Equivalent to specifying all of the above.
7142 Using @option{--preserve} with no @var{attribute_list} is equivalent
7143 to @option{--preserve=mode,ownership,timestamps}.
7145 In the absence of this option, each destination file is created with the
7146 mode bits of the corresponding source file, minus the bits set in the
7147 umask and minus the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits.
7148 @xref{File permissions}.
7150 @itemx @w{@kbd{--no-preserve}=@var{attribute_list}}
7151 @cindex file information, preserving
7152 Do not preserve the specified attributes. The @var{attribute_list}
7153 has the same form as for @option{--preserve}.
7157 @cindex parent directories and @command{cp}
7158 Form the name of each destination file by appending to the target
7159 directory a slash and the specified name of the source file. The last
7160 argument given to @command{cp} must be the name of an existing directory.
7161 For example, the command:
7164 cp --parents a/b/c existing_dir
7168 copies the file @file{a/b/c} to @file{existing_dir/a/b/c}, creating
7169 any missing intermediate directories.
7171 @itemx @w{@kbd{--reply}=@var{how}}
7173 @cindex interactivity
7174 @c FIXME: remove in 2008
7175 @strong{Deprecated: to be removed in 2008.}@*
7176 Using @option{--reply=yes} makes @command{cp} act as if @samp{yes} were
7177 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file. That effectively
7178 cancels any preceding @option{--interactive} or @option{-i} option.
7179 Specify @option{--reply=no} to make @command{cp} act as if @samp{no} were
7180 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file.
7181 Specify @option{--reply=query} to make @command{cp} prompt the user
7182 about each existing destination file.
7189 @opindex --recursive
7190 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7191 @cindex copying directories recursively
7192 @cindex recursively copying directories
7193 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7194 Copy directories recursively. By default, do not follow symbolic
7195 links in the source; see the @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d},
7196 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference}
7197 (@option{-P}), and @option{-H} options. Special files are copied by
7198 creating a destination file of the same type as the source; see the
7199 @option{--copy-contents} option. It is not portable to use
7200 @option{-r} to copy symbolic links or special files. On some
7201 non-@sc{gnu} systems, @option{-r} implies the equivalent of
7202 @option{-L} and @option{--copy-contents} for historical reasons.
7203 Also, it is not portable to use @option{-R} to copy symbolic links
7204 unless you also specify @option{-P}, as @acronym{POSIX} allows
7205 implementations that dereference symbolic links by default.
7207 @item --remove-destination
7208 @opindex --remove-destination
7209 Remove each existing destination file before attempting to open it
7210 (contrast with @option{-f} above).
7212 @item --sparse=@var{when}
7213 @opindex --sparse=@var{when}
7214 @cindex sparse files, copying
7215 @cindex holes, copying files with
7216 @findex read @r{system call, and holes}
7217 A @dfn{sparse file} contains @dfn{holes}---a sequence of zero bytes that
7218 does not occupy any physical disk blocks; the @samp{read} system call
7219 reads these as zeros. This can both save considerable disk space and
7220 increase speed, since many binary files contain lots of consecutive zero
7221 bytes. By default, @command{cp} detects holes in input source files via a crude
7222 heuristic and makes the corresponding output file sparse as well.
7223 Only regular files may be sparse.
7225 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
7229 The default behavior: if the input file is sparse, attempt to make
7230 the output file sparse, too. However, if an output file exists but
7231 refers to a non-regular file, then do not attempt to make it sparse.
7234 For each sufficiently long sequence of zero bytes in the input file,
7235 attempt to create a corresponding hole in the output file, even if the
7236 input file does not appear to be sparse.
7237 This is useful when the input file resides on a file system
7238 that does not support sparse files
7239 (for example, @samp{efs} file systems in SGI IRIX 5.3 and earlier),
7240 but the output file is on a type of file system that does support them.
7241 Holes may be created only in regular files, so if the destination file
7242 is of some other type, @command{cp} does not even try to make it sparse.
7245 Never make the output file sparse.
7246 This is useful in creating a file for use with the @command{mkswap} command,
7247 since such a file must not have any holes.
7250 @optStripTrailingSlashes
7253 @itemx --symbolic-link
7255 @opindex --symbolic-link
7256 @cindex symbolic links, copying with
7257 Make symbolic links instead of copies of non-directories. All source
7258 file names must be absolute (starting with @samp{/}) unless the
7259 destination files are in the current directory. This option merely
7260 results in an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
7266 @optNoTargetDirectory
7272 @cindex newer files, copying only
7273 Do not copy a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
7274 same or newer modification time. If time stamps are being preserved,
7275 the comparison is to the source time stamp truncated to the
7276 resolutions of the destination file system and of the system calls
7277 used to update time stamps; this avoids duplicate work if several
7278 @samp{cp -pu} commands are executed with the same source and
7285 Print the name of each file before copying it.
7288 @itemx --one-file-system
7290 @opindex --one-file-system
7291 @cindex file systems, omitting copying to different
7292 Skip subdirectories that are on different file systems from the one that
7293 the copy started on.
7294 However, mount point directories @emph{are} copied.
7302 @section @command{dd}: Convert and copy a file
7305 @cindex converting while copying a file
7307 @command{dd} copies a file (from standard input to standard output, by
7308 default) with a changeable I/O block size, while optionally performing
7309 conversions on it. Synopses:
7312 dd [@var{operand}]@dots{}
7316 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
7317 @xref{Common options}. @command{dd} accepts the following operands.
7323 Read from @var{file} instead of standard input.
7327 Write to @var{file} instead of standard output. Unless
7328 @samp{conv=notrunc} is given, @command{dd} truncates @var{file} to zero
7329 bytes (or the size specified with @samp{seek=}).
7331 @item ibs=@var{bytes}
7333 @cindex block size of input
7334 @cindex input block size
7335 Set the input block size to @var{bytes}.
7336 This makes @command{dd} read @var{bytes} per block.
7338 @item obs=@var{bytes}
7340 @cindex block size of output
7341 @cindex output block size
7342 Set the output block size to @var{bytes}.
7343 This makes @command{dd} write @var{bytes} per block.
7345 @item bs=@var{bytes}
7348 Set both input and output block sizes to @var{bytes}.
7349 This makes @command{dd} read and write @var{bytes} per block,
7350 overriding any @samp{ibs} and @samp{obs} settings.
7352 @item cbs=@var{bytes}
7354 @cindex block size of conversion
7355 @cindex conversion block size
7356 @cindex fixed-length records, converting to variable-length
7357 @cindex variable-length records, converting to fixed-length
7358 Set the conversion block size to @var{bytes}.
7359 When converting variable-length records to fixed-length ones
7360 (@option{conv=block}) or the reverse (@option{conv=unblock}),
7361 use @var{bytes} as the fixed record length.
7363 @item skip=@var{blocks}
7365 Skip @var{blocks} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks in the input file before copying.
7367 @item seek=@var{blocks}
7369 Skip @var{blocks} @samp{obs}-byte blocks in the output file before copying.
7371 @item count=@var{blocks}
7373 Copy @var{blocks} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks from the input file, instead
7374 of everything until the end of the file.
7376 @item conv=@var{conversion}[,@var{conversion}]@dots{}
7378 Convert the file as specified by the @var{conversion} argument(s).
7379 (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7386 @opindex ascii@r{, converting to}
7387 Convert @acronym{EBCDIC} to @acronym{ASCII},
7388 using the conversion table specified by @acronym{POSIX}.
7389 This provides a 1:1 translation for all 256 bytes.
7392 @opindex ebcdic@r{, converting to}
7393 Convert @acronym{ASCII} to @acronym{EBCDIC}.
7394 This is the inverse of the @samp{ascii} conversion.
7397 @opindex alternate ebcdic@r{, converting to}
7398 Convert @acronym{ASCII} to alternate @acronym{EBCDIC},
7399 using the alternate conversion table specified by @acronym{POSIX}.
7400 This is not a 1:1 translation, but reflects common historical practice
7401 for @samp{~}, @samp{[}, and @samp{]}.
7403 The @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic}, and @samp{ibm} conversions are
7407 @opindex block @r{(space-padding)}
7408 For each line in the input, output @samp{cbs} bytes, replacing the
7409 input newline with a space and padding with spaces as necessary.
7413 Replace trailing spaces in each @samp{cbs}-sized input block with a
7416 The @samp{block} and @samp{unblock} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7419 @opindex lcase@r{, converting to}
7420 Change uppercase letters to lowercase.
7423 @opindex ucase@r{, converting to}
7424 Change lowercase letters to uppercase.
7426 The @samp{lcase} and @samp{ucase} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7429 @opindex swab @r{(byte-swapping)}
7430 @cindex byte-swapping
7431 Swap every pair of input bytes. @sc{gnu} @command{dd}, unlike others, works
7432 when an odd number of bytes are read---the last byte is simply copied
7433 (since there is nothing to swap it with).
7437 @cindex read errors, ignoring
7438 Continue after read errors.
7442 @cindex creating output file, avoiding
7443 Do not create the output file; the output file must already exist.
7447 @cindex creating output file, requiring
7448 Fail if the output file already exists; @command{dd} must create the
7451 The @samp{excl} and @samp{nocreat} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7455 @cindex truncating output file, avoiding
7456 Do not truncate the output file.
7459 @opindex sync @r{(padding with nulls)}
7460 Pad every input block to size of @samp{ibs} with trailing zero bytes.
7461 When used with @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, pad with spaces instead of
7466 @cindex synchronized data writes, before finishing
7467 Synchronize output data just before finishing. This forces a physical
7468 write of output data.
7472 @cindex synchronized data and metadata writes, before finishing
7473 Synchronize output data and metadata just before finishing. This
7474 forces a physical write of output data and metadata.
7478 @item iflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
7480 Access the input file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
7481 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7483 @item oflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
7485 Access the output file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
7486 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7488 Here are the flags. Not every flag is supported on every operating
7495 @cindex appending to the output file
7496 Write in append mode, so that even if some other process is writing to
7497 this file, every @command{dd} write will append to the current
7498 contents of the file. This flag makes sense only for output.
7499 If you combine this flag with the @samp{of=@var{file}} operand,
7500 you should also specify @samp{conv=notrunc} unless you want the
7501 output file to be truncated before being appended to.
7506 Use direct I/O for data, avoiding the buffer cache.
7510 @cindex directory I/O
7512 Fail unless the file is a directory. Most operating systems do not
7513 allow I/O to a directory, so this flag has limited utility.
7517 @cindex synchronized data reads
7518 Use synchronized I/O for data. For the output file, this forces a
7519 physical write of output data on each write. For the input file,
7520 this flag can matter when reading from a remote file that has been
7521 written to synchronously by some other process. Metadata (e.g.,
7522 last-access and last-modified time) is not necessarily synchronized.
7526 @cindex synchronized data and metadata I/O
7527 Use synchronized I/O for both data and metadata.
7531 @cindex nonblocking I/O
7532 Use non-blocking I/O.
7537 Do not update the file's access time.
7538 Some older file systems silently ignore this flag, so it is a good
7539 idea to test it on your files before relying on it.
7543 @cindex controlling terminal
7544 Do not assign the file to be a controlling terminal for @command{dd}.
7545 This has no effect when the file is not a terminal.
7546 On many hosts (e.g., @acronym{GNU}/Linux hosts), this option has no effect
7551 @cindex symbolic links, following
7552 Do not follow symbolic links.
7557 Fail if the file has multiple hard links.
7562 Use binary I/O. This option has an effect only on nonstandard
7563 platforms that distinguish binary from text I/O.
7568 Use text I/O. Like @samp{binary}, this option has no effect on
7573 These flags are not supported on all systems, and @samp{dd} rejects
7574 attempts to use them when they are not supported. When reading from
7575 standard input or writing to standard output, the @samp{nofollow} and
7576 @samp{noctty} flags should not be specified, and the other flags
7577 (e.g., @samp{nonblock}) can affect how other processes behave with the
7578 affected file descriptors, even after @command{dd} exits.
7582 @cindex multipliers after numbers
7583 The numeric-valued strings above (@var{bytes} and @var{blocks}) can be
7584 followed by a multiplier: @samp{b}=512, @samp{c}=1,
7585 @samp{w}=2, @samp{x@var{m}}=@var{m}, or any of the
7586 standard block size suffixes like @samp{k}=1024 (@pxref{Block size}).
7588 Use different @command{dd} invocations to use different block sizes for
7589 skipping and I/O@. For example, the following shell commands copy data
7590 in 512 KiB blocks between a disk and a tape, but do not save or restore a
7591 4 KiB label at the start of the disk:
7594 disk=/dev/rdsk/c0t1d0s2
7597 # Copy all but the label from disk to tape.
7598 (dd bs=4k skip=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$disk >$tape
7600 # Copy from tape back to disk, but leave the disk label alone.
7601 (dd bs=4k seek=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$tape >$disk
7604 Sending an @samp{INFO} signal to a running @command{dd}
7605 process makes it print I/O statistics to standard error
7606 and then resume copying. In the example below,
7607 @command{dd} is run in the background to copy 10 million blocks.
7608 The @command{kill} command makes it output intermediate I/O statistics,
7609 and when @command{dd} completes normally or is killed by the
7610 @code{SIGINT} signal, it outputs the final statistics.
7613 $ dd if=/dev/zero of=/dev/null count=10MB & pid=$!
7614 $ kill -s INFO $pid; wait $pid
7615 3385223+0 records in
7616 3385223+0 records out
7617 1733234176 bytes (1.7 GB) copied, 6.42173 seconds, 270 MB/s
7618 10000000+0 records in
7619 10000000+0 records out
7620 5120000000 bytes (5.1 GB) copied, 18.913 seconds, 271 MB/s
7623 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
7624 On systems lacking the @samp{INFO} signal @command{dd} responds to the
7625 @samp{USR1} signal instead, unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
7626 environment variable is set.
7631 @node install invocation
7632 @section @command{install}: Copy files and set attributes
7635 @cindex copying files and setting attributes
7637 @command{install} copies files while setting their file mode bits and, if
7638 possible, their owner and group. Synopses:
7641 install [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7642 install [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7643 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7644 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -d @var{directory}@dots{}
7649 If two file names are given, @command{install} copies the first file to the
7653 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7654 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7655 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7656 @command{install} copies each @var{source} file to the specified
7657 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
7660 If the @option{--directory} (@option{-d}) option is given,
7661 @command{install} creates each @var{directory} and any missing parent
7662 directories. Parent directories are created with mode
7663 @samp{u=rwx,go=rx} (755), regardless of the @option{-m} option or the
7664 current umask. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
7665 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of parent directories are inherited.
7668 @cindex Makefiles, installing programs in
7669 @command{install} is similar to @command{cp}, but allows you to control the
7670 attributes of destination files. It is typically used in Makefiles to
7671 copy programs into their destination directories. It refuses to copy
7672 files onto themselves.
7674 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7682 Ignored; for compatibility with old Unix versions of @command{install}.
7686 Create any missing parent directories of @var{dest},
7687 then copy @var{source} to @var{dest}.
7688 This option is ignored if a destination directory is specified
7689 via @option{--target-directory=DIR}.
7694 @opindex --directory
7695 @cindex directories, creating with given attributes
7696 @cindex parent directories, creating missing
7697 @cindex leading directories, creating missing
7698 Create any missing parent directories, giving them the default
7699 attributes. Then create each given directory, setting their owner,
7700 group and mode as given on the command line or to the defaults.
7702 @item -g @var{group}
7703 @itemx --group=@var{group}
7706 @cindex group ownership of installed files, setting
7707 Set the group ownership of installed files or directories to
7708 @var{group}. The default is the process's current group. @var{group}
7709 may be either a group name or a numeric group ID.
7712 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
7715 @cindex permissions of installed files, setting
7716 Set the file mode bits for the installed file or directory to @var{mode},
7717 which can be either an octal number, or a symbolic mode as in
7718 @command{chmod}, with @samp{a=} (no access allowed to anyone) as the
7719 point of departure (@pxref{File permissions}).
7720 The default mode is @samp{u=rwx,go=rx,a-s}---read, write, and
7721 execute for the owner, read and execute for group and other, and with
7722 set-user-ID and set-group-ID disabled.
7723 This default is not quite the same as @samp{755}, since it disables
7724 instead of preserving set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
7725 @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}.
7727 @item -o @var{owner}
7728 @itemx --owner=@var{owner}
7731 @cindex ownership of installed files, setting
7732 @cindex appropriate privileges
7733 @vindex root @r{as default owner}
7734 If @command{install} has appropriate privileges (is run as root), set the
7735 ownership of installed files or directories to @var{owner}. The default
7736 is @code{root}. @var{owner} may be either a user name or a numeric user
7740 @itemx --preserve-timestamps
7742 @opindex --preserve-timestamps
7743 @cindex timestamps of installed files, preserving
7744 Set the time of last access and the time of last modification of each
7745 installed file to match those of each corresponding original file.
7746 When a file is installed without this option, its last access and
7747 last modification times are both set to the time of installation.
7748 This option is useful if you want to use the last modification times
7749 of installed files to keep track of when they were last built as opposed
7750 to when they were last installed.
7756 @cindex symbol table information, stripping
7757 @cindex stripping symbol table information
7758 Strip the symbol tables from installed binary executables.
7764 @optNoTargetDirectory
7770 Print the name of each file before copying it.
7778 @section @command{mv}: Move (rename) files
7782 @command{mv} moves or renames files (or directories). Synopses:
7785 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7786 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7787 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7792 If two file names are given, @command{mv} moves the first file to the
7796 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7797 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7798 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7799 @command{mv} moves each @var{source} file to the specified
7800 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
7803 @command{mv} can move any type of file from one file system to another.
7804 Prior to version @code{4.0} of the fileutils,
7805 @command{mv} could move only regular files between file systems.
7806 For example, now @command{mv} can move an entire directory hierarchy
7807 including special device files from one partition to another. It first
7808 uses some of the same code that's used by @code{cp -a} to copy the
7809 requested directories and files, then (assuming the copy succeeded)
7810 it removes the originals. If the copy fails, then the part that was
7811 copied to the destination partition is removed. If you were to copy
7812 three directories from one partition to another and the copy of the first
7813 directory succeeded, but the second didn't, the first would be left on
7814 the destination partition and the second and third would be left on the
7817 @cindex prompting, and @command{mv}
7818 If a destination file exists but is normally unwritable, standard input
7819 is a terminal, and the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given,
7820 @command{mv} prompts the user for whether to replace the file. (You might
7821 own the file, or have write permission on its directory.) If the
7822 response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7824 @emph{Warning}: Avoid specifying a source name with a trailing slash,
7825 when it might be a symlink to a directory.
7826 Otherwise, @command{mv} may do something very surprising, since
7827 its behavior depends on the underlying rename system call.
7828 On modern Linux systems, it fails with @code{errno=ENOTDIR}.
7829 However, on other systems (at least FreeBSD 6.1 and Solaris 10) it silently
7830 renames not the symlink but rather the directory referenced by the symlink.
7831 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
7833 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7843 @cindex prompts, omitting
7844 Do not prompt the user before removing a destination file.
7847 @itemx --interactive
7849 @opindex --interactive
7850 @cindex prompts, forcing
7851 Prompt whether to overwrite each existing destination file, regardless
7853 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7855 @itemx @w{@kbd{--reply}=@var{how}}
7857 @cindex interactivity
7858 @c FIXME: remove in 2008
7859 @strong{Deprecated: to be removed in 2008.}@*
7860 Specifying @option{--reply=yes} is equivalent to using @option{--force}.
7861 Specify @option{--reply=no} to make @command{mv} act as if @samp{no} were
7862 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file.
7863 Specify @option{--reply=query} to make @command{mv} prompt the user
7864 about each existing destination file.
7865 Note that @option{--reply=no} has an effect only when @command{mv} would prompt
7866 without @option{-i} or equivalent, i.e., when a destination file exists and is
7867 not writable, standard input is a terminal, and no @option{-f} (or equivalent)
7868 option is specified.
7874 @cindex newer files, moving only
7875 Do not move a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
7876 same or newer modification time.
7877 If the move is across file system boundaries, the comparison is to the
7878 source time stamp truncated to the resolutions of the destination file
7879 system and of the system calls used to update time stamps; this avoids
7880 duplicate work if several @samp{mv -u} commands are executed with the
7881 same source and destination.
7887 Print the name of each file before moving it.
7889 @optStripTrailingSlashes
7895 @optNoTargetDirectory
7903 @section @command{rm}: Remove files or directories
7906 @cindex removing files or directories
7908 @command{rm} removes each given @var{file}. By default, it does not remove
7909 directories. Synopsis:
7912 rm [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
7915 @cindex prompting, and @command{rm}
7916 If the @option{-I} or @option{--interactive=once} option is given,
7917 and there are more than three files or the @option{-r}, @option{-R},
7918 or @option{--recursive} are given, then @command{rm} prompts the user
7919 for whether to proceed with the entire operation. If the response is
7920 not affirmative, the entire command is aborted.
7922 Otherwise, if a file is unwritable, standard input is a terminal, and
7923 the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given, or the
7924 @option{-i} or @option{--interactive=always} option @emph{is} given,
7925 @command{rm} prompts the user for whether to remove the file.
7926 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7928 Any attempt to remove a file whose last file name component is
7929 @file{.} or @file{..} is rejected without any prompting.
7931 @emph{Warning}: If you use @command{rm} to remove a file, it is usually
7932 possible to recover the contents of that file. If you want more assurance
7933 that the contents are truly unrecoverable, consider using @command{shred}.
7935 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7943 Ignore nonexistent files and never prompt the user.
7944 Ignore any previous @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option.
7948 Prompt whether to remove each file.
7949 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7950 Ignore any previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option.
7951 Equivalent to @option{--interactive=always}.
7955 Prompt once whether to proceed with the command, if more than three
7956 files are named or if a recursive removal is requested. Ignore any
7957 previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option. Equivalent to
7958 @option{--interactive=once}.
7960 @itemx --interactive [=@var{when}]
7961 @opindex --interactive
7962 Specify when to issue an interactive prompt. @var{when} may be
7966 @vindex never @r{interactive option}
7967 - Do not prompt at all.
7969 @vindex once @r{interactive option}
7970 - Prompt once if more than three files are named or if a recursive
7971 removal is requested. Equivalent to @option{-I}.
7973 @vindex always @r{interactive option}
7974 - Prompt for every file being removed. Equivalent to @option{-i}.
7976 @option{--interactive} with no @var{when} is equivalent to
7977 @option{--interactive=always}.
7979 @itemx --one-file-system
7980 @opindex --one-file-system
7981 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{rm} to
7982 When removing a hierarchy recursively, skip any directory that is on a
7983 file system different from that of the corresponding command line argument.
7985 This option is useful when removing a build ``chroot'' hierarchy,
7986 which normally contains no valuable data. However, it is not uncommon
7987 to bind-mount @file{/home} into such a hierarchy, to make it easier to
7988 use one's start-up file. The catch is that it's easy to forget to
7989 unmount @file{/home}. Then, when you use @command{rm -rf} to remove
7990 your normally throw-away chroot, that command will remove everything
7991 under @file{/home}, too.
7992 Use the @option{--one-file-system} option, and it will
7993 warn about and skip directories on other file systems.
7994 Of course, this will not save your @file{/home} if it and your
7995 chroot happen to be on the same file system.
7997 @itemx --preserve-root
7998 @opindex --preserve-root
7999 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive destruction
8000 Fail upon any attempt to remove the root directory, @file{/},
8001 when used with the @option{--recursive} option.
8002 This is the default behavior.
8003 @xref{Treating / specially}.
8005 @itemx --no-preserve-root
8006 @opindex --no-preserve-root
8007 @cindex root directory, allow recursive destruction
8008 Do not treat @file{/} specially when removing recursively.
8009 This option is not recommended unless you really want to
8010 remove all the files on your computer.
8011 @xref{Treating / specially}.
8018 @opindex --recursive
8019 @cindex directories, removing (recursively)
8020 Remove the listed directories and their contents recursively.
8026 Print the name of each file before removing it.
8030 @cindex files beginning with @samp{-}, removing
8031 @cindex @samp{-}, removing files beginning with
8032 One common question is how to remove files whose names begin with a
8033 @samp{-}. @sc{gnu} @command{rm}, like every program that uses the @code{getopt}
8034 function to parse its arguments, lets you use the @samp{--} option to
8035 indicate that all following arguments are non-options. To remove a file
8036 called @file{-f} in the current directory, you could type either:
8049 @opindex - @r{and Unix @command{rm}}
8050 The Unix @command{rm} program's use of a single @samp{-} for this purpose
8051 predates the development of the getopt standard syntax.
8056 @node shred invocation
8057 @section @command{shred}: Remove files more securely
8060 @cindex data, erasing
8061 @cindex erasing data
8063 @command{shred} overwrites devices or files, to help prevent even
8064 very expensive hardware from recovering the data.
8066 Ordinarily when you remove a file (@pxref{rm invocation}), the data is
8067 not actually destroyed. Only the index listing where the file is
8068 stored is destroyed, and the storage is made available for reuse.
8069 There are undelete utilities that will attempt to reconstruct the index
8070 and can bring the file back if the parts were not reused.
8072 On a busy system with a nearly-full drive, space can get reused in a few
8073 seconds. But there is no way to know for sure. If you have sensitive
8074 data, you may want to be sure that recovery is not possible by actually
8075 overwriting the file with non-sensitive data.
8077 However, even after doing that, it is possible to take the disk back
8078 to a laboratory and use a lot of sensitive (and expensive) equipment
8079 to look for the faint ``echoes'' of the original data underneath the
8080 overwritten data. If the data has only been overwritten once, it's not
8083 The best way to remove something irretrievably is to destroy the media
8084 it's on with acid, melt it down, or the like. For cheap removable media
8085 like floppy disks, this is the preferred method. However, hard drives
8086 are expensive and hard to melt, so the @command{shred} utility tries
8087 to achieve a similar effect non-destructively.
8089 This uses many overwrite passes, with the data patterns chosen to
8090 maximize the damage they do to the old data. While this will work on
8091 floppies, the patterns are designed for best effect on hard drives.
8092 For more details, see the source code and Peter Gutmann's paper
8093 @uref{http://www.cs.auckland.ac.nz/~pgut001/pubs/secure_del.html,
8094 @cite{Secure Deletion of Data from Magnetic and Solid-State Memory}},
8095 from the proceedings of the Sixth @acronym{USENIX} Security Symposium (San Jose,
8096 California, July 22--25, 1996).
8098 @strong{Please note} that @command{shred} relies on a very important assumption:
8099 that the file system overwrites data in place. This is the traditional
8100 way to do things, but many modern file system designs do not satisfy this
8101 assumption. Exceptions include:
8106 Log-structured or journaled file systems, such as those supplied with
8107 AIX and Solaris, and JFS, ReiserFS, XFS, Ext3 (in @code{data=journal} mode),
8108 BFS, NTFS, etc.@: when they are configured to journal @emph{data}.
8111 File systems that write redundant data and carry on even if some writes
8112 fail, such as RAID-based file systems.
8115 File systems that make snapshots, such as Network Appliance's NFS server.
8118 File systems that cache in temporary locations, such as NFS version 3
8122 Compressed file systems.
8125 In the particular case of ext3 file systems, the above disclaimer applies (and
8126 @command{shred} is thus of limited effectiveness) only in @code{data=journal}
8127 mode, which journals file data in addition to just metadata. In both
8128 the @code{data=ordered} (default) and @code{data=writeback} modes,
8129 @command{shred} works as usual. Ext3 journaling modes can be changed
8130 by adding the @code{data=something} option to the mount options for a
8131 particular file system in the @file{/etc/fstab} file, as documented in
8132 the mount man page (man mount).
8134 If you are not sure how your file system operates, then you should assume
8135 that it does not overwrite data in place, which means that shred cannot
8136 reliably operate on regular files in your file system.
8138 Generally speaking, it is more reliable to shred a device than a file,
8139 since this bypasses the problem of file system design mentioned above.
8140 However, even shredding devices is not always completely reliable. For
8141 example, most disks map out bad sectors invisibly to the application; if
8142 the bad sectors contain sensitive data, @command{shred} won't be able to
8145 @command{shred} makes no attempt to detect or report this problem, just as
8146 it makes no attempt to do anything about backups. However, since it is
8147 more reliable to shred devices than files, @command{shred} by default does
8148 not truncate or remove the output file. This default is more suitable
8149 for devices, which typically cannot be truncated and should not be
8152 Finally, consider the risk of backups and mirrors.
8153 File system backups and remote mirrors may contain copies of the
8154 file that cannot be removed, and that will allow a shredded file
8155 to be recovered later. So if you keep any data you may later want
8156 to destroy using @command{shred}, be sure that it is not backed up or mirrored.
8159 shred [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}[@dots{}]
8162 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8170 @cindex force deletion
8171 Override file permissions if necessary to allow overwriting.
8174 @itemx -n @var{NUMBER}
8175 @itemx --iterations=@var{NUMBER}
8176 @opindex -n @var{NUMBER}
8177 @opindex --iterations=@var{NUMBER}
8178 @cindex iterations, selecting the number of
8179 By default, @command{shred} uses 25 passes of overwrite. This is enough
8180 for all of the useful overwrite patterns to be used at least once.
8181 You can reduce this to save time, or increase it if you have a lot of
8184 @item --random-source=@var{file}
8185 @opindex --random-source
8186 @cindex random source for shredding
8187 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to overwrite and to
8188 choose pass ordering. @xref{Random sources}.
8190 @item -s @var{BYTES}
8191 @itemx --size=@var{BYTES}
8192 @opindex -s @var{BYTES}
8193 @opindex --size=@var{BYTES}
8194 @cindex size of file to shred
8195 Shred the first @var{BYTES} bytes of the file. The default is to shred
8196 the whole file. @var{BYTES} can be followed by a size specification like
8197 @samp{K}, @samp{M}, or @samp{G} to specify a multiple. @xref{Block size}.
8203 @cindex removing files after shredding
8204 After shredding a file, truncate it (if possible) and then remove it.
8205 If a file has multiple links, only the named links will be removed.
8211 Display to standard error all status updates as sterilization proceeds.
8217 By default, @command{shred} rounds the size of a regular file up to the next
8218 multiple of the file system block size to fully erase the last block of the file.
8219 Use @option{--exact} to suppress that behavior.
8220 Thus, by default if you shred a 10-byte regular file on a system with 512-byte
8221 blocks, the resulting file will be 512 bytes long. With this option,
8222 shred does not increase the apparent size of the file.
8228 Normally, the last pass that @command{shred} writes is made up of
8229 random data. If this would be conspicuous on your hard drive (for
8230 example, because it looks like encrypted data), or you just think
8231 it's tidier, the @option{--zero} option adds an additional overwrite pass with
8232 all zero bits. This is in addition to the number of passes specified
8233 by the @option{--iterations} option.
8237 You might use the following command to erase all trace of the
8238 file system you'd created on the floppy disk in your first drive.
8239 That command takes about 20 minutes to erase a ``1.44MB'' (actually
8243 shred --verbose /dev/fd0
8246 Similarly, to erase all data on a selected partition of
8247 your hard disk, you could give a command like this:
8250 shred --verbose /dev/sda5
8253 A @var{file} of @samp{-} denotes standard output.
8254 The intended use of this is to shred a removed temporary file.
8258 i=`tempfile -m 0600`
8261 echo "Hello, world" >&3
8266 However, the command @samp{shred - >file} does not shred the contents
8267 of @var{file}, since the shell truncates @var{file} before invoking
8268 @command{shred}. Use the command @samp{shred file} or (if using a
8269 Bourne-compatible shell) the command @samp{shred - 1<>file} instead.
8274 @node Special file types
8275 @chapter Special file types
8277 @cindex special file types
8278 @cindex file types, special
8280 This chapter describes commands which create special types of files (and
8281 @command{rmdir}, which removes directories, one special file type).
8283 @cindex special file types
8285 Although Unix-like operating systems have markedly fewer special file
8286 types than others, not @emph{everything} can be treated only as the
8287 undifferentiated byte stream of @dfn{normal files}. For example, when a
8288 file is created or removed, the system must record this information,
8289 which it does in a @dfn{directory}---a special type of file. Although
8290 you can read directories as normal files, if you're curious, in order
8291 for the system to do its job it must impose a structure, a certain
8292 order, on the bytes of the file. Thus it is a ``special'' type of file.
8294 Besides directories, other special file types include named pipes
8295 (FIFOs), symbolic links, sockets, and so-called @dfn{special files}.
8298 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
8299 * ln invocation:: Make links between files.
8300 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories.
8301 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes).
8302 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files.
8303 * readlink invocation:: Print the referent of a symbolic link.
8304 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories.
8305 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via the unlink syscall
8309 @node link invocation
8310 @section @command{link}: Make a hard link via the link syscall
8313 @cindex links, creating
8314 @cindex hard links, creating
8315 @cindex creating links (hard only)
8317 @command{link} creates a single hard link at a time.
8318 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
8319 @code{link} function. @xref{Hard Links, , , libc,
8320 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8321 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
8322 @command{ln} command (@pxref{ln invocation}).
8326 link @var{filename} @var{linkname}
8329 @var{filename} must specify an existing file, and @var{linkname}
8330 must specify a nonexistent entry in an existing directory.
8331 @command{link} simply calls @code{link (@var{filename}, @var{linkname})}
8334 On a @acronym{GNU} system, this command acts like @samp{ln --directory
8335 --no-target-directory @var{filename} @var{linkname}}. However, the
8336 @option{--directory} and @option{--no-target-directory} options are
8337 not specified by @acronym{POSIX}, and the @command{link} command is
8338 more portable in practice.
8344 @section @command{ln}: Make links between files
8347 @cindex links, creating
8348 @cindex hard links, creating
8349 @cindex symbolic (soft) links, creating
8350 @cindex creating links (hard or soft)
8352 @cindex file systems and hard links
8353 @command{ln} makes links between files. By default, it makes hard links;
8354 with the @option{-s} option, it makes symbolic (or @dfn{soft}) links.
8358 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{target} @var{linkname}
8359 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}
8360 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}@dots{} @var{directory}
8361 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{target}@dots{}
8367 If two file names are given, @command{ln} creates a link to the first
8368 file from the second.
8371 If one @var{target} is given, @command{ln} creates a link to that file
8372 in the current directory.
8375 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8376 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8377 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8378 @command{ln} creates a link to each @var{target} file in the specified
8379 directory, using the @var{target}s' names.
8383 Normally @command{ln} does not remove existing files. Use the
8384 @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option to remove them unconditionally,
8385 the @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option to remove them
8386 conditionally, and the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option to
8389 @cindex hard link, defined
8390 @cindex inode, and hard links
8391 A @dfn{hard link} is another name for an existing file; the link and the
8392 original are indistinguishable. Technically speaking, they share the
8393 same inode, and the inode contains all the information about a
8394 file---indeed, it is not incorrect to say that the inode @emph{is} the
8395 file. On all existing implementations, you cannot make a hard link to
8396 a directory, and hard links cannot cross file system boundaries. (These
8397 restrictions are not mandated by @acronym{POSIX}, however.)
8399 @cindex dereferencing symbolic links
8400 @cindex symbolic link, defined
8401 @dfn{Symbolic links} (@dfn{symlinks} for short), on the other hand, are
8402 a special file type (which not all kernels support: System V release 3
8403 (and older) systems lack symlinks) in which the link file actually
8404 refers to a different file, by name. When most operations (opening,
8405 reading, writing, and so on) are passed the symbolic link file, the
8406 kernel automatically @dfn{dereferences} the link and operates on the
8407 target of the link. But some operations (e.g., removing) work on the
8408 link file itself, rather than on its target. @xref{Symbolic Links,,,
8409 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8411 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8422 @opindex --directory
8423 @cindex hard links to directories
8424 Allow users with appropriate privileges to attempt to make hard links
8426 However, note that this will probably fail due to
8427 system restrictions, even for the super-user.
8433 Remove existing destination files.
8436 @itemx --interactive
8438 @opindex --interactive
8439 @cindex prompting, and @command{ln}
8440 Prompt whether to remove existing destination files.
8443 @itemx --no-dereference
8445 @opindex --no-dereference
8446 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a symbolic link to
8447 a directory. Instead, treat it as if it were a normal file.
8449 When the destination is an actual directory (not a symlink to one),
8450 there is no ambiguity. The link is created in that directory.
8451 But when the specified destination is a symlink to a directory,
8452 there are two ways to treat the user's request. @command{ln} can
8453 treat the destination just as it would a normal directory and create
8454 the link in it. On the other hand, the destination can be viewed as a
8455 non-directory---as the symlink itself. In that case, @command{ln}
8456 must delete or backup that symlink before creating the new link.
8457 The default is to treat a destination that is a symlink to a directory
8458 just like a directory.
8460 This option is weaker than the @option{--no-target-directory}
8461 (@option{-T}) option, so it has no effect if both options are given.
8467 Make symbolic links instead of hard links. This option merely produces
8468 an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
8474 @optNoTargetDirectory
8480 Print the name of each file after linking it successfully.
8491 # Create link ../a pointing to a in that directory.
8492 # Not really useful because it points to itself.
8497 # Change to the target before creating symlinks to avoid being confused.
8503 # Hard coded file names don't move well.
8504 ln -s $(pwd)/a /some/dir/
8508 # Relative file names survive directory moves and also
8509 # work across networked file systems.
8510 ln -s afile anotherfile
8511 ln -s ../adir/afile yetanotherfile
8515 @node mkdir invocation
8516 @section @command{mkdir}: Make directories
8519 @cindex directories, creating
8520 @cindex creating directories
8522 @command{mkdir} creates directories with the specified names. Synopsis:
8525 mkdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
8528 @command{mkdir} creates each directory @var{name} in the order given.
8529 It reports an error if @var{name} already exists, unless the
8530 @option{-p} option is given and @var{name} is a directory.
8532 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8537 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8540 @cindex modes of created directories, setting
8541 Set the file permission bits of created directories to @var{mode},
8542 which uses the same syntax as
8543 in @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rwx} (read, write and execute allowed for
8544 everyone) for the point of the departure. @xref{File permissions}.
8546 Normally the directory has the desired file mode bits at the moment it
8547 is created. As a @acronym{GNU} extension, @var{mode} may also mention
8548 special mode bits, but in this case there may be a temporary window
8549 during which the directory exists but its special mode bits are
8550 incorrect. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
8551 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of directories are inherited unless
8552 overridden in this way.
8558 @cindex parent directories, creating
8559 Make any missing parent directories for each argument, setting their
8560 file permission bits to the umask modified by @samp{u+wx}. Ignore
8561 existing parent directories, and do not change their file permission
8564 To set the file permission bits of any newly-created parent
8565 directories to a value that includes @samp{u+wx}, you can set the
8566 umask before invoking @command{mkdir}. For example, if the shell
8567 command @samp{(umask u=rwx,go=rx; mkdir -p P/Q)} creates the parent
8568 @file{P} it sets the parent's permission bits to @samp{u=rwx,go=rx}.
8569 To set a parent's special mode bits as well, you can invoke
8570 @command{chmod} after @command{mkdir}. @xref{Directory Setuid and
8571 Setgid}, for how the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of
8572 newly-created parent directories are inherited.
8578 Print a message for each created directory. This is most useful with
8585 @node mkfifo invocation
8586 @section @command{mkfifo}: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
8589 @cindex FIFOs, creating
8590 @cindex named pipes, creating
8591 @cindex creating FIFOs (named pipes)
8593 @command{mkfifo} creates FIFOs (also called @dfn{named pipes}) with the
8594 specified names. Synopsis:
8597 mkfifo [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
8600 A @dfn{FIFO} is a special file type that permits independent processes
8601 to communicate. One process opens the FIFO file for writing, and
8602 another for reading, after which data can flow as with the usual
8603 anonymous pipe in shells or elsewhere.
8605 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8610 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8613 @cindex modes of created FIFOs, setting
8614 Set the mode of created FIFOs to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
8615 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} (read and write allowed for everyone)
8616 for the point of departure. @var{mode} should specify only file
8617 permission bits. @xref{File permissions}.
8624 @node mknod invocation
8625 @section @command{mknod}: Make block or character special files
8628 @cindex block special files, creating
8629 @cindex character special files, creating
8631 @command{mknod} creates a FIFO, character special file, or block special
8632 file with the specified name. Synopsis:
8635 mknod [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name} @var{type} [@var{major} @var{minor}]
8638 @cindex special files
8639 @cindex block special files
8640 @cindex character special files
8641 Unlike the phrase ``special file type'' above, the term @dfn{special
8642 file} has a technical meaning on Unix: something that can generate or
8643 receive data. Usually this corresponds to a physical piece of hardware,
8644 e.g., a printer or a disk. (These files are typically created at
8645 system-configuration time.) The @command{mknod} command is what creates
8646 files of this type. Such devices can be read either a character at a
8647 time or a ``block'' (many characters) at a time, hence we say there are
8648 @dfn{block special} files and @dfn{character special} files.
8650 The arguments after @var{name} specify the type of file to make:
8655 @opindex p @r{for FIFO file}
8659 @opindex b @r{for block special file}
8660 for a block special file
8663 @c Don't document the `u' option -- it's just a synonym for `c'.
8664 @c Do *any* versions of mknod still use it?
8666 @opindex c @r{for character special file}
8667 @c @opindex u @r{for character special file}
8668 for a character special file
8672 When making a block or character special file, the major and minor
8673 device numbers must be given after the file type.
8674 If a major or minor device number begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X},
8675 it is interpreted as hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0},
8676 as octal; otherwise, as decimal.
8678 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8683 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8686 Set the mode of created files to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
8687 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} as the point of departure.
8688 @var{mode} should specify only file permission bits.
8689 @xref{File permissions}.
8696 @node readlink invocation
8697 @section @command{readlink}: Print the referent of a symbolic link
8700 @cindex displaying value of a symbolic link
8702 @command{readlink} may work in one of two supported modes:
8708 @command{readlink} outputs the value of the given symbolic link.
8709 If @command{readlink} is invoked with an argument other than the name
8710 of a symbolic link, it produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8712 @item Canonicalize mode
8714 @command{readlink} outputs the absolute name of the given file which contains
8715 no @file{.}, @file{..} components nor any repeated separators
8716 (@file{/}) or symbolic links.
8721 readlink [@var{option}] @var{file}
8724 By default, @command{readlink} operates in readlink mode.
8726 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8731 @itemx --canonicalize
8733 @opindex --canonicalize
8734 Activate canonicalize mode.
8735 If any component of the file name except the last one is missing or unavailable,
8736 @command{readlink} produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8739 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
8741 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
8742 Activate canonicalize mode.
8743 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} produces
8744 no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8747 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
8749 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
8750 Activate canonicalize mode.
8751 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} treats it
8757 @opindex --no-newline
8758 Do not output the trailing newline.
8768 Suppress most error messages.
8774 Report error messages.
8778 The @command{readlink} utility first appeared in OpenBSD 2.1.
8783 @node rmdir invocation
8784 @section @command{rmdir}: Remove empty directories
8787 @cindex removing empty directories
8788 @cindex directories, removing empty
8790 @command{rmdir} removes empty directories. Synopsis:
8793 rmdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{directory}@dots{}
8796 If any @var{directory} argument does not refer to an existing empty
8797 directory, it is an error.
8799 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8803 @item --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
8804 @opindex --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
8805 @cindex directory deletion, ignoring failures
8806 Ignore each failure to remove a directory that is solely because
8807 the directory is non-empty.
8813 @cindex parent directories, removing
8814 Remove @var{directory}, then try to remove each component of @var{directory}.
8815 So, for example, @samp{rmdir -p a/b/c} is similar to @samp{rmdir a/b/c a/b a}.
8816 As such, it fails if any of those directories turns out not to be empty.
8817 Use the @option{--ignore-fail-on-non-empty} option to make it so such
8818 a failure does not evoke a diagnostic and does not cause @command{rmdir} to
8819 exit unsuccessfully.
8825 @cindex directory deletion, reporting
8826 Give a diagnostic for each successful removal.
8827 @var{directory} is removed.
8831 @xref{rm invocation}, for how to remove non-empty directories (recursively).
8836 @node unlink invocation
8837 @section @command{unlink}: Remove files via the unlink syscall
8840 @cindex removing files or directories (via the unlink syscall)
8842 @command{unlink} deletes a single specified file name.
8843 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
8844 @code{unlink} function. @xref{Deleting Files, , , libc,
8845 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. Synopsis:
8846 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
8847 @command{rm} command (@pxref{rm invocation}).
8850 unlink @var{filename}
8853 On some systems @code{unlink} can be used to delete the name of a
8854 directory. On others, it can be used that way only by a privileged user.
8855 In the GNU system @code{unlink} can never delete the name of a directory.
8857 The @command{unlink} command honors the @option{--help} and
8858 @option{--version} options. To remove a file whose name begins with
8859 @samp{-}, prefix the name with @samp{./}, e.g., @samp{unlink ./--help}.
8864 @node Changing file attributes
8865 @chapter Changing file attributes
8867 @cindex changing file attributes
8868 @cindex file attributes, changing
8869 @cindex attributes, file
8871 A file is not merely its contents, a name, and a file type
8872 (@pxref{Special file types}). A file also has an owner (a user ID), a
8873 group (a group ID), permissions (what the owner can do with the file,
8874 what people in the group can do, and what everyone else can do), various
8875 timestamps, and other information. Collectively, we call these a file's
8878 These commands change file attributes.
8881 * chgrp invocation:: Change file groups.
8882 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions.
8883 * chown invocation:: Change file owners and groups.
8884 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps.
8888 @node chown invocation
8889 @section @command{chown}: Change file owner and group
8892 @cindex file ownership, changing
8893 @cindex group ownership, changing
8894 @cindex changing file ownership
8895 @cindex changing group ownership
8897 @command{chown} changes the user and/or group ownership of each given @var{file}
8898 to @var{new-owner} or to the user and group of an existing reference file.
8902 chown [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{new-owner} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
8905 If used, @var{new-owner} specifies the new owner and/or group as follows
8906 (with no embedded white space):
8909 [@var{owner}] [ : [@var{group}] ]
8916 If only an @var{owner} (a user name or numeric user ID) is given, that
8917 user is made the owner of each given file, and the files' group is not
8920 @item owner@samp{:}group
8921 If the @var{owner} is followed by a colon and a @var{group} (a
8922 group name or numeric group ID), with no spaces between them, the group
8923 ownership of the files is changed as well (to @var{group}).
8926 If a colon but no group name follows @var{owner}, that user is
8927 made the owner of the files and the group of the files is changed to
8928 @var{owner}'s login group.
8931 If the colon and following @var{group} are given, but the owner
8932 is omitted, only the group of the files is changed; in this case,
8933 @command{chown} performs the same function as @command{chgrp}.
8936 If only a colon is given, or if @var{new-owner} is empty, neither the
8937 owner nor the group is changed.
8941 If @var{owner} or @var{group} is intended to represent a numeric user
8942 or group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
8943 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
8945 Some older scripts may still use @samp{.} in place of the @samp{:} separator.
8946 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) does not
8947 require support for that, but for backward compatibility @acronym{GNU}
8948 @command{chown} supports @samp{.} so long as no ambiguity results.
8949 New scripts should avoid the use of @samp{.} because it is not
8950 portable, and because it has undesirable results if the entire
8951 @var{owner@samp{.}group} happens to identify a user whose name
8954 The @command{chown} command sometimes clears the set-user-ID or
8955 set-group-ID permission bits. This behavior depends on the policy and
8956 functionality of the underlying @code{chown} system call, which may
8957 make system-dependent file mode modifications outside the control of
8958 the @command{chown} command. For example, the @command{chown} command
8959 might not affect those bits when invoked by a user with appropriate
8960 privileges, or when the
8961 bits signify some function other than executable permission (e.g.,
8963 When in doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
8965 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8973 @cindex changed owners, verbosely describing
8974 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose ownership
8983 @cindex error messages, omitting
8984 Do not print error messages about files whose ownership cannot be
8987 @itemx @w{@kbd{--from}=@var{old-owner}}
8989 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
8990 Change a @var{file}'s ownership only if it has current attributes specified
8991 by @var{old-owner}. @var{old-owner} has the same form as @var{new-owner}
8993 This option is useful primarily from a security standpoint in that
8994 it narrows considerably the window of potential abuse.
8995 For example, to reflect a user ID numbering change for one user's files
8996 without an option like this, @code{root} might run
8999 find / -owner OLDUSER -print0 | xargs -0 chown -h NEWUSER
9002 But that is dangerous because the interval between when the @command{find}
9003 tests the existing file's owner and when the @command{chown} is actually run
9005 One way to narrow the gap would be to invoke chown for each file
9009 find / -owner OLDUSER -exec chown -h NEWUSER @{@} \;
9012 But that is very slow if there are many affected files.
9013 With this option, it is safer (the gap is narrower still)
9014 though still not perfect:
9017 chown -h -R --from=OLDUSER NEWUSER /
9021 @opindex --dereference
9022 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9024 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
9025 This is the default.
9028 @itemx --no-dereference
9030 @opindex --no-dereference
9031 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9033 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
9034 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
9035 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
9036 @command{chown} fails when a file specified on the command line
9038 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
9039 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
9041 @itemx --preserve-root
9042 @opindex --preserve-root
9043 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9044 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9045 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9046 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9048 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9049 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9050 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9051 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9052 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9054 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9055 @opindex --reference
9056 Change the user and group of each @var{file} to be the same as those of
9057 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
9058 user and group of the symbolic link, but rather those of the file it
9065 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
9066 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
9067 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
9068 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
9069 its referent is being changed.
9074 @opindex --recursive
9075 @cindex recursively changing file ownership
9076 Recursively change ownership of directories and their contents.
9079 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9082 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9085 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9094 # Change the owner of /u to "root".
9097 # Likewise, but also change its group to "staff".
9100 # Change the owner of /u and subfiles to "root".
9105 @node chgrp invocation
9106 @section @command{chgrp}: Change group ownership
9109 @cindex group ownership, changing
9110 @cindex changing group ownership
9112 @command{chgrp} changes the group ownership of each given @var{file}
9113 to @var{group} (which can be either a group name or a numeric group ID)
9114 or to the group of an existing reference file. Synopsis:
9117 chgrp [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{group} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
9120 If @var{group} is intended to represent a
9121 numeric group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
9122 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
9124 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9132 @cindex changed files, verbosely describing
9133 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose group actually
9142 @cindex error messages, omitting
9143 Do not print error messages about files whose group cannot be
9147 @opindex --dereference
9148 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9150 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
9151 This is the default.
9154 @itemx --no-dereference
9156 @opindex --no-dereference
9157 @cindex symbolic links, changing group
9159 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
9160 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
9161 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
9162 @command{chgrp} fails when a file specified on the command line
9164 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
9165 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
9167 @itemx --preserve-root
9168 @opindex --preserve-root
9169 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9170 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9171 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9172 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9174 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9175 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9176 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9177 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9178 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9180 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9181 @opindex --reference
9182 Change the group of each @var{file} to be the same as that of
9183 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
9184 group of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
9190 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
9191 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
9192 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
9193 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
9194 its referent is being changed.
9199 @opindex --recursive
9200 @cindex recursively changing group ownership
9201 Recursively change the group ownership of directories and their contents.
9204 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9207 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9210 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9219 # Change the group of /u to "staff".
9222 # Change the group of /u and subfiles to "staff".
9227 @node chmod invocation
9228 @section @command{chmod}: Change access permissions
9231 @cindex changing access permissions
9232 @cindex access permissions, changing
9233 @cindex permissions, changing access
9235 @command{chmod} changes the access permissions of the named files. Synopsis:
9238 chmod [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{mode} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
9241 @cindex symbolic links, permissions of
9242 @command{chmod} never changes the permissions of symbolic links, since
9243 the @command{chmod} system call cannot change their permissions.
9244 This is not a problem since the permissions of symbolic links are
9245 never used. However, for each symbolic link listed on the command
9246 line, @command{chmod} changes the permissions of the pointed-to file.
9247 In contrast, @command{chmod} ignores symbolic links encountered during
9248 recursive directory traversals.
9250 A successful use of @command{chmod} clears the set-group-ID bit of a
9251 regular file if the file's group ID does not match the user's
9252 effective group ID or one of the user's supplementary group IDs,
9253 unless the user has appropriate privileges. Additional restrictions
9254 may cause the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of @var{mode} or
9255 @var{ref_file} to be ignored. This behavior depends on the policy and
9256 functionality of the underlying @code{chmod} system call. When in
9257 doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
9259 If used, @var{mode} specifies the new file mode bits.
9260 For details, see the section on @ref{File permissions}.
9261 If you really want @var{mode} to have a leading @samp{-}, you should
9262 use @option{--} first, e.g., @samp{chmod -- -w file}. Typically,
9263 though, @samp{chmod a-w file} is preferable, and @command{chmod -w
9264 file} (without the @option{--}) complains if it behaves differently
9265 from what @samp{chmod a-w file} would do.
9267 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9275 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose permissions
9284 @cindex error messages, omitting
9285 Do not print error messages about files whose permissions cannot be
9288 @itemx --preserve-root
9289 @opindex --preserve-root
9290 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9291 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9292 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9293 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9295 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9296 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9297 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9298 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9299 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9305 Verbosely describe the action or non-action taken for every @var{file}.
9307 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9308 @opindex --reference
9309 Change the mode of each @var{file} to be the same as that of @var{ref_file}.
9310 @xref{File permissions}.
9311 If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the mode
9312 of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
9317 @opindex --recursive
9318 @cindex recursively changing access permissions
9319 Recursively change permissions of directories and their contents.
9326 @node touch invocation
9327 @section @command{touch}: Change file timestamps
9330 @cindex changing file timestamps
9331 @cindex file timestamps, changing
9332 @cindex timestamps, changing file
9334 @command{touch} changes the access and/or modification times of the
9335 specified files. Synopsis:
9338 touch [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
9341 @cindex empty files, creating
9342 Any @var{file} argument that does not exist is created empty.
9344 A @var{file} argument string of @samp{-} is handled specially and
9345 causes @command{touch} to change the times of the file associated with
9348 @cindex permissions, for changing file timestamps
9349 If changing both the access and modification times to the current
9350 time, @command{touch} can change the timestamps for files that the user
9351 running it does not own but has write permission for. Otherwise, the
9352 user must own the files.
9354 Although @command{touch} provides options for changing two of the times---the
9355 times of last access and modification---of a file, there is actually
9356 a third one as well: the inode change time. This is often referred to
9357 as a file's @code{ctime}.
9358 The inode change time represents the time when the file's meta-information
9359 last changed. One common example of this is when the permissions of a
9360 file change. Changing the permissions doesn't access the file, so
9361 the atime doesn't change, nor does it modify the file, so the mtime
9362 doesn't change. Yet, something about the file itself has changed,
9363 and this must be noted somewhere. This is the job of the ctime field.
9364 This is necessary, so that, for example, a backup program can make a
9365 fresh copy of the file, including the new permissions value.
9366 Another operation that modifies a file's ctime without affecting
9367 the others is renaming. In any case, it is not possible, in normal
9368 operations, for a user to change the ctime field to a user-specified value.
9371 Time stamps assume the time zone rules specified by the @env{TZ}
9372 environment variable, or by the system default rules if @env{TZ} is
9373 not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with @env{TZ},
9374 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
9375 You can avoid ambiguities during
9376 daylight saving transitions by using @sc{utc} time stamps.
9378 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9384 @itemx --time=access
9388 @opindex atime@r{, changing}
9389 @opindex access @r{time, changing}
9390 @opindex use @r{time, changing}
9391 Change the access time only.
9396 @opindex --no-create
9397 Do not create files that do not exist.
9400 @itemx --date=@var{time}
9404 Use @var{time} instead of the current time. It can contain month names,
9405 time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm}, @samp{yesterday}, etc. For
9406 example, @option{--date="2004-02-27 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"}
9407 specifies the instant of time that is 489,392,193 nanoseconds after
9408 February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a time zone that is 5 hours and 30
9409 minutes east of @acronym{UTC}. @xref{Date input formats}.
9410 File systems that do not support high-resolution time stamps
9411 silently ignore any excess precision here.
9415 @cindex BSD @command{touch} compatibility
9416 Ignored; for compatibility with BSD versions of @command{touch}.
9420 @itemx --time=modify
9423 @opindex mtime@r{, changing}
9424 @opindex modify @r{time, changing}
9425 Change the modification time only.
9428 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
9430 @opindex --reference
9431 Use the times of the reference @var{file} instead of the current time.
9432 If this option is combined with the @option{--date=@var{time}}
9433 (@option{-d @var{time}}) option, the reference @var{file}'s time is
9434 the origin for any relative @var{time}s given, but is otherwise ignored.
9435 For example, @samp{-r foo -d '-5 seconds'} specifies a time stamp
9436 equal to five seconds before the corresponding time stamp for @file{foo}.
9438 @item -t [[@var{CC}]@var{YY}]@var{MMDDhhmm}[.@var{ss}]
9439 Use the argument (optional four-digit or two-digit years, months,
9440 days, hours, minutes, optional seconds) instead of the current time.
9441 If the year is specified with only two digits, then @var{CC}
9442 is 20 for years in the range 0 @dots{} 68, and 19 for years in
9443 69 @dots{} 99. If no digits of the year are specified,
9444 the argument is interpreted as a date in the current year.
9448 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
9449 On older systems, @command{touch} supports an obsolete syntax, as follows.
9450 If no timestamp is given with any of the @option{-d}, @option{-r}, or
9451 @option{-t} options, and if there are two or more @var{file}s and the
9452 first @var{file} is of the form @samp{@var{MMDDhhmm}[@var{YY}]} and this
9453 would be a valid argument to the @option{-t} option (if the @var{YY}, if
9454 any, were moved to the front), and if the represented year
9455 is in the range 1969--1999, that argument is interpreted as the time
9456 for the other files instead of as a file name.
9457 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
9458 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
9459 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
9460 behavior depends on this variable.
9461 For example, use @samp{touch ./12312359 main.c} or @samp{touch -t
9462 12312359 main.c} rather than the ambiguous @samp{touch 12312359 main.c}.
9472 No disk can hold an infinite amount of data. These commands report
9473 how much disk storage is in use or available, report other file and
9474 file status information, and write buffers to disk.
9477 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage.
9478 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage.
9479 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status.
9480 * sync invocation:: Synchronize memory and disk.
9485 @section @command{df}: Report file system disk space usage
9488 @cindex file system disk usage
9489 @cindex disk usage by file system
9491 @command{df} reports the amount of disk space used and available on
9492 file systems. Synopsis:
9495 df [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9498 With no arguments, @command{df} reports the space used and available on all
9499 currently mounted file systems (of all types). Otherwise, @command{df}
9500 reports on the file system containing each argument @var{file}.
9502 Normally the disk space is printed in units of
9503 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
9504 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
9506 @cindex disk device file
9507 @cindex device file, disk
9508 If an argument @var{file} is a disk device file containing a mounted
9509 file system, @command{df} shows the space available on that file system
9510 rather than on the file system containing the device node (i.e., the root
9511 file system). @sc{gnu} @command{df} does not attempt to determine the disk usage
9512 on unmounted file systems, because on most kinds of systems doing so
9513 requires extremely nonportable intimate knowledge of file system
9516 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9524 @cindex automounter file systems
9525 @cindex ignore file systems
9526 Include in the listing dummy file systems, which
9527 are omitted by default. Such file systems are typically special-purpose
9528 pseudo-file-systems, such as automounter entries.
9531 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
9533 @opindex --block-size
9534 @cindex file system sizes
9535 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
9536 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
9542 Equivalent to @option{--si}.
9549 List inode usage information instead of block usage. An inode (short
9550 for index node) contains information about a file such as its owner,
9551 permissions, timestamps, and location on the disk.
9555 @cindex kibibytes for file system sizes
9556 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9557 (@pxref{Block size}).
9558 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
9564 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
9565 Limit the listing to local file systems. By default, remote file systems
9570 @cindex file system space, retrieving old data more quickly
9571 Do not invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data.
9572 This may make @command{df} run significantly faster on systems with many
9573 disks, but on some systems (notably SunOS) the results may be slightly
9574 out of date. This is the default.
9577 @itemx --portability
9579 @opindex --portability
9580 @cindex one-line output format
9581 @cindex @acronym{POSIX} output format
9582 @cindex portable output format
9583 @cindex output format, portable
9584 Use the @acronym{POSIX} output format. This is like the default format except
9589 The information about each file system is always printed on exactly
9590 one line; a mount device is never put on a line by itself. This means
9591 that if the mount device name is more than 20 characters long (e.g., for
9592 some network mounts), the columns are misaligned.
9595 The labels in the header output line are changed to conform to @acronym{POSIX}.
9598 The default block size and output format are unaffected by the
9599 @env{DF_BLOCK_SIZE}, @env{BLOCK_SIZE} and @env{BLOCKSIZE} environment
9600 variables. However, the default block size is still affected by
9601 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}: it is 512 if @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, 1024
9602 otherwise. @xref{Block size}.
9609 @cindex file system space, retrieving current data more slowly
9610 Invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data. On
9611 some systems (notably SunOS), doing this yields more up to date results,
9612 but in general this option makes @command{df} much slower, especially when
9613 there are many or very busy file systems.
9615 @item -t @var{fstype}
9616 @itemx --type=@var{fstype}
9619 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
9620 Limit the listing to file systems of type @var{fstype}. Multiple
9621 file system types can be specified by giving multiple @option{-t} options.
9622 By default, nothing is omitted.
9627 @opindex --print-type
9628 @cindex file system types, printing
9629 Print each file system's type. The types printed here are the same ones
9630 you can include or exclude with @option{-t} and @option{-x}. The particular
9631 types printed are whatever is supported by the system. Here are some of
9632 the common names (this list is certainly not exhaustive):
9637 @cindex @acronym{NFS} file system type
9638 An @acronym{NFS} file system, i.e., one mounted over a network from another
9639 machine. This is the one type name which seems to be used uniformly by
9642 @item 4.2@r{, }ufs@r{, }efs@dots{}
9643 @cindex Linux file system types
9644 @cindex local file system types
9645 @opindex 4.2 @r{file system type}
9646 @opindex ufs @r{file system type}
9647 @opindex efs @r{file system type}
9648 A file system on a locally-mounted hard disk. (The system might even
9649 support more than one type here; Linux does.)
9651 @item hsfs@r{, }cdfs
9652 @cindex CD-ROM file system type
9653 @cindex High Sierra file system
9654 @opindex hsfs @r{file system type}
9655 @opindex cdfs @r{file system type}
9656 A file system on a CD-ROM drive. HP-UX uses @samp{cdfs}, most other
9657 systems use @samp{hsfs} (@samp{hs} for ``High Sierra'').
9660 @cindex PC file system
9661 @cindex DOS file system
9662 @cindex MS-DOS file system
9663 @cindex diskette file system
9665 An MS-DOS file system, usually on a diskette.
9669 @item -x @var{fstype}
9670 @itemx --exclude-type=@var{fstype}
9672 @opindex --exclude-type
9673 Limit the listing to file systems not of type @var{fstype}.
9674 Multiple file system types can be eliminated by giving multiple
9675 @option{-x} options. By default, no file system types are omitted.
9678 Ignored; for compatibility with System V versions of @command{df}.
9683 Failure includes the case where no output is generated, so you can
9684 inspect the exit status of a command like @samp{df -t ext3 -t reiserfs
9685 @var{dir}} to test whether @var{dir} is on a file system of type
9686 @samp{ext3} or @samp{reiserfs}.
9690 @section @command{du}: Estimate file space usage
9693 @cindex file space usage
9694 @cindex disk usage for files
9696 @command{du} reports the amount of disk space used by the specified files
9697 and for each subdirectory (of directory arguments). Synopsis:
9700 du [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9703 With no arguments, @command{du} reports the disk space for the current
9704 directory. Normally the disk space is printed in units of
9705 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
9706 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
9708 If two or more hard links point to the same file, only one of the hard
9709 links is counted. The @var{file} argument order affects which links
9710 are counted, and changing the argument order may change the numbers
9711 that @command{du} outputs.
9713 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9721 Show counts for all files, not just directories.
9723 @itemx --apparent-size
9724 @opindex --apparent-size
9725 Print apparent sizes, rather than disk usage. The apparent size of a
9726 file is the number of bytes reported by @code{wc -c} on regular files,
9727 or more generally, @code{ls -l --block-size=1} or @code{stat --format=%s}.
9728 For example, a file containing the word @samp{zoo} with no newline would,
9729 of course, have an apparent size of 3. Such a small file may require
9730 anywhere from 0 to 16 KiB or more of disk space, depending on
9731 the type and configuration of the file system on which the file resides.
9732 However, a sparse file created with this command:
9735 dd bs=1 seek=2GiB if=/dev/null of=big
9739 has an apparent size of 2 GiB, yet on most modern
9740 systems, it actually uses almost no disk space.
9746 Equivalent to @code{--apparent-size --block-size=1}.
9749 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
9751 @opindex --block-size
9753 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
9754 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
9760 @cindex grand total of disk space
9761 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
9762 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk usage of
9763 a given set of files or directories.
9766 @itemx --dereference-args
9768 @opindex --dereference-args
9769 Dereference symbolic links that are command line arguments.
9770 Does not affect other symbolic links. This is helpful for finding
9771 out the disk usage of directories, such as @file{/usr/tmp}, which
9772 are often symbolic links.
9774 @c --files0-from=FILE
9775 @filesZeroFromOption{du, with the @option{--total} (@option{-c}) option}
9781 Currently, @option{-H} is the same as @option{--si},
9782 except that @option{-H} evokes a warning.
9783 This option will be changed to be equivalent to
9784 @option{--dereference-args} (@option{-D}).
9788 @cindex kibibytes for file sizes
9789 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9790 (@pxref{Block size}).
9791 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
9794 @itemx --count-links
9796 @opindex --count-links
9797 @cindex hard links, counting in @command{du}
9798 Count the size of all files, even if they have appeared already (as a
9802 @itemx --dereference
9804 @opindex --dereference
9805 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
9806 Dereference symbolic links (show the disk space used by the file
9807 or directory that the link points to instead of the space used by
9812 @cindex mebibytes for file sizes
9813 Print sizes in 1,048,576-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9814 (@pxref{Block size}).
9815 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1M}.
9818 @itemx --no-dereference
9820 @opindex --no-dereference
9821 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
9822 For each symbolic links encountered by @command{du},
9823 consider the disk space used by the symbolic link.
9825 @item --max-depth=@var{DEPTH}
9826 @opindex --max-depth=@var{DEPTH}
9827 @cindex limiting output of @command{du}
9828 Show the total for each directory (and file if --all) that is at
9829 most MAX_DEPTH levels down from the root of the hierarchy. The root
9830 is at level 0, so @code{du --max-depth=0} is equivalent to @code{du -s}.
9836 @cindex output null-byte-terminated lines
9837 Output a null byte at the end of each line, rather than a newline.
9838 This option enables other programs to parse the output of @command{du}
9839 even when that output would contain file names with embedded newlines.
9846 @opindex --summarize
9847 Display only a total for each argument.
9850 @itemx --separate-dirs
9852 @opindex --separate-dirs
9853 Normally, in the output of @command{du} (when not using @option{--summarize}),
9854 the size listed next to a directory name, @var{d}, represents the sum
9855 of sizes of all entries beneath @var{d} as well as the size of @var{d} itself.
9856 With @option{--separate-dirs}, the size reported for a directory name,
9857 @var{d}, is merely the @code{stat.st_size}-derived size of the directory
9862 @cindex last modified dates, displaying in @command{du}
9863 Show time of the most recent modification of any file in the directory,
9864 or any of its subdirectories.
9867 @itemx --time=status
9870 @opindex ctime@r{, show the most recent}
9871 @opindex status time@r{, show the most recent}
9872 @opindex use time@r{, show the most recent}
9873 Show the most recent status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) of
9874 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
9877 @itemx --time=access
9879 @opindex atime@r{, show the most recent}
9880 @opindex access time@r{, show the most recent}
9881 Show the most recent access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode) of
9882 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
9884 @item --time-style=@var{style}
9885 @opindex --time-style
9887 List timestamps in style @var{style}. This option has an effect only if
9888 the @option{--time} option is also specified. The @var{style} should
9889 be one of the following:
9894 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
9895 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
9896 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
9897 @command{du} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
9898 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
9899 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
9902 List timestamps in full using @acronym{ISO} 8601 date, time, and time zone
9903 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
9904 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
9905 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
9908 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
9909 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
9910 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
9911 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
9914 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 dates for timestamps, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30}.
9915 This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d}.
9919 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
9920 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
9921 the default style is @samp{long-iso}. For compatibility with @command{ls},
9922 if @env{TIME_STYLE} begins with @samp{+} and contains a newline,
9923 the newline and any later characters are ignored; if @env{TIME_STYLE}
9924 begins with @samp{posix-} the @samp{posix-} is ignored; and if
9925 @env{TIME_STYLE} is @samp{locale} it is ignored.
9928 @itemx --one-file-system
9930 @opindex --one-file-system
9931 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{du} to
9932 Skip directories that are on different file systems from the one that
9933 the argument being processed is on.
9935 @item --exclude=@var{PATTERN}
9936 @opindex --exclude=@var{PATTERN}
9937 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
9938 When recursing, skip subdirectories or files matching @var{PATTERN}.
9939 For example, @code{du --exclude='*.o'} excludes files whose names
9943 @itemx --exclude-from=@var{FILE}
9944 @opindex -X @var{FILE}
9945 @opindex --exclude-from=@var{FILE}
9946 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
9947 Like @option{--exclude}, except take the patterns to exclude from @var{FILE},
9948 one per line. If @var{FILE} is @samp{-}, take the patterns from standard
9953 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
9954 On BSD systems, @command{du} reports sizes that are half the correct
9955 values for files that are NFS-mounted from HP-UX systems. On HP-UX
9956 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for
9957 files that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw
9958 in HP-UX; it also affects the HP-UX @command{du} program.
9963 @node stat invocation
9964 @section @command{stat}: Report file or file system status
9968 @cindex file system status
9970 @command{stat} displays information about the specified file(s). Synopsis:
9973 stat [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9976 With no option, @command{stat} reports all information about the given files.
9977 But it also can be used to report the information of the file systems the
9978 given files are located on. If the files are links, @command{stat} can
9979 also give information about the files the links point to.
9985 @itemx --dereference
9987 @opindex --dereference
9988 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{stat}
9989 Change how @command{stat} treats symbolic links.
9990 With this option, @command{stat} acts on the file referenced
9991 by each symbolic link argument.
9992 Without it, @command{stat} acts on any symbolic link argument directly.
9995 @itemx --file-system
9997 @opindex --file-system
9998 @cindex file systems
9999 Report information about the file systems where the given files are located
10000 instead of information about the files themselves.
10003 @itemx --format=@var{format}
10005 @opindex --format=@var{format}
10006 @cindex output format
10007 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
10008 @var{format} is automatically newline-terminated, so
10009 running a command like the following with two or more @var{file}
10010 operands produces a line of output for each operand:
10012 $ stat --format=%d:%i / /usr
10017 @itemx --printf=@var{format}
10018 @opindex --printf=@var{format}
10019 @cindex output format
10020 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
10021 Like @option{--format}, but interpret backslash escapes,
10022 and do not output a mandatory trailing newline.
10023 If you want a newline, include @samp{\n} in the @var{format}.
10024 Here's how you would use @option{--printf} to print the device
10025 and inode numbers of @file{/} and @file{/usr}:
10027 $ stat --printf='%d:%i\n' / /usr
10036 @cindex terse output
10037 Print the information in terse form, suitable for parsing by other programs.
10039 The valid format sequences for files are:
10042 @item %a - Access rights in octal
10043 @item %A - Access rights in human readable form
10044 @item %b - Number of blocks allocated (see @samp{%B})
10045 @item %B - The size in bytes of each block reported by @samp{%b}
10046 @item %d - Device number in decimal
10047 @item %D - Device number in hex
10048 @item %f - Raw mode in hex
10049 @item %F - File type
10050 @item %g - Group ID of owner
10051 @item %G - Group name of owner
10052 @item %h - Number of hard links
10053 @item %i - Inode number
10054 @item %n - File name
10055 @item %N - Quoted file name with dereference if symbolic link
10056 @item %o - I/O block size
10057 @item %s - Total size, in bytes
10058 @item %t - Major device type in hex
10059 @item %T - Minor device type in hex
10060 @item %u - User ID of owner
10061 @item %U - User name of owner
10062 @item %x - Time of last access
10063 @item %X - Time of last access as seconds since Epoch
10064 @item %y - Time of last modification
10065 @item %Y - Time of last modification as seconds since Epoch
10066 @item %z - Time of last change
10067 @item %Z - Time of last change as seconds since Epoch
10070 The valid format sequences for file systems are:
10073 @item %a - Free blocks available to non-super-user
10074 @item %b - Total data blocks in file system
10075 @item %c - Total file nodes in file system
10076 @item %d - Free file nodes in file system
10077 @item %f - Free blocks in file system
10078 @item %i - File System ID in hex
10079 @item %l - Maximum length of file names
10080 @item %n - File name
10081 @item %s - Block size (for faster transfers)
10082 @item %S - Fundamental block size (for block counts)
10083 @item %t - Type in hex
10084 @item %T - Type in human readable form
10088 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
10089 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
10090 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
10091 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10097 @node sync invocation
10098 @section @command{sync}: Synchronize data on disk with memory
10101 @cindex synchronize disk and memory
10103 @cindex superblock, writing
10104 @cindex inodes, written buffered
10105 @command{sync} writes any data buffered in memory out to disk. This can
10106 include (but is not limited to) modified superblocks, modified inodes,
10107 and delayed reads and writes. This must be implemented by the kernel;
10108 The @command{sync} program does nothing but exercise the @code{sync} system
10111 @cindex crashes and corruption
10112 The kernel keeps data in memory to avoid doing (relatively slow) disk
10113 reads and writes. This improves performance, but if the computer
10114 crashes, data may be lost or the file system corrupted as a
10115 result. The @command{sync} command ensures everything in memory
10116 is written to disk.
10118 Any arguments are ignored, except for a lone @option{--help} or
10119 @option{--version} (@pxref{Common options}).
10124 @node Printing text
10125 @chapter Printing text
10127 @cindex printing text, commands for
10128 @cindex commands for printing text
10130 This section describes commands that display text strings.
10133 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text.
10134 * printf invocation:: Format and print data.
10135 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted.
10139 @node echo invocation
10140 @section @command{echo}: Print a line of text
10143 @cindex displaying text
10144 @cindex printing text
10145 @cindex text, displaying
10146 @cindex arbitrary text, displaying
10148 @command{echo} writes each given @var{string} to standard output, with a
10149 space between each and a newline after the last one. Synopsis:
10152 echo [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{string}]@dots{}
10155 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10156 Options must precede operands, and the normally-special argument
10157 @samp{--} has no special meaning and is treated like any other
10163 Do not output the trailing newline.
10167 @cindex backslash escapes
10168 Enable interpretation of the following backslash-escaped characters in
10177 suppress trailing newline
10191 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
10192 (zero to three octal digits)
10194 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
10195 (one to three octal digits)
10197 the eight-bit value that is the hexadecimal number @var{hh}
10198 (one or two hexadecimal digits)
10203 @cindex backslash escapes
10204 Disable interpretation of backslash escapes in each @var{string}.
10205 This is the default. If @option{-e} and @option{-E} are both
10206 specified, the last one given takes effect.
10210 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
10211 If the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, then when
10212 @command{echo}'s first argument is not @option{-n} it outputs
10213 option-like arguments instead of treating them as options. For
10214 example, @code{echo -ne hello} outputs @samp{-ne hello} instead of
10215 plain @samp{hello}.
10217 @acronym{POSIX} does not require support for any options, and says
10218 that the behavior of @command{echo} is implementation-defined if any
10219 @var{string} contains a backslash or if the first argument is
10220 @option{-n}. Portable programs can use the @command{printf} command
10221 if they need to omit trailing newlines or output control characters or
10222 backslashes. @xref{printf invocation}.
10227 @node printf invocation
10228 @section @command{printf}: Format and print data
10231 @command{printf} does formatted printing of text. Synopsis:
10234 printf @var{format} [@var{argument}]@dots{}
10237 @command{printf} prints the @var{format} string, interpreting @samp{%}
10238 directives and @samp{\} escapes to format numeric and string arguments
10239 in a way that is mostly similar to the C @samp{printf} function.
10240 @xref{Output Conversion Syntax,, @command{printf} format directives,
10241 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for details.
10242 The differences are as follows:
10247 The @var{format} argument is reused as necessary to convert all the
10248 given @var{argument}s. For example, the command @samp{printf %s a b}
10252 Missing @var{argument}s are treated as null strings or as zeros,
10253 depending on whether the context expects a string or a number. For
10254 example, the command @samp{printf %sx%d} prints @samp{x0}.
10258 An additional escape, @samp{\c}, causes @command{printf} to produce no
10259 further output. For example, the command @samp{printf 'A%sC\cD%sF' B
10260 E} prints @samp{ABC}.
10263 The hexadecimal escape sequence @samp{\x@var{hh}} has at most two
10264 digits, as opposed to C where it can have an unlimited number of
10265 digits. For example, the command @samp{printf '\x07e'} prints two
10266 bytes, whereas the C statement @samp{printf ("\x07e")} prints just
10271 @command{printf} has an additional directive, @samp{%b}, which prints its
10272 argument string with @samp{\} escapes interpreted in the same way as in
10273 the @var{format} string, except that octal escapes are of the form
10274 @samp{\0@var{ooo}} where @var{ooo} is 0 to 3 octal digits.
10275 If a precision is also given, it limits the number of bytes printed
10276 from the converted string.
10279 Numeric arguments must be single C constants, possibly with leading
10280 @samp{+} or @samp{-}. For example, @samp{printf %.4d -3} outputs
10284 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
10285 If the leading character of a numeric argument is @samp{"} or @samp{'}
10286 then its value is the numeric value of the immediately following
10287 character. Any remaining characters are silently ignored if the
10288 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set; otherwise, a
10289 warning is printed. For example, @samp{printf "%d" "'a"} outputs
10290 @samp{97} on hosts that use the @acronym{ASCII} character set, since
10291 @samp{a} has the numeric value 97 in @acronym{ASCII}.
10296 A floating-point argument must use a period before any fractional
10297 digits, but is printed according to the @env{LC_NUMERIC} category of the
10298 current locale. For example, in a locale whose radix character is a
10299 comma, the command @samp{printf %g 3.14} outputs @samp{3,14} whereas
10300 the command @samp{printf %g 3,14} is an error.
10304 @command{printf} interprets @samp{\@var{ooo}} in @var{format} as an octal number
10305 (if @var{ooo} is 1 to 3 octal digits) specifying a character to print,
10306 and @samp{\x@var{hh}} as a hexadecimal number (if @var{hh} is 1 to 2 hex
10307 digits) specifying a character to print.
10312 @cindex ISO/IEC 10646
10314 @command{printf} interprets two character syntaxes introduced in
10315 @acronym{ISO} C 99:
10316 @samp{\u} for 16-bit Unicode (@acronym{ISO}/@acronym{IEC} 10646)
10317 characters, specified as
10318 four hexadecimal digits @var{hhhh}, and @samp{\U} for 32-bit Unicode
10319 characters, specified as eight hexadecimal digits @var{hhhhhhhh}.
10320 @command{printf} outputs the Unicode characters
10321 according to the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale. Unicode characters in the ranges
10322 U+0000...U+009F, U+D800...U+DFFF cannot be specified by this syntax, except
10323 for U+0024 ($), U+0040 (@@), and U+0060 (@`).
10325 The processing of @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} requires a full-featured
10326 @code{iconv} facility. It is activated on systems with glibc 2.2 (or newer),
10327 or when @code{libiconv} is installed prior to this package. Otherwise
10328 @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} will print as-is.
10330 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
10331 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
10332 Options must precede operands.
10334 The Unicode character syntaxes are useful for writing strings in a locale
10335 independent way. For example, a string containing the Euro currency symbol
10338 $ /usr/local/bin/printf '\u20AC 14.95'
10342 will be output correctly in all locales supporting the Euro symbol
10343 (@acronym{ISO}-8859-15, UTF-8, and others). Similarly, a Chinese string
10346 $ /usr/local/bin/printf '\u4e2d\u6587'
10350 will be output correctly in all Chinese locales (GB2312, BIG5, UTF-8, etc).
10352 Note that in these examples, the full name of @command{printf} has been
10353 given, to distinguish it from the GNU @code{bash} built-in function
10356 For larger strings, you don't need to look up the hexadecimal code
10357 values of each character one by one. @acronym{ASCII} characters mixed with \u
10358 escape sequences is also known as the JAVA source file encoding. You can
10359 use GNU recode 3.5c (or newer) to convert strings to this encoding. Here
10360 is how to convert a piece of text into a shell script which will output
10361 this text in a locale-independent way:
10364 $ LC_CTYPE=zh_CN.big5 /usr/local/bin/printf \
10365 '\u4e2d\u6587\n' > sample.txt
10366 $ recode BIG5..JAVA < sample.txt \
10367 | sed -e "s|^|/usr/local/bin/printf '|" -e "s|$|\\\\n'|" \
10374 @node yes invocation
10375 @section @command{yes}: Print a string until interrupted
10378 @cindex repeated output of a string
10380 @command{yes} prints the command line arguments, separated by spaces and
10381 followed by a newline, forever until it is killed. If no arguments are
10382 given, it prints @samp{y} followed by a newline forever until killed.
10384 Upon a write error, @command{yes} exits with status @samp{1}.
10386 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
10387 To output an argument that begins with
10388 @samp{-}, precede it with @option{--}, e.g., @samp{yes -- --help}.
10389 @xref{Common options}.
10393 @chapter Conditions
10396 @cindex commands for exit status
10397 @cindex exit status commands
10399 This section describes commands that are primarily useful for their exit
10400 status, rather than their output. Thus, they are often used as the
10401 condition of shell @code{if} statements, or as the last command in a
10405 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
10406 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully.
10407 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values.
10408 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions.
10412 @node false invocation
10413 @section @command{false}: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
10416 @cindex do nothing, unsuccessfully
10417 @cindex failure exit status
10418 @cindex exit status of @command{false}
10420 @command{false} does nothing except return an exit status of 1, meaning
10421 @dfn{failure}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
10422 where an unsuccessful command is needed.
10423 In most modern shells, @command{false} is a built-in command, so when
10424 you use @samp{false} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
10425 command, not the one documented here.
10427 @command{false} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
10429 This version of @command{false} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
10430 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
10431 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
10433 Note that @command{false} (unlike all other programs documented herein)
10434 exits unsuccessfully, even when invoked with
10435 @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
10437 Portable programs should not assume that the exit status of
10438 @command{false} is 1, as it is greater than 1 on some
10439 non-@acronym{GNU} hosts.
10442 @node true invocation
10443 @section @command{true}: Do nothing, successfully
10446 @cindex do nothing, successfully
10448 @cindex successful exit
10449 @cindex exit status of @command{true}
10451 @command{true} does nothing except return an exit status of 0, meaning
10452 @dfn{success}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
10453 where a successful command is needed, although the shell built-in
10454 command @code{:} (colon) may do the same thing faster.
10455 In most modern shells, @command{true} is a built-in command, so when
10456 you use @samp{true} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
10457 command, not the one documented here.
10459 @command{true} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
10461 Note, however, that it is possible to cause @command{true}
10462 to exit with nonzero status: with the @option{--help} or @option{--version}
10463 option, and with standard
10464 output already closed or redirected to a file that evokes an I/O error.
10465 For example, using a Bourne-compatible shell:
10468 $ ./true --version >&-
10469 ./true: write error: Bad file number
10470 $ ./true --version > /dev/full
10471 ./true: write error: No space left on device
10474 This version of @command{true} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
10475 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
10476 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
10478 @node test invocation
10479 @section @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
10482 @cindex check file types
10483 @cindex compare values
10484 @cindex expression evaluation
10486 @command{test} returns a status of 0 (true) or 1 (false) depending on the
10487 evaluation of the conditional expression @var{expr}. Each part of the
10488 expression must be a separate argument.
10490 @command{test} has file status checks, string operators, and numeric
10491 comparison operators.
10493 @command{test} has an alternate form that uses opening and closing
10494 square brackets instead a leading @samp{test}. For example, instead
10495 of @samp{test -d /}, you can write @samp{[ -d / ]}. The square
10496 brackets must be separate arguments; for example, @samp{[-d /]} does
10497 not have the desired effect. Since @samp{test @var{expr}} and @samp{[
10498 @var{expr} ]} have the same meaning, only the former form is discussed
10504 test @var{expression}
10506 [ @var{expression} ]
10511 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
10512 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
10513 Because most shells have a built-in @command{test} command, using an
10514 unadorned @command{test} in a script or interactively may get you
10515 different functionality than that described here.
10517 If @var{expression} is omitted, @command{test} returns false.
10518 If @var{expression} is a single argument,
10519 @command{test} returns false if the argument is null and true otherwise. The argument
10520 can be any string, including strings like @samp{-d}, @samp{-1},
10521 @samp{--}, @samp{--help}, and @samp{--version} that most other
10522 programs would treat as options. To get help and version information,
10523 invoke the commands @samp{[ --help} and @samp{[ --version}, without
10524 the usual closing brackets. @xref{Common options}.
10526 @cindex exit status of @command{test}
10530 0 if the expression is true,
10531 1 if the expression is false,
10532 2 if an error occurred.
10536 * File type tests:: -[bcdfhLpSt]
10537 * Access permission tests:: -[gkruwxOG]
10538 * File characteristic tests:: -e -s -nt -ot -ef
10539 * String tests:: -z -n = !=
10540 * Numeric tests:: -eq -ne -lt -le -gt -ge
10541 * Connectives for test:: ! -a -o
10545 @node File type tests
10546 @subsection File type tests
10548 @cindex file type tests
10550 These options test for particular types of files. (Everything's a file,
10551 but not all files are the same!)
10555 @item -b @var{file}
10557 @cindex block special check
10558 True if @var{file} exists and is a block special device.
10560 @item -c @var{file}
10562 @cindex character special check
10563 True if @var{file} exists and is a character special device.
10565 @item -d @var{file}
10567 @cindex directory check
10568 True if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
10570 @item -f @var{file}
10572 @cindex regular file check
10573 True if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
10575 @item -h @var{file}
10576 @itemx -L @var{file}
10579 @cindex symbolic link check
10580 True if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
10581 Unlike all other file-related tests, this test does not dereference
10582 @var{file} if it is a symbolic link.
10584 @item -p @var{file}
10586 @cindex named pipe check
10587 True if @var{file} exists and is a named pipe.
10589 @item -S @var{file}
10591 @cindex socket check
10592 True if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
10596 @cindex terminal check
10597 True if @var{fd} is a file descriptor that is associated with a
10603 @node Access permission tests
10604 @subsection Access permission tests
10606 @cindex access permission tests
10607 @cindex permission tests
10609 These options test for particular access permissions.
10613 @item -g @var{file}
10615 @cindex set-group-ID check
10616 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-group-ID bit set.
10618 @item -k @var{file}
10620 @cindex sticky bit check
10621 True if @var{file} exists and has its @dfn{sticky} bit set.
10623 @item -r @var{file}
10625 @cindex readable file check
10626 True if @var{file} exists and read permission is granted.
10628 @item -u @var{file}
10630 @cindex set-user-ID check
10631 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-user-ID bit set.
10633 @item -w @var{file}
10635 @cindex writable file check
10636 True if @var{file} exists and write permission is granted.
10638 @item -x @var{file}
10640 @cindex executable file check
10641 True if @var{file} exists and execute permission is granted
10642 (or search permission, if it is a directory).
10644 @item -O @var{file}
10646 @cindex owned by effective user ID check
10647 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective user ID.
10649 @item -G @var{file}
10651 @cindex owned by effective group ID check
10652 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective group ID.
10656 @node File characteristic tests
10657 @subsection File characteristic tests
10659 @cindex file characteristic tests
10661 These options test other file characteristics.
10665 @item -e @var{file}
10667 @cindex existence-of-file check
10668 True if @var{file} exists.
10670 @item -s @var{file}
10672 @cindex nonempty file check
10673 True if @var{file} exists and has a size greater than zero.
10675 @item @var{file1} -nt @var{file2}
10677 @cindex newer-than file check
10678 True if @var{file1} is newer (according to modification date) than
10679 @var{file2}, or if @var{file1} exists and @var{file2} does not.
10681 @item @var{file1} -ot @var{file2}
10683 @cindex older-than file check
10684 True if @var{file1} is older (according to modification date) than
10685 @var{file2}, or if @var{file2} exists and @var{file1} does not.
10687 @item @var{file1} -ef @var{file2}
10689 @cindex same file check
10690 @cindex hard link check
10691 True if @var{file1} and @var{file2} have the same device and inode
10692 numbers, i.e., if they are hard links to each other.
10698 @subsection String tests
10700 @cindex string tests
10702 These options test string characteristics. You may need to quote
10703 @var{string} arguments for the shell. For example:
10709 The quotes here prevent the wrong arguments from being passed to
10710 @command{test} if @samp{$V} is empty or contains special characters.
10714 @item -z @var{string}
10716 @cindex zero-length string check
10717 True if the length of @var{string} is zero.
10719 @item -n @var{string}
10720 @itemx @var{string}
10722 @cindex nonzero-length string check
10723 True if the length of @var{string} is nonzero.
10725 @item @var{string1} = @var{string2}
10727 @cindex equal string check
10728 True if the strings are equal.
10730 @item @var{string1} != @var{string2}
10732 @cindex not-equal string check
10733 True if the strings are not equal.
10738 @node Numeric tests
10739 @subsection Numeric tests
10741 @cindex numeric tests
10742 @cindex arithmetic tests
10744 Numeric relational operators. The arguments must be entirely numeric
10745 (possibly negative), or the special expression @w{@code{-l @var{string}}},
10746 which evaluates to the length of @var{string}.
10750 @item @var{arg1} -eq @var{arg2}
10751 @itemx @var{arg1} -ne @var{arg2}
10752 @itemx @var{arg1} -lt @var{arg2}
10753 @itemx @var{arg1} -le @var{arg2}
10754 @itemx @var{arg1} -gt @var{arg2}
10755 @itemx @var{arg1} -ge @var{arg2}
10762 These arithmetic binary operators return true if @var{arg1} is equal,
10763 not-equal, less-than, less-than-or-equal, greater-than, or
10764 greater-than-or-equal than @var{arg2}, respectively.
10771 test -1 -gt -2 && echo yes
10773 test -l abc -gt 1 && echo yes
10776 @error{} test: integer expression expected before -eq
10780 @node Connectives for test
10781 @subsection Connectives for @command{test}
10783 @cindex logical connectives
10784 @cindex connectives, logical
10786 The usual logical connectives.
10792 True if @var{expr} is false.
10794 @item @var{expr1} -a @var{expr2}
10796 @cindex logical and operator
10797 @cindex and operator
10798 True if both @var{expr1} and @var{expr2} are true.
10800 @item @var{expr1} -o @var{expr2}
10802 @cindex logical or operator
10803 @cindex or operator
10804 True if either @var{expr1} or @var{expr2} is true.
10809 @node expr invocation
10810 @section @command{expr}: Evaluate expressions
10813 @cindex expression evaluation
10814 @cindex evaluation of expressions
10816 @command{expr} evaluates an expression and writes the result on standard
10817 output. Each token of the expression must be a separate argument.
10819 Operands are either integers or strings. Integers consist of one or
10820 more decimal digits, with an optional leading @samp{-}.
10821 @command{expr} converts
10822 anything appearing in an operand position to an integer or a string
10823 depending on the operation being applied to it.
10825 Strings are not quoted for @command{expr} itself, though you may need to
10826 quote them to protect characters with special meaning to the shell,
10827 e.g., spaces. However, regardless of whether it is quoted, a string
10828 operand should not be a parenthesis or any of @command{expr}'s
10829 operators like @code{+}, so you cannot safely pass an arbitrary string
10830 @code{$str} to expr merely by quoting it to the shell. One way to
10831 work around this is to use the @sc{gnu} extension @code{+},
10832 (e.g., @code{+ "$str" = foo}); a more portable way is to use
10833 @code{@w{" $str"}} and to adjust the rest of the expression to take
10834 the leading space into account (e.g., @code{@w{" $str" = " foo"}}).
10836 You should not pass a negative integer or a string with leading
10837 @samp{-} as @command{expr}'s first argument, as it might be
10838 misinterpreted as an option; this can be avoided by parenthesization.
10839 Also, portable scripts should not use a string operand that happens to
10840 take the form of an integer; this can be worked around by inserting
10841 leading spaces as mentioned above.
10843 @cindex parentheses for grouping
10844 Operators may be given as infix symbols or prefix keywords. Parentheses
10845 may be used for grouping in the usual manner. You must quote
10846 parentheses and many operators to avoid the shell evaluating them,
10849 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
10850 options}. Options must precede operands.
10852 @cindex exit status of @command{expr}
10856 0 if the expression is neither null nor 0,
10857 1 if the expression is null or 0,
10858 2 if the expression is invalid,
10859 3 if an internal error occurred (e.g., arithmetic overflow).
10863 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
10864 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
10865 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
10866 * Examples of expr:: Examples.
10870 @node String expressions
10871 @subsection String expressions
10873 @cindex string expressions
10874 @cindex expressions, string
10876 @command{expr} supports pattern matching and other string operators. These
10877 have higher precedence than both the numeric and relational operators (in
10878 the next sections).
10882 @item @var{string} : @var{regex}
10883 @cindex pattern matching
10884 @cindex regular expression matching
10885 @cindex matching patterns
10886 Perform pattern matching. The arguments are converted to strings and the
10887 second is considered to be a (basic, a la GNU @code{grep}) regular
10888 expression, with a @code{^} implicitly prepended. The first argument is
10889 then matched against this regular expression.
10891 If the match succeeds and @var{regex} uses @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the
10892 @code{:} expression returns the part of @var{string} that matched the
10893 subexpression; otherwise, it returns the number of characters matched.
10895 If the match fails, the @code{:} operator returns the null string if
10896 @samp{\(} and @samp{\)} are used in @var{regex}, otherwise 0.
10898 @kindex \( @r{regexp operator}
10899 Only the first @samp{\( @dots{} \)} pair is relevant to the return
10900 value; additional pairs are meaningful only for grouping the regular
10901 expression operators.
10903 @kindex \+ @r{regexp operator}
10904 @kindex \? @r{regexp operator}
10905 @kindex \| @r{regexp operator}
10906 In the regular expression, @code{\+}, @code{\?}, and @code{\|} are
10907 operators which respectively match one or more, zero or one, or separate
10908 alternatives. SunOS and other @command{expr}'s treat these as regular
10909 characters. (@acronym{POSIX} allows either behavior.)
10910 @xref{Top, , Regular Expression Library, regex, Regex}, for details of
10911 regular expression syntax. Some examples are in @ref{Examples of expr}.
10913 @item match @var{string} @var{regex}
10915 An alternative way to do pattern matching. This is the same as
10916 @w{@samp{@var{string} : @var{regex}}}.
10918 @item substr @var{string} @var{position} @var{length}
10920 Returns the substring of @var{string} beginning at @var{position}
10921 with length at most @var{length}. If either @var{position} or
10922 @var{length} is negative, zero, or non-numeric, returns the null string.
10924 @item index @var{string} @var{charset}
10926 Returns the first position in @var{string} where the first character in
10927 @var{charset} was found. If no character in @var{charset} is found in
10928 @var{string}, return 0.
10930 @item length @var{string}
10932 Returns the length of @var{string}.
10934 @item + @var{token}
10936 Interpret @var{token} as a string, even if it is a keyword like @var{match}
10937 or an operator like @code{/}.
10938 This makes it possible to test @code{expr length + "$x"} or
10939 @code{expr + "$x" : '.*/\(.\)'} and have it do the right thing even if
10940 the value of @var{$x} happens to be (for example) @code{/} or @code{index}.
10941 This operator is a @acronym{GNU} extension. Portable shell scripts should use
10942 @code{@w{" $token"} : @w{' \(.*\)'}} instead of @code{+ "$token"}.
10946 To make @command{expr} interpret keywords as strings, you must use the
10947 @code{quote} operator.
10950 @node Numeric expressions
10951 @subsection Numeric expressions
10953 @cindex numeric expressions
10954 @cindex expressions, numeric
10956 @command{expr} supports the usual numeric operators, in order of increasing
10957 precedence. These numeric operators have lower precedence than the
10958 string operators described in the previous section, and higher precedence
10959 than the connectives (next section).
10967 @cindex subtraction
10968 Addition and subtraction. Both arguments are converted to integers;
10969 an error occurs if this cannot be done.
10975 @cindex multiplication
10978 Multiplication, division, remainder. Both arguments are converted to
10979 integers; an error occurs if this cannot be done.
10984 @node Relations for expr
10985 @subsection Relations for @command{expr}
10987 @cindex connectives, logical
10988 @cindex logical connectives
10989 @cindex relations, numeric or string
10991 @command{expr} supports the usual logical connectives and relations. These
10992 have lower precedence than the string and numeric operators
10993 (previous sections). Here is the list, lowest-precedence operator first.
10999 @cindex logical or operator
11000 @cindex or operator
11001 Returns its first argument if that is neither null nor zero, otherwise
11002 its second argument if it is neither null nor zero, otherwise 0. It
11003 does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is neither
11008 @cindex logical and operator
11009 @cindex and operator
11010 Return its first argument if neither argument is null or zero, otherwise
11011 0. It does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is
11014 @item < <= = == != >= >
11021 @cindex comparison operators
11023 Compare the arguments and return 1 if the relation is true, 0 otherwise.
11024 @code{==} is a synonym for @code{=}. @command{expr} first tries to convert
11025 both arguments to integers and do a numeric comparison; if either
11026 conversion fails, it does a lexicographic comparison using the character
11027 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
11032 @node Examples of expr
11033 @subsection Examples of using @command{expr}
11035 @cindex examples of @command{expr}
11036 Here are a few examples, including quoting for shell metacharacters.
11038 To add 1 to the shell variable @code{foo}, in Bourne-compatible shells:
11041 foo=`expr $foo + 1`
11044 To print the non-directory part of the file name stored in
11045 @code{$fname}, which need not contain a @code{/}:
11048 expr $fname : '.*/\(.*\)' '|' $fname
11051 An example showing that @code{\+} is an operator:
11059 expr abc : 'a\(.\)c'
11061 expr index abcdef cz
11064 @error{} expr: syntax error
11065 expr index quote index a
11071 @chapter Redirection
11073 @cindex redirection
11074 @cindex commands for redirection
11076 Unix shells commonly provide several forms of @dfn{redirection}---ways
11077 to change the input source or output destination of a command. But one
11078 useful redirection is performed by a separate command, not by the shell;
11079 it's described here.
11082 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes.
11086 @node tee invocation
11087 @section @command{tee}: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
11090 @cindex pipe fitting
11091 @cindex destinations, multiple output
11092 @cindex read from stdin and write to stdout and files
11094 The @command{tee} command copies standard input to standard output and also
11095 to any files given as arguments. This is useful when you want not only
11096 to send some data down a pipe, but also to save a copy. Synopsis:
11099 tee [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11102 If a file being written to does not already exist, it is created. If a
11103 file being written to already exists, the data it previously contained
11104 is overwritten unless the @option{-a} option is used.
11106 A @var{file} of @samp{-} causes @command{tee} to send another copy of
11107 input to standard output, but this is typically not that useful as the
11108 copies are interleaved.
11110 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11117 Append standard input to the given files rather than overwriting
11121 @itemx --ignore-interrupts
11123 @opindex --ignore-interrupts
11124 Ignore interrupt signals.
11128 The @command{tee} command is useful when you happen to be transferring a large
11129 amount of data and also want to summarize that data without reading
11130 it a second time. For example, when you are downloading a DVD image,
11131 you often want to verify its signature or checksum right away.
11132 The inefficient way to do it is simply:
11135 wget http://example.com/some.iso && sha1sum some.iso
11138 One problem with the above is that it makes you wait for the
11139 download to complete before starting the time-consuming SHA1 computation.
11140 Perhaps even more importantly, the above requires reading
11141 the DVD image a second time (the first was from the network).
11143 The efficient way to do it is to interleave the download
11144 and SHA1 computation. Then, you'll get the checksum for
11145 free, because the entire process parallelizes so well:
11148 # slightly contrived, to demonstrate process substitution
11149 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
11150 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) > dvd.iso
11153 That makes @command{tee} write not just to the expected output file,
11154 but also to a pipe running @command{sha1sum} and saving the final
11155 checksum in a file named @file{dvd.sha1}.
11157 Note, however, that this example relies on a feature of modern shells
11158 called @dfn{process substitution}
11159 (the @samp{>(command)} syntax, above;
11160 @xref{Process Substitution,,Process Substitution, bashref,
11161 The Bash Reference Manual}.),
11162 so it works with @command{zsh}, @command{bash}, and @command{ksh},
11163 but not with @command{/bin/sh}. So if you write code like this
11164 in a shell script, be sure to start the script with @samp{#!/bin/bash}.
11166 Since the above example writes to one file and one process,
11167 a more conventional and portable use of @command{tee} is even better:
11170 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
11171 | tee dvd.iso | sha1sum > dvd.sha1
11174 You can extend this example to make @command{tee} write to two processes,
11175 computing MD5 and SHA1 checksums in parallel. In this case,
11176 process substitution is required:
11179 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
11180 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) \
11181 >(md5sum > dvd.md5) \
11185 This technique is also useful when you want to make a @emph{compressed}
11186 copy of the contents of a pipe.
11187 Consider a tool to graphically summarize disk usage data from @samp{du -ak}.
11188 For a large hierarchy, @samp{du -ak} can run for a long time,
11189 and can easily produce terabytes of data, so you won't want to
11190 rerun the command unnecessarily. Nor will you want to save
11191 the uncompressed output.
11193 Doing it the inefficient way, you can't even start the GUI
11194 until after you've compressed all of the @command{du} output:
11197 du -ak | gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz
11198 gzip -d /tmp/du.gz | xdiskusage -a
11201 With @command{tee} and process substitution, you start the GUI
11202 right away and eliminate the decompression completely:
11205 du -ak | tee >(gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz) | xdiskusage -a
11208 Finally, if you regularly create more than one type of
11209 compressed tarball at once, for example when @code{make dist} creates
11210 both @command{gzip}-compressed and @command{bzip2}-compressed tarballs,
11211 there may be a better way.
11212 Typical @command{automake}-generated @file{Makefile} rules create
11213 the two compressed tar archives with commands in sequence, like this
11214 (slightly simplified):
11217 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
11218 tar chof - "$tardir" | gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz
11219 tar chof - "$tardir" | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
11222 However, if the hierarchy you are archiving and compressing is larger
11223 than a couple megabytes, and especially if you are using a multi-processor
11224 system with plenty of memory, then you can do much better by reading the
11225 directory contents only once and running the compression programs in parallel:
11228 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
11229 tar chof - "$tardir" \
11230 | tee >(gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz) \
11231 | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
11237 @node File name manipulation
11238 @chapter File name manipulation
11240 @cindex file name manipulation
11241 @cindex manipulation of file names
11242 @cindex commands for file name manipulation
11244 This section describes commands that manipulate file names.
11247 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name.
11248 * dirname invocation:: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name.
11249 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name portability.
11253 @node basename invocation
11254 @section @command{basename}: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
11257 @cindex strip directory and suffix from file names
11258 @cindex directory, stripping from file names
11259 @cindex suffix, stripping from file names
11260 @cindex file names, stripping directory and suffix
11261 @cindex leading directory components, stripping
11263 @command{basename} removes any leading directory components from
11264 @var{name}. Synopsis:
11267 basename @var{name} [@var{suffix}]
11270 If @var{suffix} is specified and is identical to the end of @var{name},
11271 it is removed from @var{name} as well. Note that since trailing slashes
11272 are removed prior to suffix matching, @var{suffix} will do nothing if it
11273 contains slashes. @command{basename} prints the result on standard
11276 @c This test is used both here and in the section on dirname.
11277 @macro basenameAndDirname
11278 Together, @command{basename} and @command{dirname} are designed such
11279 that if @samp{ls "$name"} succeeds, then the command sequence @samp{cd
11280 "$(dirname "$name")"; ls "$(basename "$name")"} will, too. This works
11281 for everything except file names containing a trailing newline.
11283 @basenameAndDirname
11285 @acronym{POSIX} allows the implementation to define the results if
11286 @var{name} is empty or @samp{//}. In the former case, @acronym{GNU}
11287 @command{basename} returns the empty string. In the latter case, the
11288 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
11289 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
11291 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
11292 options}. Options must precede operands.
11300 basename /usr/bin/sort
11303 basename include/stdio.h .h
11307 @node dirname invocation
11308 @section @command{dirname}: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name
11311 @cindex directory components, printing
11312 @cindex stripping non-directory suffix
11313 @cindex non-directory suffix, stripping
11315 @command{dirname} prints all but the final slash-delimited component of
11316 a string (presumably a file name). Synopsis:
11322 If @var{name} is a single component, @command{dirname} prints @samp{.}
11323 (meaning the current directory).
11325 @basenameAndDirname
11327 @acronym{POSIX} allows the implementation to define the results if
11328 @var{name} is @samp{//}. With @acronym{GNU} @command{dirname}, the
11329 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
11330 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
11332 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
11340 # Output "/usr/bin".
11341 dirname /usr/bin/sort
11348 @node pathchk invocation
11349 @section @command{pathchk}: Check file name portability
11352 @cindex file names, checking validity and portability
11353 @cindex valid file names, checking for
11354 @cindex portable file names, checking for
11356 @command{pathchk} checks portability of file names. Synopsis:
11359 pathchk [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
11362 For each @var{name}, @command{pathchk} prints a message if any of
11363 these conditions is true:
11367 One of the existing directories in @var{name} does not have search
11368 (execute) permission,
11370 The length of @var{name} is larger than the maximum supported by the
11373 The length of one component of @var{name} is longer than
11374 its file system's maximum.
11377 A nonexistent @var{name} is not an error, so long a file with that
11378 name could be created under the above conditions.
11380 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11381 Options must precede operands.
11387 Instead of performing checks based on the underlying file system,
11388 print a message if any of these conditions is true:
11392 A file name is empty.
11395 The length of a file name or one of its components exceeds the
11396 @acronym{POSIX} minimum limits for portability.
11399 A file name contains a character outside the portable file name
11400 character set, namely, the ASCII letters and digits, @samp{-},
11401 @samp{.}, @samp{/}, and @samp{_}.
11406 Print a message if a file name is empty, or if it contains a component
11407 that begins with @samp{-}.
11409 @item --portability
11410 @opindex --portability
11411 Print a message if a file name is not portable to all @acronym{POSIX}
11412 hosts. This option is equivalent to @samp{-p -P}.
11416 @cindex exit status of @command{pathchk}
11420 0 if all specified file names passed all checks,
11425 @node Working context
11426 @chapter Working context
11428 @cindex working context
11429 @cindex commands for printing the working context
11431 This section describes commands that display or alter the context in
11432 which you are working: the current directory, the terminal settings, and
11433 so forth. See also the user-related commands in the next section.
11436 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory.
11437 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics.
11438 * printenv invocation:: Print environment variables.
11439 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input.
11443 @node pwd invocation
11444 @section @command{pwd}: Print working directory
11447 @cindex print name of current directory
11448 @cindex current working directory, printing
11449 @cindex working directory, printing
11451 @cindex symbolic links and @command{pwd}
11452 @command{pwd} prints the fully resolved name of the current directory.
11453 That is, all components of the printed name will be actual directory
11454 names---none will be symbolic links.
11456 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
11457 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
11458 Because most shells have a built-in @command{pwd} command, using an
11459 unadorned @command{pwd} in a script or interactively may get you
11460 different functionality than that described here.
11462 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
11463 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
11468 @node stty invocation
11469 @section @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
11472 @cindex change or print terminal settings
11473 @cindex terminal settings
11474 @cindex line settings of terminal
11476 @command{stty} prints or changes terminal characteristics, such as baud rate.
11480 stty [@var{option}] [@var{setting}]@dots{}
11481 stty [@var{option}]
11484 If given no line settings, @command{stty} prints the baud rate, line
11485 discipline number (on systems that support it), and line settings
11486 that have been changed from the values set by @samp{stty sane}.
11487 By default, mode reading and setting are performed on the tty line
11488 connected to standard input, although this can be modified by the
11489 @option{--file} option.
11491 @command{stty} accepts many non-option arguments that change aspects of
11492 the terminal line operation, as described below.
11494 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11501 Print all current settings in human-readable form. This option may not
11502 be used in combination with any line settings.
11504 @item -F @var{device}
11505 @itemx --file=@var{device}
11508 Set the line opened by the file name specified in @var{device} instead of
11509 the tty line connected to standard input. This option is necessary
11510 because opening a @acronym{POSIX} tty requires use of the @code{O_NONDELAY} flag to
11511 prevent a @acronym{POSIX} tty from blocking until the carrier detect line is high if
11512 the @code{clocal} flag is not set. Hence, it is not always possible
11513 to allow the shell to open the device in the traditional manner.
11519 @cindex machine-readable @command{stty} output
11520 Print all current settings in a form that can be used as an argument to
11521 another @command{stty} command to restore the current settings. This option
11522 may not be used in combination with any line settings.
11526 Many settings can be turned off by preceding them with a @samp{-}.
11527 Such arguments are marked below with ``May be negated'' in their
11528 description. The descriptions themselves refer to the positive
11529 case, that is, when @emph{not} negated (unless stated otherwise,
11532 Some settings are not available on all @acronym{POSIX} systems, since they use
11533 extensions. Such arguments are marked below with ``Non-@acronym{POSIX}'' in their
11534 description. On non-@acronym{POSIX} systems, those or other settings also may not
11535 be available, but it's not feasible to document all the variations: just
11541 * Control:: Control settings
11542 * Input:: Input settings
11543 * Output:: Output settings
11544 * Local:: Local settings
11545 * Combination:: Combination settings
11546 * Characters:: Special characters
11547 * Special:: Special settings
11552 @subsection Control settings
11554 @cindex control settings
11560 @cindex two-way parity
11561 Generate parity bit in output and expect parity bit in input.
11567 @cindex even parity
11568 Set odd parity (even if negated). May be negated.
11575 @cindex character size
11576 @cindex eight-bit characters
11577 Set character size to 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits.
11582 Send a hangup signal when the last process closes the tty. May be
11588 Use two stop bits per character (one if negated). May be negated.
11592 Allow input to be received. May be negated.
11596 @cindex modem control
11597 Disable modem control signals. May be negated.
11601 @cindex hardware flow control
11602 @cindex flow control, hardware
11603 @cindex RTS/CTS flow control
11604 Enable RTS/CTS flow control. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11609 @subsection Input settings
11611 @cindex input settings
11616 @cindex breaks, ignoring
11617 Ignore break characters. May be negated.
11621 @cindex breaks, cause interrupts
11622 Make breaks cause an interrupt signal. May be negated.
11626 @cindex parity, ignoring
11627 Ignore characters with parity errors. May be negated.
11631 @cindex parity errors, marking
11632 Mark parity errors (with a 255-0-character sequence). May be negated.
11636 Enable input parity checking. May be negated.
11640 @cindex eight-bit input
11641 Clear high (8th) bit of input characters. May be negated.
11645 @cindex newline, translating to return
11646 Translate newline to carriage return. May be negated.
11650 @cindex return, ignoring
11651 Ignore carriage return. May be negated.
11655 @cindex return, translating to newline
11656 Translate carriage return to newline. May be negated.
11660 @cindex input encoding, UTF-8
11661 Assume input characters are UTF-8 encoded. May be negated.
11665 @kindex C-s/C-q flow control
11666 @cindex XON/XOFF flow control
11667 Enable XON/XOFF flow control (that is, @kbd{CTRL-S}/@kbd{CTRL-Q}). May
11674 @cindex software flow control
11675 @cindex flow control, software
11676 Enable sending of @code{stop} character when the system input buffer
11677 is almost full, and @code{start} character when it becomes almost
11678 empty again. May be negated.
11682 @cindex uppercase, translating to lowercase
11683 Translate uppercase characters to lowercase. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11688 Allow any character to restart output (only the start character
11689 if negated). Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11693 @cindex beeping at input buffer full
11694 Enable beeping and not flushing input buffer if a character arrives
11695 when the input buffer is full. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11700 @subsection Output settings
11702 @cindex output settings
11703 These arguments specify output-related operations.
11708 Postprocess output. May be negated.
11712 @cindex lowercase, translating to output
11713 Translate lowercase characters to uppercase. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11718 @cindex return, translating to newline
11719 Translate carriage return to newline. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11723 @cindex newline, translating to crlf
11724 Translate newline to carriage return-newline. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11729 Do not print carriage returns in the first column. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11734 Newline performs a carriage return. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11738 @cindex pad instead of timing for delaying
11739 Use fill (padding) characters instead of timing for delays. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11744 @cindex pad character
11745 Use delete characters for fill instead of null characters. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11751 Newline delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11758 Carriage return delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11764 @opindex tab@var{n}
11765 Horizontal tab delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11770 Backspace delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11775 Vertical tab delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11780 Form feed delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11785 @subsection Local settings
11787 @cindex local settings
11792 Enable @code{interrupt}, @code{quit}, and @code{suspend} special
11793 characters. May be negated.
11797 Enable @code{erase}, @code{kill}, @code{werase}, and @code{rprnt}
11798 special characters. May be negated.
11802 Enable non-@acronym{POSIX} special characters. May be negated.
11806 Echo input characters. May be negated.
11812 Echo @code{erase} characters as backspace-space-backspace. May be
11817 @cindex newline echoing after @code{kill}
11818 Echo a newline after a @code{kill} character. May be negated.
11822 @cindex newline, echoing
11823 Echo newline even if not echoing other characters. May be negated.
11827 @cindex flushing, disabling
11828 Disable flushing after @code{interrupt} and @code{quit} special
11829 characters. May be negated.
11833 @cindex case translation
11834 Enable input and output of uppercase characters by preceding their
11835 lowercase equivalents with @samp{\}, when @code{icanon} is set.
11836 Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11840 @cindex background jobs, stopping at terminal write
11841 Stop background jobs that try to write to the terminal. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11848 Echo erased characters backward, between @samp{\} and @samp{/}.
11849 Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11855 @cindex control characters, using @samp{^@var{c}}
11856 @cindex hat notation for control characters
11857 Echo control characters in hat notation (@samp{^@var{c}}) instead
11858 of literally. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11864 Echo the @code{kill} special character by erasing each character on
11865 the line as indicated by the @code{echoprt} and @code{echoe} settings,
11866 instead of by the @code{echoctl} and @code{echok} settings. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11872 @subsection Combination settings
11874 @cindex combination settings
11875 Combination settings:
11882 Same as @code{parenb -parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
11883 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
11887 Same as @code{parenb parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
11888 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
11892 Same as @code{-icrnl -onlcr}. May be negated. If negated, same as
11893 @code{icrnl -inlcr -igncr onlcr -ocrnl -onlret}.
11897 Reset the @code{erase} and @code{kill} special characters to their default
11904 @c This is too long to write inline.
11906 cread -ignbrk brkint -inlcr -igncr icrnl -ixoff
11907 -iuclc -ixany imaxbel opost -olcuc -ocrnl onlcr
11908 -onocr -onlret -ofill -ofdel nl0 cr0 tab0 bs0 vt0
11909 ff0 isig icanon iexten echo echoe echok -echonl
11910 -noflsh -xcase -tostop -echoprt echoctl echoke
11914 and also sets all special characters to their default values.
11918 Same as @code{brkint ignpar istrip icrnl ixon opost isig icanon}, plus
11919 sets the @code{eof} and @code{eol} characters to their default values
11920 if they are the same as the @code{min} and @code{time} characters.
11921 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{raw}.
11928 -ignbrk -brkint -ignpar -parmrk -inpck -istrip
11929 -inlcr -igncr -icrnl -ixon -ixoff -iuclc -ixany
11930 -imaxbel -opost -isig -icanon -xcase min 1 time 0
11934 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{cooked}.
11938 Same as @option{-icanon}. May be negated. If negated, same as
11943 @cindex eight-bit characters
11944 Same as @code{-parenb -istrip cs8}. May be negated. If negated,
11945 same as @code{parenb istrip cs7}.
11949 Same as @option{-parenb -istrip -opost cs8}. May be negated.
11950 If negated, same as @code{parenb istrip opost cs7}.
11954 Same as @option{-ixany}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11958 Same as @code{tab0}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated. If negated, same
11965 Same as @code{xcase iuclc olcuc}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11969 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke}.
11973 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke -ixany intr ^C erase ^? kill C-u}.
11978 @subsection Special characters
11980 @cindex special characters
11981 @cindex characters, special
11983 The special characters' default values vary from system to system.
11984 They are set with the syntax @samp{name value}, where the names are
11985 listed below and the value can be given either literally, in hat
11986 notation (@samp{^@var{c}}), or as an integer which may start with
11987 @samp{0x} to indicate hexadecimal, @samp{0} to indicate octal, or
11988 any other digit to indicate decimal.
11990 @cindex disabling special characters
11991 @kindex u@r{, and disabling special characters}
11992 For GNU stty, giving a value of @code{^-} or @code{undef} disables that
11993 special character. (This is incompatible with Ultrix @command{stty},
11994 which uses a value of @samp{u} to disable a special character. GNU
11995 @command{stty} treats a value @samp{u} like any other, namely to set that
11996 special character to @key{U}.)
12002 Send an interrupt signal.
12006 Send a quit signal.
12010 Erase the last character typed.
12014 Erase the current line.
12018 Send an end of file (terminate the input).
12026 Alternate character to end the line. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12030 Switch to a different shell layer. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12034 Restart the output after stopping it.
12042 Send a terminal stop signal.
12046 Send a terminal stop signal after flushing the input. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12050 Redraw the current line. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12054 Erase the last word typed. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12058 Enter the next character typed literally, even if it is a special
12059 character. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12064 @subsection Special settings
12066 @cindex special settings
12071 Set the minimum number of characters that will satisfy a read until
12072 the time value has expired, when @option{-icanon} is set.
12076 Set the number of tenths of a second before reads time out if the minimum
12077 number of characters have not been read, when @option{-icanon} is set.
12079 @item ispeed @var{n}
12081 Set the input speed to @var{n}.
12083 @item ospeed @var{n}
12085 Set the output speed to @var{n}.
12089 Tell the tty kernel driver that the terminal has @var{n} rows. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12092 @itemx columns @var{n}
12095 Tell the kernel that the terminal has @var{n} columns. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12101 Print the number of rows and columns that the kernel thinks the
12102 terminal has. (Systems that don't support rows and columns in the kernel
12103 typically use the environment variables @env{LINES} and @env{COLUMNS}
12104 instead; however, GNU @command{stty} does not know anything about them.)
12105 Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12109 Use line discipline @var{n}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12113 Print the terminal speed.
12116 @cindex baud rate, setting
12117 @c FIXME: Is this still true that the baud rate can't be set
12118 @c higher than 38400?
12119 Set the input and output speeds to @var{n}. @var{n} can be one
12120 of: 0 50 75 110 134 134.5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 4800 9600
12121 19200 38400 @code{exta} @code{extb}. @code{exta} is the same as
12122 19200; @code{extb} is the same as 38400. 0 hangs up the line if
12123 @option{-clocal} is set.
12127 @node printenv invocation
12128 @section @command{printenv}: Print all or some environment variables
12131 @cindex printing all or some environment variables
12132 @cindex environment variables, printing
12134 @command{printenv} prints environment variable values. Synopsis:
12137 printenv [@var{option}] [@var{variable}]@dots{}
12140 If no @var{variable}s are specified, @command{printenv} prints the value of
12141 every environment variable. Otherwise, it prints the value of each
12142 @var{variable} that is set, and nothing for those that are not set.
12144 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
12145 @xref{Common options}.
12147 @cindex exit status of @command{printenv}
12151 0 if all variables specified were found
12152 1 if at least one specified variable was not found
12153 2 if a write error occurred
12157 @node tty invocation
12158 @section @command{tty}: Print file name of terminal on standard input
12161 @cindex print terminal file name
12162 @cindex terminal file name, printing
12164 @command{tty} prints the file name of the terminal connected to its standard
12165 input. It prints @samp{not a tty} if standard input is not a terminal.
12169 tty [@var{option}]@dots{}
12172 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12182 Print nothing; only return an exit status.
12186 @cindex exit status of @command{tty}
12190 0 if standard input is a terminal
12191 1 if standard input is not a terminal
12192 2 if given incorrect arguments
12193 3 if a write error occurs
12197 @node User information
12198 @chapter User information
12200 @cindex user information, commands for
12201 @cindex commands for printing user information
12203 This section describes commands that print user-related information:
12204 logins, groups, and so forth.
12207 * id invocation:: Print user identity.
12208 * logname invocation:: Print current login name.
12209 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID.
12210 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in.
12211 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in.
12212 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in.
12216 @node id invocation
12217 @section @command{id}: Print user identity
12220 @cindex real user and group IDs, printing
12221 @cindex effective user and group IDs, printing
12222 @cindex printing real and effective user and group IDs
12224 @command{id} prints information about the given user, or the process
12225 running it if no user is specified. Synopsis:
12228 id [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{username}]
12231 By default, it prints the real user ID, real group ID, effective user ID
12232 if different from the real user ID, effective group ID if different from
12233 the real group ID, and supplemental group IDs.
12235 Each of these numeric values is preceded by an identifying string and
12236 followed by the corresponding user or group name in parentheses.
12238 The options cause @command{id} to print only part of the above information.
12239 Also see @ref{Common options}.
12246 Print only the group ID.
12252 Print only the group ID and the supplementary groups.
12258 Print the user or group name instead of the ID number. Requires
12259 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
12265 Print the real, instead of effective, user or group ID. Requires
12266 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
12272 Print only the user ID.
12278 @macro primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{cmd,arg}
12279 Primary and supplementary groups for a process are normally inherited
12280 from its parent and are usually unchanged since login. This means
12281 that if you change the group database after logging in, @command{\cmd\}
12282 will not reflect your changes within your existing login session.
12283 Running @command{\cmd\} with a \arg\ causes the user and group
12284 database to be consulted afresh, and so will give a different result.
12286 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{id,user argument}
12288 @node logname invocation
12289 @section @command{logname}: Print current login name
12292 @cindex printing user's login name
12293 @cindex login name, printing
12294 @cindex user name, printing
12297 @command{logname} prints the calling user's name, as found in a
12298 system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12299 @file{/etc/utmp}), and exits with a status of 0. If there is no entry
12300 for the calling process, @command{logname} prints
12301 an error message and exits with a status of 1.
12303 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12309 @node whoami invocation
12310 @section @command{whoami}: Print effective user ID
12313 @cindex effective user ID, printing
12314 @cindex printing the effective user ID
12316 @command{whoami} prints the user name associated with the current
12317 effective user ID. It is equivalent to the command @samp{id -un}.
12319 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12325 @node groups invocation
12326 @section @command{groups}: Print group names a user is in
12329 @cindex printing groups a user is in
12330 @cindex supplementary groups, printing
12332 @command{groups} prints the names of the primary and any supplementary
12333 groups for each given @var{username}, or the current process if no names
12334 are given. If more than one name is given, the name of each user is
12336 the list of that user's groups and the user name is separated from the
12337 group list by a colon. Synopsis:
12340 groups [@var{username}]@dots{}
12343 The group lists are equivalent to the output of the command @samp{id -Gn}.
12345 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{groups,list of users}
12347 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12353 @node users invocation
12354 @section @command{users}: Print login names of users currently logged in
12357 @cindex printing current usernames
12358 @cindex usernames, printing current
12360 @cindex login sessions, printing users with
12361 @command{users} prints on a single line a blank-separated list of user
12362 names of users currently logged in to the current host. Each user name
12363 corresponds to a login session, so if a user has more than one login
12364 session, that user's name will appear the same number of times in the
12373 With no @var{file} argument, @command{users} extracts its information from
12374 a system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12375 @file{/etc/utmp}). If a file argument is given, @command{users} uses
12376 that file instead. A common choice is @file{/var/log/wtmp}.
12378 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12384 @node who invocation
12385 @section @command{who}: Print who is currently logged in
12388 @cindex printing current user information
12389 @cindex information, about current users
12391 @command{who} prints information about users who are currently logged on.
12395 @command{who} [@var{option}] [@var{file}] [am i]
12398 @cindex terminal lines, currently used
12400 @cindex remote hostname
12401 If given no non-option arguments, @command{who} prints the following
12402 information for each user currently logged on: login name, terminal
12403 line, login time, and remote hostname or X display.
12407 If given one non-option argument, @command{who} uses that instead of
12408 a default system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12409 @file{/etc/utmp}) as the name of the file containing the record of
12410 users logged on. @file{/var/log/wtmp} is commonly given as an argument
12411 to @command{who} to look at who has previously logged on.
12415 If given two non-option arguments, @command{who} prints only the entry
12416 for the user running it (determined from its standard input), preceded
12417 by the hostname. Traditionally, the two arguments given are @samp{am
12418 i}, as in @samp{who am i}.
12421 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
12422 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
12423 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
12424 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
12426 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12434 Same as @samp{-b -d --login -p -r -t -T -u}.
12440 Print the date and time of last system boot.
12446 Print information corresponding to dead processes.
12452 Print column headings.
12456 Same as @samp{who am i}.
12462 Print only the login names and the number of users logged on.
12463 Overrides all other options.
12467 Ignored; for compatibility with other versions of @command{who}.
12472 After the login time, print the number of hours and minutes that the
12473 user has been idle. @samp{.} means the user was active in the last minute.
12474 @samp{old} means the user has been idle for more than 24 hours.
12480 List only the entries that correspond to processes via which the
12481 system is waiting for a user to login. The user name is always @samp{LOGIN}.
12485 Attempt to canonicalize hostnames found in utmp through a DNS lookup. This
12486 is not the default because it can cause significant delays on systems with
12487 automatic dial-up internet access.
12493 Print a line of column headings.
12504 @opindex --writable
12505 @cindex message status
12506 @pindex write@r{, allowed}
12507 After each login name print a character indicating the user's message status:
12510 @samp{+} allowing @code{write} messages
12511 @samp{-} disallowing @code{write} messages
12512 @samp{?} cannot find terminal device
12520 @node System context
12521 @chapter System context
12523 @cindex system context
12524 @cindex context, system
12525 @cindex commands for system context
12527 This section describes commands that print or change system-wide
12531 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name.
12532 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time.
12533 * uname invocation:: Print system information.
12534 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name.
12535 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
12539 @node date invocation
12540 @section @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
12543 @cindex time, printing or setting
12544 @cindex printing the current time
12549 date [@var{option}]@dots{} [+@var{format}]
12550 date [-u|--utc|--universal] @c this avoids a newline in the output
12551 [ MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss] ]
12555 Invoking @command{date} with no @var{format} argument is equivalent to invoking
12556 it with a default format that depends on the @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
12557 In the default C locale, this format is @samp{'+%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'},
12558 so the output looks like @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 13:47:51 PST 2005}.
12561 Normally, @command{date} uses the time zone rules indicated by the
12562 @env{TZ} environment variable, or the system default rules if @env{TZ}
12563 is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with
12564 @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
12566 @findex strftime @r{and @command{date}}
12567 @cindex time formats
12568 @cindex formatting times
12569 If given an argument that starts with a @samp{+}, @command{date} prints the
12570 current date and time (or the date and time specified by the
12571 @option{--date} option, see below) in the format defined by that argument,
12572 which is similar to that of the @code{strftime} function. Except for
12573 conversion specifiers, which start with @samp{%}, characters in the
12574 format string are printed unchanged. The conversion specifiers are
12580 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
12581 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
12582 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
12583 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
12584 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
12585 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
12587 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
12589 * Examples of date:: Examples.
12592 @node Time conversion specifiers
12593 @subsection Time conversion specifiers
12595 @cindex time conversion specifiers
12596 @cindex conversion specifiers, time
12598 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to times.
12602 hour (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{23})
12604 hour (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
12606 hour (@samp{ 0}@dots{}@samp{23}).
12607 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12609 hour (@samp{ 1}@dots{}@samp{12}).
12610 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12612 minute (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{59})
12614 nanoseconds (@samp{000000000}@dots{}@samp{999999999}).
12615 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12617 locale's equivalent of either @samp{AM} or @samp{PM};
12618 blank in many locales.
12619 Noon is treated as @samp{PM} and midnight as @samp{AM}.
12621 like @samp{%p}, except lower case.
12622 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12624 locale's 12-hour clock time (e.g., @samp{11:11:04 PM})
12626 24-hour hour and minute. Same as @samp{%H:%M}.
12627 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12629 @cindex epoch, seconds since
12630 @cindex seconds since the epoch
12631 @cindex beginning of time
12632 seconds since the epoch, i.e., since 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC.
12633 Leap seconds are not counted unless leap second support is available.
12634 @xref{%s-examples}, for examples.
12635 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12637 second (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{60}).
12638 This may be @samp{60} if leap seconds are supported.
12640 24-hour hour, minute, and second. Same as @samp{%H:%M:%S}.
12642 locale's time representation (e.g., @samp{23:13:48})
12644 @w{@acronym{RFC} 2822/@acronym{ISO} 8601} style numeric time zone
12645 (e.g., @samp{-0600} or @samp{+0530}), or nothing if no
12646 time zone is determinable. This value reflects the numeric time zone
12647 appropriate for the current time, using the time zone rules specified
12648 by the @env{TZ} environment variable.
12649 The time (and optionally, the time zone rules) can be overridden
12650 by the @option{--date} option.
12651 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12653 @w{@acronym{RFC} 3339/@acronym{ISO} 8601} style numeric time zone with
12654 @samp{:} (e.g., @samp{-06:00} or @samp{+05:30}), or nothing if no time
12655 zone is determinable.
12656 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12658 Numeric time zone to the nearest second with @samp{:} (e.g.,
12659 @samp{-06:00:00} or @samp{+05:30:00}), or nothing if no time zone is
12661 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12663 Numeric time zone with @samp{:} using the minimum necessary precision
12664 (e.g., @samp{-06}, @samp{+05:30}, or @samp{-04:56:02}), or nothing if
12665 no time zone is determinable.
12666 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12668 alphabetic time zone abbreviation (e.g., @samp{EDT}), or nothing if no
12669 time zone is determinable. See @samp{%z} for how it is determined.
12673 @node Date conversion specifiers
12674 @subsection Date conversion specifiers
12676 @cindex date conversion specifiers
12677 @cindex conversion specifiers, date
12679 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to dates.
12683 locale's abbreviated weekday name (e.g., @samp{Sun})
12685 locale's full weekday name, variable length (e.g., @samp{Sunday})
12687 locale's abbreviated month name (e.g., @samp{Jan})
12689 locale's full month name, variable length (e.g., @samp{January})
12691 locale's date and time (e.g., @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 23:05:25 2005})
12693 century. This is like @samp{%Y}, except the last two digits are omitted.
12694 For example, it is @samp{20} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{2000},
12695 and is @samp{-0} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{-001}.
12696 It is normally at least two characters, but it may be more.
12698 day of month (e.g., @samp{01})
12700 date; same as @samp{%m/%d/%y}
12702 day of month, space padded; same as @samp{%_d}
12704 full date in @acronym{ISO} 8601 format; same as @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
12705 This is a good choice for a date format, as it is standard and
12706 is easy to sort in the usual case where years are in the range
12708 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12710 year corresponding to the @acronym{ISO} week number, but without the century
12711 (range @samp{00} through @samp{99}). This has the same format and value
12712 as @samp{%y}, except that if the @acronym{ISO} week number (see
12714 to the previous or next year, that year is used instead.
12715 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12717 year corresponding to the @acronym{ISO} week number. This has the
12718 same format and value as @samp{%Y}, except that if the @acronym{ISO}
12720 @samp{%V}) belongs to the previous or next year, that year is used
12722 It is normally useful only if @samp{%V} is also used;
12723 for example, the format @samp{%G-%m-%d} is probably a mistake,
12724 since it combines the ISO week number year with the conventional month and day.
12725 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12729 day of year (@samp{001}@dots{}@samp{366})
12731 month (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
12733 day of week (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{7}) with @samp{1} corresponding to Monday
12735 week number of year, with Sunday as the first day of the week
12736 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
12737 Days in a new year preceding the first Sunday are in week zero.
12739 @acronym{ISO} week number, that is, the
12740 week number of year, with Monday as the first day of the week
12741 (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{53}).
12742 If the week containing January 1 has four or more days in
12743 the new year, then it is considered week 1; otherwise, it is week 53 of
12744 the previous year, and the next week is week 1. (See the @acronym{ISO} 8601
12747 day of week (@samp{0}@dots{}@samp{6}) with 0 corresponding to Sunday
12749 week number of year, with Monday as first day of week
12750 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
12751 Days in a new year preceding the first Monday are in week zero.
12753 locale's date representation (e.g., @samp{12/31/99})
12755 last two digits of year (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{99})
12757 year. This is normally at least four characters, but it may be more.
12758 Year @samp{0000} precedes year @samp{0001}, and year @samp{-001}
12759 precedes year @samp{0000}.
12763 @node Literal conversion specifiers
12764 @subsection Literal conversion specifiers
12766 @cindex literal conversion specifiers
12767 @cindex conversion specifiers, literal
12769 @command{date} conversion specifiers that produce literal strings.
12781 @node Padding and other flags
12782 @subsection Padding and other flags
12784 @cindex numeric field padding
12785 @cindex padding of numeric fields
12786 @cindex fields, padding numeric
12788 Unless otherwise specified, @command{date} normally pads numeric fields
12789 with zeros, so that, for
12790 example, numeric months are always output as two digits.
12791 Seconds since the epoch are not padded, though,
12792 since there is no natural width for them.
12794 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, @command{date} recognizes any of the
12795 following optional flags after the @samp{%}:
12799 (hyphen) Do not pad the field; useful if the output is intended for
12802 (underscore) Pad with spaces; useful if you need a fixed
12803 number of characters in the output, but zeros are too distracting.
12805 (zero) Pad with zeros even if the conversion specifier
12806 would normally pad with spaces.
12808 Use upper case characters if possible.
12810 Use opposite case characters if possible.
12811 A field that is normally upper case becomes lower case, and vice versa.
12815 Here are some examples of padding:
12818 date +%d/%m -d "Feb 1"
12820 date +%-d/%-m -d "Feb 1"
12822 date +%_d/%_m -d "Feb 1"
12826 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, you can specify the field width
12827 (after any flag, if present) as a decimal number. If the natural size of the
12828 output is of the field has less than the specified number of characters,
12829 the result is written right adjusted and padded to the given
12830 size. For example, @samp{%9B} prints the right adjusted month name in
12831 a field of width 9.
12833 An optional modifier can follow the optional flag and width
12834 specification. The modifiers are:
12838 Use the locale's alternate representation for date and time. This
12839 modifier applies to the @samp{%c}, @samp{%C}, @samp{%x}, @samp{%X},
12840 @samp{%y} and @samp{%Y} conversion specifiers. In a Japanese locale, for
12841 example, @samp{%Ex} might yield a date format based on the Japanese
12845 Use the locale's alternate numeric symbols for numbers. This modifier
12846 applies only to numeric conversion specifiers.
12849 If the format supports the modifier but no alternate representation
12850 is available, it is ignored.
12853 @node Setting the time
12854 @subsection Setting the time
12856 @cindex setting the time
12857 @cindex time setting
12858 @cindex appropriate privileges
12860 If given an argument that does not start with @samp{+}, @command{date} sets
12861 the system clock to the date and time specified by that argument (as
12862 described below). You must have appropriate privileges to set the
12863 system clock. The @option{--date} and @option{--set} options may not be
12864 used with such an argument. The @option{--universal} option may be used
12865 with such an argument to indicate that the specified date and time are
12866 relative to Coordinated Universal Time rather than to the local time
12869 The argument must consist entirely of digits, which have the following
12882 first two digits of year (optional)
12884 last two digits of year (optional)
12889 The @option{--set} option also sets the system clock; see the next section.
12892 @node Options for date
12893 @subsection Options for @command{date}
12895 @cindex @command{date} options
12896 @cindex options for @command{date}
12898 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12902 @item -d @var{datestr}
12903 @itemx --date=@var{datestr}
12906 @cindex parsing date strings
12907 @cindex date strings, parsing
12908 @cindex arbitrary date strings, parsing
12911 @opindex next @var{day}
12912 @opindex last @var{day}
12913 Display the date and time specified in @var{datestr} instead of the
12914 current date and time. @var{datestr} can be in almost any common
12915 format. It can contain month names, time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm},
12916 @samp{yesterday}, etc. For example, @option{--date="2004-02-27
12917 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"} specifies the instant of time that is
12918 489,392,193 nanoseconds after February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a
12919 time zone that is 5 hours and 30 minutes east of @acronym{UTC}.@*
12920 @xref{Date input formats}.
12922 @item -f @var{datefile}
12923 @itemx --file=@var{datefile}
12926 Parse each line in @var{datefile} as with @option{-d} and display the
12927 resulting date and time. If @var{datefile} is @samp{-}, use standard
12928 input. This is useful when you have many dates to process, because the
12929 system overhead of starting up the @command{date} executable many times can
12932 @item -r @var{file}
12933 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
12935 @opindex --reference
12936 Display the date and time of the last modification of @var{file},
12937 instead of the current date and time.
12944 @opindex --rfc-2822
12945 Display the date and time using the format @samp{%a, %d %b %Y %H:%M:%S
12946 %z}, evaluated in the C locale so abbreviations are always in English.
12950 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
12953 This format conforms to
12954 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2822.txt, Internet
12955 @acronym{RFCs} 2822} and
12956 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc822.txt, 822}, the
12957 current and previous standards for Internet email.
12959 @item --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
12960 @opindex --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
12961 Display the date using a format specified by
12962 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc3339.txt, Internet
12963 @acronym{RFC} 3339}. This is a subset of the @acronym{ISO} 8601
12964 format, except that it also permits applications to use a space rather
12965 than a @samp{T} to separate dates from times. Unlike the other
12966 standard formats, @acronym{RFC} 3339 format is always suitable as
12967 input for the @option{--date} (@option{-d}) and @option{--file}
12968 (@option{-f}) options, regardless of the current locale.
12970 The argument @var{timespec} specifies how much of the time to include.
12971 It can be one of the following:
12975 Print just the full-date, e.g., @samp{2005-09-14}.
12976 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
12979 Print the full-date and full-time separated by a space, e.g.,
12980 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06+05:30}. The output ends with a numeric
12981 time-offset; here the @samp{+05:30} means that local time is five
12982 hours and thirty minutes east of @acronym{UTC}. This is equivalent to
12983 the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S%:z}.
12986 Like @samp{seconds}, but also print nanoseconds, e.g.,
12987 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06.998458565+05:30}.
12988 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N%:z}.
12992 @item -s @var{datestr}
12993 @itemx --set=@var{datestr}
12996 Set the date and time to @var{datestr}. See @option{-d} above.
13003 @opindex --universal
13004 @cindex Coordinated Universal Time
13006 @cindex Greenwich Mean Time
13009 Use Coordinated Universal Time (@acronym{UTC}) by operating as if the
13010 @env{TZ} environment variable were set to the string @samp{UTC0}.
13012 Universal Time is often called ``Greenwich Mean Time'' (@sc{gmt}) for
13013 historical reasons.
13017 @node Examples of date
13018 @subsection Examples of @command{date}
13020 @cindex examples of @command{date}
13022 Here are a few examples. Also see the documentation for the @option{-d}
13023 option in the previous section.
13028 To print the date of the day before yesterday:
13031 date --date='2 days ago'
13035 To print the date of the day three months and one day hence:
13038 date --date='3 months 1 day'
13042 To print the day of year of Christmas in the current year:
13045 date --date='25 Dec' +%j
13049 To print the current full month name and the day of the month:
13055 But this may not be what you want because for the first nine days of
13056 the month, the @samp{%d} expands to a zero-padded two-digit field,
13057 for example @samp{date -d 1may '+%B %d'} will print @samp{May 01}.
13060 To print a date without the leading zero for one-digit days
13061 of the month, you can use the (@acronym{GNU} extension)
13062 @samp{-} flag to suppress
13063 the padding altogether:
13066 date -d 1may '+%B %-d
13070 To print the current date and time in the format required by many
13071 non-@acronym{GNU} versions of @command{date} when setting the system clock:
13074 date +%m%d%H%M%Y.%S
13078 To set the system clock forward by two minutes:
13081 date --set='+2 minutes'
13085 To print the date in @acronym{RFC} 2822 format,
13086 use @samp{date --rfc-2822}. Here is some example output:
13089 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
13092 @anchor{%s-examples}
13094 To convert a date string to the number of seconds since the epoch
13095 (which is 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC), use the @option{--date} option with
13096 the @samp{%s} format. That can be useful in sorting and/or graphing
13097 and/or comparing data by date. The following command outputs the
13098 number of the seconds since the epoch for the time two minutes after the
13102 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00 +0000' +%s
13106 If you do not specify time zone information in the date string,
13107 @command{date} uses your computer's idea of the time zone when
13108 interpreting the string. For example, if your computer's time zone is
13109 that of Cambridge, Massachusetts, which was then 5 hours (i.e., 18,000
13110 seconds) behind UTC:
13113 # local time zone used
13114 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00' +%s
13119 If you're sorting or graphing dated data, your raw date values may be
13120 represented as seconds since the epoch. But few people can look at
13121 the date @samp{946684800} and casually note ``Oh, that's the first second
13122 of the year 2000 in Greenwich, England.''
13125 date --date='2000-01-01 UTC' +%s
13129 An alternative is to use the @option{--utc} (@option{-u}) option.
13130 Then you may omit @samp{UTC} from the date string. Although this
13131 produces the same result for @samp{%s} and many other format sequences,
13132 with a time zone offset different from zero, it would give a different
13133 result for zone-dependent formats like @samp{%z}.
13136 date -u --date=2000-01-01 +%s
13140 To convert such an unwieldy number of seconds back to
13141 a more readable form, use a command like this:
13144 # local time zone used
13145 date -d '1970-01-01 UTC 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
13146 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
13149 Or if you do not mind depending on the @samp{@@} feature present since
13150 coreutils 5.3.0, you could shorten this to:
13153 date -d @@946684800 +"%F %T %z"
13154 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
13157 Often it is better to output UTC-relative date and time:
13160 date -u -d '1970-01-01 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
13161 2000-01-01 00:00:00 +0000
13167 @node arch invocation
13168 @section @command{arch}: Print machine hardware name
13171 @cindex print machine hardware name
13172 @cindex system information, printing
13174 @command{arch} prints the machine hardware name,
13175 and is equivalent to @samp{uname -m}.
13179 arch [@var{option}]
13182 The program accepts the @ref{Common options} only.
13187 @node uname invocation
13188 @section @command{uname}: Print system information
13191 @cindex print system information
13192 @cindex system information, printing
13194 @command{uname} prints information about the machine and operating system
13195 it is run on. If no options are given, @command{uname} acts as if the
13196 @option{-s} option were given. Synopsis:
13199 uname [@var{option}]@dots{}
13202 If multiple options or @option{-a} are given, the selected information is
13203 printed in this order:
13206 @var{kernel-name} @var{nodename} @var{kernel-release} @var{kernel-version}
13207 @var{machine} @var{processor} @var{hardware-platform} @var{operating-system}
13210 The information may contain internal spaces, so such output cannot be
13211 parsed reliably. In the following example, @var{release} is
13212 @samp{2.2.18ss.e820-bda652a #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001}:
13216 @result{} Linux dum 2.2.18 #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001 i686 unknown unknown GNU/Linux
13220 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13228 Print all of the below information, except omit the processor type
13229 and the hardware platform name if they are unknown.
13232 @itemx --hardware-platform
13234 @opindex --hardware-platform
13235 @cindex implementation, hardware
13236 @cindex hardware platform
13237 @cindex platform, hardware
13238 Print the hardware platform name
13239 (sometimes called the hardware implementation).
13240 Print @samp{unknown} if the kernel does not make this information
13241 easily available, as is the case with Linux kernels.
13247 @cindex machine type
13248 @cindex hardware class
13249 @cindex hardware type
13250 Print the machine hardware name (sometimes called the hardware class
13256 @opindex --nodename
13259 @cindex network node name
13260 Print the network node hostname.
13265 @opindex --processor
13266 @cindex host processor type
13267 Print the processor type (sometimes called the instruction set
13268 architecture or ISA).
13269 Print @samp{unknown} if the kernel does not make this information
13270 easily available, as is the case with Linux kernels.
13273 @itemx --operating-system
13275 @opindex --operating-system
13276 @cindex operating system name
13277 Print the name of the operating system.
13280 @itemx --kernel-release
13282 @opindex --kernel-release
13283 @cindex kernel release
13284 @cindex release of kernel
13285 Print the kernel release.
13288 @itemx --kernel-name
13290 @opindex --kernel-name
13291 @cindex kernel name
13292 @cindex name of kernel
13293 Print the kernel name.
13294 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) calls this
13295 ``the implementation of the operating system'', because the
13296 @acronym{POSIX} specification itself has no notion of ``kernel''.
13297 The kernel name might be the same as the operating system name printed
13298 by the @option{-o} or @option{--operating-system} option, but it might
13299 differ. Some operating systems (e.g., FreeBSD, HP-UX) have the same
13300 name as their underlying kernels; others (e.g., GNU/Linux, Solaris)
13304 @itemx --kernel-version
13306 @opindex --kernel-version
13307 @cindex kernel version
13308 @cindex version of kernel
13309 Print the kernel version.
13316 @node hostname invocation
13317 @section @command{hostname}: Print or set system name
13320 @cindex setting the hostname
13321 @cindex printing the hostname
13322 @cindex system name, printing
13323 @cindex appropriate privileges
13325 With no arguments, @command{hostname} prints the name of the current host
13326 system. With one argument, it sets the current host name to the
13327 specified string. You must have appropriate privileges to set the host
13331 hostname [@var{name}]
13334 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13340 @node hostid invocation
13341 @section @command{hostid}: Print numeric host identifier.
13344 @cindex printing the host identifier
13346 @command{hostid} prints the numeric identifier of the current host
13347 in hexadecimal. This command accepts no arguments.
13348 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
13349 @xref{Common options}.
13351 For example, here's what it prints on one system I use:
13358 On that system, the 32-bit quantity happens to be closely
13359 related to the system's Internet address, but that isn't always
13365 @node Modified command invocation
13366 @chapter Modified command invocation
13368 @cindex modified command invocation
13369 @cindex invocation of commands, modified
13370 @cindex commands for invoking other commands
13372 This section describes commands that run other commands in some context
13373 different than the current one: a modified environment, as a different
13377 * chroot invocation:: Modify the root directory.
13378 * env invocation:: Modify environment variables.
13379 * nice invocation:: Modify niceness.
13380 * nohup invocation:: Immunize to hangups.
13381 * su invocation:: Modify user and group ID.
13385 @node chroot invocation
13386 @section @command{chroot}: Run a command with a different root directory
13389 @cindex running a program in a specified root directory
13390 @cindex root directory, running a program in a specified
13392 @command{chroot} runs a command with a specified root directory.
13393 On many systems, only the super-user can do this.@footnote{However,
13394 some systems (e.g., FreeBSD) can be configured to allow certain regular
13395 users to use the @code{chroot} system call, and hence to run this program.
13396 Also, on Cygwin, anyone can run the @command{chroot} command, because the
13397 underlying function is non-privileged due to lack of support in MS-Windows.}
13401 chroot @var{newroot} [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
13402 chroot @var{option}
13405 Ordinarily, file names are looked up starting at the root of the
13406 directory structure, i.e., @file{/}. @command{chroot} changes the root to
13407 the directory @var{newroot} (which must exist) and then runs
13408 @var{command} with optional @var{args}. If @var{command} is not
13409 specified, the default is the value of the @env{SHELL} environment
13410 variable or @command{/bin/sh} if not set, invoked with the @option{-i} option.
13411 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility
13412 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
13414 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13415 options}. Options must precede operands.
13417 Here are a few tips to help avoid common problems in using chroot.
13418 To start with a simple example, make @var{command} refer to a statically
13419 linked binary. If you were to use a dynamically linked executable, then
13420 you'd have to arrange to have the shared libraries in the right place under
13421 your new root directory.
13423 For example, if you create a statically linked @command{ls} executable,
13424 and put it in @file{/tmp/empty}, you can run this command as root:
13427 $ chroot /tmp/empty /ls -Rl /
13430 Then you'll see output like this:
13435 -rwxr-xr-x 1 0 0 1041745 Aug 16 11:17 ls
13438 If you want to use a dynamically linked executable, say @command{bash},
13439 then first run @samp{ldd bash} to see what shared objects it needs.
13440 Then, in addition to copying the actual binary, also copy the listed
13441 files to the required positions under your intended new root directory.
13442 Finally, if the executable requires any other files (e.g., data, state,
13443 device files), copy them into place, too.
13445 @cindex exit status of @command{chroot}
13449 1 if @command{chroot} itself fails
13450 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13451 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13452 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13456 @node env invocation
13457 @section @command{env}: Run a command in a modified environment
13460 @cindex environment, running a program in a modified
13461 @cindex modified environment, running a program in a
13462 @cindex running a program in a modified environment
13464 @command{env} runs a command with a modified environment. Synopses:
13467 env [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
13468 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
13472 Operands of the form @samp{@var{variable}=@var{value}} set
13473 the environment variable @var{variable} to value @var{value}.
13474 @var{value} may be empty (@samp{@var{variable}=}). Setting a variable
13475 to an empty value is different from unsetting it.
13476 These operands are evaluated left-to-right, so if two operands
13477 mention the same variable the earlier is ignored.
13479 Environment variable names can be empty, and can contain any
13480 characters other than @samp{=} and the null character (@acronym{ASCII}
13481 @sc{nul}). However, it is wise to limit yourself to names that
13482 consist solely of underscores, digits, and @acronym{ASCII} letters,
13483 and that begin with a non-digit, as applications like the shell do not
13484 work well with other names.
13487 The first operand that does not contain the character @samp{=}
13488 specifies the program to invoke; it is
13489 searched for according to the @env{PATH} environment variable. Any
13490 remaining arguments are passed as arguments to that program.
13491 The program should not be a special built-in utility
13492 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
13494 @cindex environment, printing
13496 If no command name is specified following the environment
13497 specifications, the resulting environment is printed. This is like
13498 specifying the @command{printenv} program.
13500 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13501 Options must precede operands.
13505 @item -u @var{name}
13506 @itemx --unset=@var{name}
13509 Remove variable @var{name} from the environment, if it was in the
13514 @itemx --ignore-environment
13517 @opindex --ignore-environment
13518 Start with an empty environment, ignoring the inherited environment.
13522 @cindex exit status of @command{env}
13526 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the environment is output
13527 1 if @command{env} itself fails
13528 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13529 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13530 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13534 @node nice invocation
13535 @section @command{nice}: Run a command with modified niceness
13539 @cindex scheduling, affecting
13540 @cindex appropriate privileges
13542 @command{nice} prints or modifies a process's @dfn{niceness},
13543 a parameter that affects whether the process is scheduled favorably.
13547 nice [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
13550 If no arguments are given, @command{nice} prints the current niceness.
13551 Otherwise, @command{nice} runs the given @var{command} with its
13552 niceness adjusted. By default, its niceness is incremented by 10.
13554 Niceness values range at least from @minus{}20 (process has high priority
13555 and gets more resources, thus slowing down other processes) through 19
13556 (process has lower priority and runs slowly itself, but has less impact
13557 on the speed of other running processes). Some systems
13558 may have a wider range of nicenesses; conversely, other systems may
13559 enforce more restrictive limits. An attempt to set the niceness
13560 outside the supported range is treated as an attempt to use the
13561 minimum or maximum supported value.
13563 A niceness should not be confused with a scheduling priority, which
13564 lets applications determine the order in which threads are scheduled
13565 to run. Unlike a priority, a niceness is merely advice to the
13566 scheduler, which the scheduler is free to ignore. Also, as a point of
13567 terminology, @acronym{POSIX} defines the behavior of @command{nice} in
13568 terms of a @dfn{nice value}, which is the nonnegative difference
13569 between a niceness and the minimum niceness. Though @command{nice}
13570 conforms to @acronym{POSIX}, its documentation and diagnostics use the
13571 term ``niceness'' for compatibility with historical practice.
13573 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
13574 built-in utilities}).
13576 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
13577 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
13578 Because many shells have a built-in @command{nice} command, using an
13579 unadorned @command{nice} in a script or interactively may get you
13580 different functionality than that described here.
13582 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13583 Options must precede operands.
13586 @item -n @var{adjustment}
13587 @itemx --adjustment=@var{adjustment}
13589 @opindex --adjustment
13590 Add @var{adjustment} instead of 10 to the command's niceness. If
13591 @var{adjustment} is negative and you lack appropriate privileges,
13592 @command{nice} issues a warning but otherwise acts as if you specified
13595 For compatibility @command{nice} also supports an obsolete
13596 option syntax @option{-@var{adjustment}}. New scripts should use
13597 @option{-n @var{adjustment}} instead.
13601 @cindex exit status of @command{nice}
13605 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the niceness is output
13606 1 if @command{nice} itself fails
13607 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13608 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13609 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13612 It is sometimes useful to run a non-interactive program with reduced niceness.
13615 $ nice factor 4611686018427387903
13618 Since @command{nice} prints the current niceness,
13619 you can invoke it through itself to demonstrate how it works.
13621 The default behavior is to increase the niceness by @samp{10}:
13632 The @var{adjustment} is relative to the current niceness. In the
13633 next example, the first @command{nice} invocation runs the second one
13634 with niceness 10, and it in turn runs the final one with a niceness
13638 $ nice nice -n 3 nice
13642 Specifying a niceness larger than the supported range
13643 is the same as specifying the maximum supported value:
13646 $ nice -n 10000000000 nice
13650 Only a privileged user may run a process with lower niceness:
13654 nice: cannot set niceness: Permission denied
13656 $ sudo nice -n -1 nice
13661 @node nohup invocation
13662 @section @command{nohup}: Run a command immune to hangups
13665 @cindex hangups, immunity to
13666 @cindex immunity to hangups
13667 @cindex logging out and continuing to run
13670 @command{nohup} runs the given @var{command} with hangup signals ignored,
13671 so that the command can continue running in the background after you log
13675 nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
13678 If standard input is a terminal, it is redirected from
13679 @file{/dev/null} so that terminal sessions do not mistakenly consider
13680 the terminal to be used by the command. This is a @acronym{GNU}
13681 extension; programs intended to be portable to non-@acronym{GNU} hosts
13682 should use @samp{nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{} </dev/null}
13686 If standard output is a terminal, the command's standard output is appended
13687 to the file @file{nohup.out}; if that cannot be written to, it is appended
13688 to the file @file{$HOME/nohup.out}; and if that cannot be written to, the
13689 command is not run.
13690 Any @file{nohup.out} or @file{$HOME/nohup.out} file created by
13691 @command{nohup} is made readable and writable only to the user,
13692 regardless of the current umask settings.
13694 If standard error is a terminal, it is normally redirected to the same file
13695 descriptor as the (possibly-redirected) standard output.
13696 However, if standard output is closed, standard error terminal output
13697 is instead appended to the file @file{nohup.out} or
13698 @file{$HOME/nohup.out} as above.
13700 To capture the command's output to a file other than @file{nohup.out}
13701 you can redirect it. For example, to capture the output of
13705 nohup make > make.log
13708 @command{nohup} does not automatically put the command it runs in the
13709 background; you must do that explicitly, by ending the command line
13710 with an @samp{&}. Also, @command{nohup} does not alter the
13711 niceness of @var{command}; use @command{nice} for that,
13712 e.g., @samp{nohup nice @var{command}}.
13714 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
13715 built-in utilities}).
13717 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13718 options}. Options must precede operands.
13720 @cindex exit status of @command{nohup}
13724 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13725 127 if @command{nohup} itself fails or if @var{command} cannot be found
13726 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13730 @node su invocation
13731 @section @command{su}: Run a command with substitute user and group ID
13734 @cindex substitute user and group IDs
13735 @cindex user ID, switching
13736 @cindex super-user, becoming
13737 @cindex root, becoming
13739 @command{su} allows one user to temporarily become another user. It runs a
13740 command (often an interactive shell) with the real and effective user
13741 ID, group ID, and supplemental groups of a given @var{user}. Synopsis:
13744 su [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{user} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
13747 @cindex passwd entry, and @command{su} shell
13749 @flindex /etc/passwd
13750 If no @var{user} is given, the default is @code{root}, the super-user.
13751 The shell to use is taken from @var{user}'s @code{passwd} entry, or
13752 @file{/bin/sh} if none is specified there. If @var{user} has a
13753 password, @command{su} prompts for the password unless run by a user with
13754 effective user ID of zero (the super-user).
13760 @cindex login shell
13761 By default, @command{su} does not change the current directory.
13762 It sets the environment variables @env{HOME} and @env{SHELL}
13763 from the password entry for @var{user}, and if @var{user} is not
13764 the super-user, sets @env{USER} and @env{LOGNAME} to @var{user}.
13765 By default, the shell is not a login shell.
13767 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
13770 @cindex @option{-su}
13771 GNU @command{su} does not treat @file{/bin/sh} or any other shells specially
13772 (e.g., by setting @code{argv[0]} to @option{-su}, passing @option{-c} only
13773 to certain shells, etc.).
13776 @command{su} can optionally be compiled to use @code{syslog} to report
13777 failed, and optionally successful, @command{su} attempts. (If the system
13778 supports @code{syslog}.) However, GNU @command{su} does not check if the
13779 user is a member of the @code{wheel} group; see below.
13781 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13784 @item -c @var{command}
13785 @itemx --command=@var{command}
13788 Pass @var{command}, a single command line to run, to the shell with
13789 a @option{-c} option instead of starting an interactive shell.
13796 @cindex file name pattern expansion, disabled
13797 @cindex globbing, disabled
13798 Pass the @option{-f} option to the shell. This probably only makes sense
13799 if the shell run is @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}, for which the @option{-f}
13800 option prevents reading the startup file (@file{.cshrc}). With
13801 Bourne-like shells, the @option{-f} option disables file name pattern
13802 expansion (globbing), which is not likely to be useful.
13810 @c other variables already indexed above
13813 @cindex login shell, creating
13814 Make the shell a login shell. This means the following. Unset all
13815 environment variables except @env{TERM}, @env{HOME}, and @env{SHELL}
13816 (which are set as described above), and @env{USER} and @env{LOGNAME}
13817 (which are set, even for the super-user, as described above), and set
13818 @env{PATH} to a compiled-in default value. Change to @var{user}'s home
13819 directory. Prepend @samp{-} to the shell's name, intended to make it
13820 read its login startup file(s).
13824 @itemx --preserve-environment
13827 @opindex --preserve-environment
13828 @cindex environment, preserving
13829 @flindex /etc/shells
13830 @cindex restricted shell
13831 Do not change the environment variables @env{HOME}, @env{USER},
13832 @env{LOGNAME}, or @env{SHELL}. Run the shell given in the environment
13833 variable @env{SHELL} instead of the shell from @var{user}'s passwd
13834 entry, unless the user running @command{su} is not the super-user and
13835 @var{user}'s shell is restricted. A @dfn{restricted shell} is one that
13836 is not listed in the file @file{/etc/shells}, or in a compiled-in list
13837 if that file does not exist. Parts of what this option does can be
13838 overridden by @option{--login} and @option{--shell}.
13840 @item -s @var{shell}
13841 @itemx --shell=@var{shell}
13844 Run @var{shell} instead of the shell from @var{user}'s passwd entry,
13845 unless the user running @command{su} is not the super-user and @var{user}'s
13846 shell is restricted (see @option{-m} just above).
13850 @cindex exit status of @command{su}
13854 1 if @command{su} itself fails
13855 126 if subshell is found but cannot be invoked
13856 127 if subshell cannot be found
13857 the exit status of the subshell otherwise
13860 @cindex wheel group, not supported
13861 @cindex group wheel, not supported
13863 @subsection Why GNU @command{su} does not support the @samp{wheel} group
13865 (This section is by Richard Stallman.)
13869 Sometimes a few of the users try to hold total power over all the
13870 rest. For example, in 1984, a few users at the MIT AI lab decided to
13871 seize power by changing the operator password on the Twenex system and
13872 keeping it secret from everyone else. (I was able to thwart this coup
13873 and give power back to the users by patching the kernel, but I
13874 wouldn't know how to do that in Unix.)
13876 However, occasionally the rulers do tell someone. Under the usual
13877 @command{su} mechanism, once someone learns the root password who
13878 sympathizes with the ordinary users, he or she can tell the rest. The
13879 ``wheel group'' feature would make this impossible, and thus cement the
13880 power of the rulers.
13882 I'm on the side of the masses, not that of the rulers. If you are
13883 used to supporting the bosses and sysadmins in whatever they do, you
13884 might find this idea strange at first.
13887 @node Process control
13888 @chapter Process control
13890 @cindex processes, commands for controlling
13891 @cindex commands for controlling processes
13894 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
13898 @node kill invocation
13899 @section @command{kill}: Send a signal to processes
13902 @cindex send a signal to processes
13904 The @command{kill} command sends a signal to processes, causing them
13905 to terminate or otherwise act upon receiving the signal in some way.
13906 Alternatively, it lists information about signals. Synopses:
13909 kill [-s @var{signal} | --signal @var{signal} | -@var{signal}] @var{pid}@dots{}
13910 kill [-l | --list | -t | --table] [@var{signal}]@dots{}
13913 The first form of the @command{kill} command sends a signal to all
13914 @var{pid} arguments. The default signal to send if none is specified
13915 is @samp{TERM}. The special signal number @samp{0} does not denote a
13916 valid signal, but can be used to test whether the @var{pid} arguments
13917 specify processes to which a signal could be sent.
13919 If @var{pid} is positive, the signal is sent to the process with the
13920 process ID @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, the signal is sent to all
13921 processes in the process group of the current process. If @var{pid}
13922 is @minus{}1, the signal is sent to all processes for which the user has
13923 permission to send a signal. If @var{pid} is less than @minus{}1, the signal
13924 is sent to all processes in the process group that equals the absolute
13925 value of @var{pid}.
13927 If @var{pid} is not positive, a system-dependent set of system
13928 processes is excluded from the list of processes to which the signal
13931 If a negative @var{PID} argument is desired as the first one, it
13932 should be preceded by @option{--}. However, as a common extension to
13933 @acronym{POSIX}, @option{--} is not required with @samp{kill
13934 -@var{signal} -@var{pid}}. The following commands are equivalent:
13943 The first form of the @command{kill} command succeeds if every @var{pid}
13944 argument specifies at least one process that the signal was sent to.
13946 The second form of the @command{kill} command lists signal information.
13947 Either the @option{-l} or @option{--list} option, or the @option{-t}
13948 or @option{--table} option must be specified. Without any
13949 @var{signal} argument, all supported signals are listed. The output
13950 of @option{-l} or @option{--list} is a list of the signal names, one
13951 per line; if @var{signal} is already a name, the signal number is
13952 printed instead. The output of @option{-t} or @option{--table} is a
13953 table of signal numbers, names, and descriptions. This form of the
13954 @command{kill} command succeeds if all @var{signal} arguments are valid
13955 and if there is no output error.
13957 The @command{kill} command also supports the @option{--help} and
13958 @option{--version} options. @xref{Common options}.
13960 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
13961 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
13962 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
13963 @samp{SIG}. The case of the letters is ignored, except for the
13964 @option{-@var{signal}} option which must use upper case to avoid
13965 ambiguity with lower case option letters. The following signal names
13966 and numbers are supported on all @acronym{POSIX} compliant systems:
13972 2. Terminal interrupt.
13978 9. Kill (cannot be caught or ignored).
13986 Other supported signal names have system-dependent corresponding
13987 numbers. All systems conforming to @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 also
13988 support the following signals:
13992 Access to an undefined portion of a memory object.
13994 Child process terminated, stopped, or continued.
13996 Continue executing, if stopped.
13998 Erroneous arithmetic operation.
14000 Illegal Instruction.
14002 Write on a pipe with no one to read it.
14004 Invalid memory reference.
14006 Stop executing (cannot be caught or ignored).
14010 Background process attempting read.
14012 Background process attempting write.
14014 High bandwidth data is available at a socket.
14016 User-defined signal 1.
14018 User-defined signal 2.
14022 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 systems that support the @acronym{XSI} extension
14023 also support the following signals:
14029 Profiling timer expired.
14033 Trace/breakpoint trap.
14035 Virtual timer expired.
14037 CPU time limit exceeded.
14039 File size limit exceeded.
14043 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 systems that support the @acronym{XRT} extension
14044 also support at least eight real-time signals called @samp{RTMIN},
14045 @samp{RTMIN+1}, @dots{}, @samp{RTMAX-1}, @samp{RTMAX}.
14051 @cindex delaying commands
14052 @cindex commands for delaying
14054 @c Perhaps @command{wait} or other commands should be described here also?
14057 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time.
14061 @node sleep invocation
14062 @section @command{sleep}: Delay for a specified time
14065 @cindex delay for a specified time
14067 @command{sleep} pauses for an amount of time specified by the sum of
14068 the values of the command line arguments.
14072 sleep @var{number}[smhd]@dots{}
14076 Each argument is a number followed by an optional unit; the default
14077 is seconds. The units are:
14090 Historical implementations of @command{sleep} have required that
14091 @var{number} be an integer, and only accepted a single argument
14092 without a suffix. However, GNU @command{sleep} accepts
14093 arbitrary floating point numbers (using a period before any fractional
14096 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14102 @node Numeric operations
14103 @chapter Numeric operations
14105 @cindex numeric operations
14106 These programs do numerically-related operations.
14109 * factor invocation:: Show factors of numbers.
14110 * seq invocation:: Print sequences of numbers.
14114 @node factor invocation
14115 @section @command{factor}: Print prime factors
14118 @cindex prime factors
14120 @command{factor} prints prime factors. Synopses:
14123 factor [@var{number}]@dots{}
14124 factor @var{option}
14127 If no @var{number} is specified on the command line, @command{factor} reads
14128 numbers from standard input, delimited by newlines, tabs, or spaces.
14130 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14133 The algorithm it uses is not very sophisticated, so for some inputs
14134 @command{factor} runs for a long time. The hardest numbers to factor are
14135 the products of large primes. Factoring the product of the two largest 32-bit
14136 prime numbers takes about 80 seconds of CPU time on a 1.6 GHz Athlon.
14139 $ p=`echo '4294967279 * 4294967291'|bc`
14141 18446743979220271189: 4294967279 4294967291
14144 Similarly, it takes about 80 seconds for GNU factor (from coreutils-5.1.2)
14145 to ``factor'' the largest 64-bit prime:
14148 $ factor 18446744073709551557
14149 18446744073709551557: 18446744073709551557
14152 In contrast, @command{factor} factors the largest 64-bit number in just
14153 over a tenth of a second:
14156 $ factor `echo '2^64-1'|bc`
14157 18446744073709551615: 3 5 17 257 641 65537 6700417
14163 @node seq invocation
14164 @section @command{seq}: Print numeric sequences
14167 @cindex numeric sequences
14168 @cindex sequence of numbers
14170 @command{seq} prints a sequence of numbers to standard output. Synopses:
14173 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{last}
14174 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{last}
14175 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{increment} @var{last}
14178 @command{seq} prints the numbers from @var{first} to @var{last} by
14179 @var{increment}. By default, each number is printed on a separate line.
14180 When @var{increment} is not specified, it defaults to @samp{1},
14181 even when @var{first} is larger than @var{last}.
14182 @var{first} also defaults to @samp{1}. So @code{seq 1} prints
14183 @samp{1}, but @code{seq 0} and @code{seq 10 5} produce no output.
14184 Floating-point numbers
14185 may be specified (using a period before any fractional digits).
14187 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14188 Options must precede operands.
14191 @item -f @var{format}
14192 @itemx --format=@var{format}
14193 @opindex -f @var{format}
14194 @opindex --format=@var{format}
14195 @cindex formatting of numbers in @command{seq}
14196 Print all numbers using @var{format}.
14197 @var{format} must contain exactly one of the @samp{printf}-style
14198 floating point conversion specifications @samp{%a}, @samp{%e},
14199 @samp{%f}, @samp{%g}, @samp{%A}, @samp{%E}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}.
14200 The @samp{%} may be followed by zero or more flags taken from the set
14201 @samp{-+#0 '}, then an optional width containing one or more digits,
14202 then an optional precision consisting of a @samp{.} followed by zero
14203 or more digits. @var{format} may also contain any number of @samp{%%}
14204 conversion specifications. All conversion specifications have the
14205 same meaning as with @samp{printf}.
14207 The default format is derived from @var{first}, @var{step}, and
14208 @var{last}. If these all use a fixed point decimal representation,
14209 the default format is @samp{%.@var{p}f}, where @var{p} is the minimum
14210 precision that can represent the output numbers exactly. Otherwise,
14211 the default format is @samp{%g}.
14213 @item -s @var{string}
14214 @itemx --separator=@var{string}
14215 @cindex separator for numbers in @command{seq}
14216 Separate numbers with @var{string}; default is a newline.
14217 The output always terminates with a newline.
14220 @itemx --equal-width
14221 Print all numbers with the same width, by padding with leading zeros.
14222 @var{first}, @var{step}, and @var{last} should all use a fixed point
14223 decimal representation.
14224 (To have other kinds of padding, use @option{--format}).
14228 You can get finer-grained control over output with @option{-f}:
14231 $ seq -f '(%9.2E)' -9e5 1.1e6 1.3e6
14237 If you want hexadecimal integer output, you can use @command{printf}
14238 to perform the conversion:
14241 $ printf '%x\n' `seq 1048575 1024 1050623`
14247 For very long lists of numbers, use xargs to avoid
14248 system limitations on the length of an argument list:
14251 $ seq 1000000 | xargs printf '%x\n' | tail -n 3
14257 To generate octal output, use the printf @code{%o} format instead
14260 On most systems, seq can produce whole-number output for values up to
14261 at least @math{2^{53}}. Larger integers are approximated. The details
14262 differ depending on your floating-point implementation, but a common
14263 case is that @command{seq} works with integers through @math{2^{64}},
14264 and larger integers may not be numerically correct:
14267 $ seq 18446744073709551616 1 18446744073709551618
14268 18446744073709551616
14269 18446744073709551616
14270 18446744073709551618
14273 Be careful when using @command{seq} with outlandish values: otherwise
14274 you may see surprising results, as @command{seq} uses floating point
14275 internally. For example, on the x86 platform, where the internal
14276 representation uses a 64-bit fraction, the command:
14279 seq 1 0.0000000000000000001 1.0000000000000000009
14282 outputs 1.0000000000000000007 twice and skips 1.0000000000000000008.
14287 @node File permissions
14288 @chapter File permissions
14291 @include getdate.texi
14295 @node Opening the software toolbox
14296 @chapter Opening the Software Toolbox
14298 An earlier version of this chapter appeared in
14299 @uref{http://www.linuxjournal.com/article.php?sid=2762, the
14300 @cite{What's GNU?} column of @cite{Linux Journal}, 2 (June, 1994)}.
14301 It was written by Arnold Robbins.
14304 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
14305 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
14306 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
14307 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
14308 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
14309 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
14310 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
14314 @node Toolbox introduction
14315 @unnumberedsec Toolbox Introduction
14317 This month's column is only peripherally related to the GNU Project, in
14318 that it describes a number of the GNU tools on your GNU/Linux system and how they
14319 might be used. What it's really about is the ``Software Tools'' philosophy
14320 of program development and usage.
14322 The software tools philosophy was an important and integral concept
14323 in the initial design and development of Unix (of which Linux and GNU are
14324 essentially clones). Unfortunately, in the modern day press of
14325 Internetworking and flashy GUIs, it seems to have fallen by the
14326 wayside. This is a shame, since it provides a powerful mental model
14327 for solving many kinds of problems.
14329 Many people carry a Swiss Army knife around in their pants pockets (or
14330 purse). A Swiss Army knife is a handy tool to have: it has several knife
14331 blades, a screwdriver, tweezers, toothpick, nail file, corkscrew, and perhaps
14332 a number of other things on it. For the everyday, small miscellaneous jobs
14333 where you need a simple, general purpose tool, it's just the thing.
14335 On the other hand, an experienced carpenter doesn't build a house using
14336 a Swiss Army knife. Instead, he has a toolbox chock full of specialized
14337 tools---a saw, a hammer, a screwdriver, a plane, and so on. And he knows
14338 exactly when and where to use each tool; you won't catch him hammering nails
14339 with the handle of his screwdriver.
14341 The Unix developers at Bell Labs were all professional programmers and trained
14342 computer scientists. They had found that while a one-size-fits-all program
14343 might appeal to a user because there's only one program to use, in practice
14348 difficult to write,
14351 difficult to maintain and
14355 difficult to extend to meet new situations.
14358 Instead, they felt that programs should be specialized tools. In short, each
14359 program ``should do one thing well.'' No more and no less. Such programs are
14360 simpler to design, write, and get right---they only do one thing.
14362 Furthermore, they found that with the right machinery for hooking programs
14363 together, that the whole was greater than the sum of the parts. By combining
14364 several special purpose programs, you could accomplish a specific task
14365 that none of the programs was designed for, and accomplish it much more
14366 quickly and easily than if you had to write a special purpose program.
14367 We will see some (classic) examples of this further on in the column.
14368 (An important additional point was that, if necessary, take a detour
14369 and build any software tools you may need first, if you don't already
14370 have something appropriate in the toolbox.)
14372 @node I/O redirection
14373 @unnumberedsec I/O Redirection
14375 Hopefully, you are familiar with the basics of I/O redirection in the
14376 shell, in particular the concepts of ``standard input,'' ``standard output,''
14377 and ``standard error''. Briefly, ``standard input'' is a data source, where
14378 data comes from. A program should not need to either know or care if the
14379 data source is a disk file, a keyboard, a magnetic tape, or even a punched
14380 card reader. Similarly, ``standard output'' is a data sink, where data goes
14381 to. The program should neither know nor care where this might be.
14382 Programs that only read their standard input, do something to the data,
14383 and then send it on, are called @dfn{filters}, by analogy to filters in a
14386 With the Unix shell, it's very easy to set up data pipelines:
14389 program_to_create_data | filter1 | ... | filterN > final.pretty.data
14392 We start out by creating the raw data; each filter applies some successive
14393 transformation to the data, until by the time it comes out of the pipeline,
14394 it is in the desired form.
14396 This is fine and good for standard input and standard output. Where does the
14397 standard error come in to play? Well, think about @command{filter1} in
14398 the pipeline above. What happens if it encounters an error in the data it
14399 sees? If it writes an error message to standard output, it will just
14400 disappear down the pipeline into @command{filter2}'s input, and the
14401 user will probably never see it. So programs need a place where they can send
14402 error messages so that the user will notice them. This is standard error,
14403 and it is usually connected to your console or window, even if you have
14404 redirected standard output of your program away from your screen.
14406 For filter programs to work together, the format of the data has to be
14407 agreed upon. The most straightforward and easiest format to use is simply
14408 lines of text. Unix data files are generally just streams of bytes, with
14409 lines delimited by the @acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf} (Line Feed) character,
14410 conventionally called a ``newline'' in the Unix literature. (This is
14411 @code{'\n'} if you're a C programmer.) This is the format used by all
14412 the traditional filtering programs. (Many earlier operating systems
14413 had elaborate facilities and special purpose programs for managing
14414 binary data. Unix has always shied away from such things, under the
14415 philosophy that it's easiest to simply be able to view and edit your
14416 data with a text editor.)
14418 OK, enough introduction. Let's take a look at some of the tools, and then
14419 we'll see how to hook them together in interesting ways. In the following
14420 discussion, we will only present those command line options that interest
14421 us. As you should always do, double check your system documentation
14422 for the full story.
14424 @node The who command
14425 @unnumberedsec The @command{who} Command
14427 The first program is the @command{who} command. By itself, it generates a
14428 list of the users who are currently logged in. Although I'm writing
14429 this on a single-user system, we'll pretend that several people are
14434 @print{} arnold console Jan 22 19:57
14435 @print{} miriam ttyp0 Jan 23 14:19(:0.0)
14436 @print{} bill ttyp1 Jan 21 09:32(:0.0)
14437 @print{} arnold ttyp2 Jan 23 20:48(:0.0)
14440 Here, the @samp{$} is the usual shell prompt, at which I typed @samp{who}.
14441 There are three people logged in, and I am logged in twice. On traditional
14442 Unix systems, user names are never more than eight characters long. This
14443 little bit of trivia will be useful later. The output of @command{who} is nice,
14444 but the data is not all that exciting.
14446 @node The cut command
14447 @unnumberedsec The @command{cut} Command
14449 The next program we'll look at is the @command{cut} command. This program
14450 cuts out columns or fields of input data. For example, we can tell it
14451 to print just the login name and full name from the @file{/etc/passwd}
14452 file. The @file{/etc/passwd} file has seven fields, separated by
14456 arnold:xyzzy:2076:10:Arnold D. Robbins:/home/arnold:/bin/bash
14459 To get the first and fifth fields, we would use @command{cut} like this:
14462 $ cut -d: -f1,5 /etc/passwd
14463 @print{} root:Operator
14465 @print{} arnold:Arnold D. Robbins
14466 @print{} miriam:Miriam A. Robbins
14470 With the @option{-c} option, @command{cut} will cut out specific characters
14471 (i.e., columns) in the input lines. This is useful for input data
14472 that has fixed width fields, and does not have a field separator. For
14473 example, list the Monday dates for the current month:
14475 @c Is using cal ok? Looked at gcal, but I don't like it.
14486 @node The sort command
14487 @unnumberedsec The @command{sort} Command
14489 Next we'll look at the @command{sort} command. This is one of the most
14490 powerful commands on a Unix-style system; one that you will often find
14491 yourself using when setting up fancy data plumbing.
14494 command reads and sorts each file named on the command line. It then
14495 merges the sorted data and writes it to standard output. It will read
14496 standard input if no files are given on the command line (thus
14497 making it into a filter). The sort is based on the character collating
14498 sequence or based on user-supplied ordering criteria.
14501 @node The uniq command
14502 @unnumberedsec The @command{uniq} Command
14504 Finally (at least for now), we'll look at the @command{uniq} program. When
14505 sorting data, you will often end up with duplicate lines, lines that
14506 are identical. Usually, all you need is one instance of each line.
14507 This is where @command{uniq} comes in. The @command{uniq} program reads its
14508 standard input. It prints only one
14509 copy of each repeated line. It does have several options. Later on,
14510 we'll use the @option{-c} option, which prints each unique line, preceded
14511 by a count of the number of times that line occurred in the input.
14514 @node Putting the tools together
14515 @unnumberedsec Putting the Tools Together
14517 Now, let's suppose this is a large ISP server system with dozens of users
14518 logged in. The management wants the system administrator to write a program that will
14519 generate a sorted list of logged in users. Furthermore, even if a user
14520 is logged in multiple times, his or her name should only show up in the
14523 The administrator could sit down with the system documentation and write a C
14524 program that did this. It would take perhaps a couple of hundred lines
14525 of code and about two hours to write it, test it, and debug it.
14526 However, knowing the software toolbox, the administrator can instead start out
14527 by generating just a list of logged on users:
14537 Next, sort the list:
14540 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort
14547 Finally, run the sorted list through @command{uniq}, to weed out duplicates:
14550 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
14556 The @command{sort} command actually has a @option{-u} option that does what
14557 @command{uniq} does. However, @command{uniq} has other uses for which one
14558 cannot substitute @samp{sort -u}.
14560 The administrator puts this pipeline into a shell script, and makes it available for
14561 all the users on the system (@samp{#} is the system administrator,
14562 or @code{root}, prompt):
14565 # cat > /usr/local/bin/listusers
14566 who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
14568 # chmod +x /usr/local/bin/listusers
14571 There are four major points to note here. First, with just four
14572 programs, on one command line, the administrator was able to save about two
14573 hours worth of work. Furthermore, the shell pipeline is just about as
14574 efficient as the C program would be, and it is much more efficient in
14575 terms of programmer time. People time is much more expensive than
14576 computer time, and in our modern ``there's never enough time to do
14577 everything'' society, saving two hours of programmer time is no mean
14580 Second, it is also important to emphasize that with the
14581 @emph{combination} of the tools, it is possible to do a special
14582 purpose job never imagined by the authors of the individual programs.
14584 Third, it is also valuable to build up your pipeline in stages, as we did here.
14585 This allows you to view the data at each stage in the pipeline, which helps
14586 you acquire the confidence that you are indeed using these tools correctly.
14588 Finally, by bundling the pipeline in a shell script, other users can use
14589 your command, without having to remember the fancy plumbing you set up for
14590 them. In terms of how you run them, shell scripts and compiled programs are
14593 After the previous warm-up exercise, we'll look at two additional, more
14594 complicated pipelines. For them, we need to introduce two more tools.
14596 The first is the @command{tr} command, which stands for ``transliterate.''
14597 The @command{tr} command works on a character-by-character basis, changing
14598 characters. Normally it is used for things like mapping upper case to
14602 $ echo ThIs ExAmPlE HaS MIXED case! | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]'
14603 @print{} this example has mixed case!
14606 There are several options of interest:
14610 work on the complement of the listed characters, i.e.,
14611 operations apply to characters not in the given set
14614 delete characters in the first set from the output
14617 squeeze repeated characters in the output into just one character.
14620 We will be using all three options in a moment.
14622 The other command we'll look at is @command{comm}. The @command{comm}
14623 command takes two sorted input files as input data, and prints out the
14624 files' lines in three columns. The output columns are the data lines
14625 unique to the first file, the data lines unique to the second file, and
14626 the data lines that are common to both. The @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and
14627 @option{-3} command line options @emph{omit} the respective columns. (This is
14628 non-intuitive and takes a little getting used to.) For example:
14650 The file name @file{-} tells @command{comm} to read standard input
14651 instead of a regular file.
14653 Now we're ready to build a fancy pipeline. The first application is a word
14654 frequency counter. This helps an author determine if he or she is over-using
14657 The first step is to change the case of all the letters in our input file
14658 to one case. ``The'' and ``the'' are the same word when doing counting.
14661 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | ...
14664 The next step is to get rid of punctuation. Quoted words and unquoted words
14665 should be treated identically; it's easiest to just get the punctuation out of
14669 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' | ...
14672 The second @command{tr} command operates on the complement of the listed
14673 characters, which are all the letters, the digits, the underscore, and
14674 the blank. The @samp{\n} represents the newline character; it has to
14675 be left alone. (The @acronym{ASCII} tab character should also be included for
14676 good measure in a production script.)
14678 At this point, we have data consisting of words separated by blank space.
14679 The words only contain alphanumeric characters (and the underscore). The
14680 next step is break the data apart so that we have one word per line. This
14681 makes the counting operation much easier, as we will see shortly.
14684 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14685 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | ...
14688 This command turns blanks into newlines. The @option{-s} option squeezes
14689 multiple newline characters in the output into just one. This helps us
14690 avoid blank lines. (The @samp{>} is the shell's ``secondary prompt.''
14691 This is what the shell prints when it notices you haven't finished
14692 typing in all of a command.)
14694 We now have data consisting of one word per line, no punctuation, all one
14695 case. We're ready to count each word:
14698 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14699 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | ...
14702 At this point, the data might look something like this:
14715 The output is sorted by word, not by count! What we want is the most
14716 frequently used words first. Fortunately, this is easy to accomplish,
14717 with the help of two more @command{sort} options:
14721 do a numeric sort, not a textual one
14724 reverse the order of the sort
14727 The final pipeline looks like this:
14730 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14731 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | sort -n -r
14740 Whew! That's a lot to digest. Yet, the same principles apply. With six
14741 commands, on two lines (really one long one split for convenience), we've
14742 created a program that does something interesting and useful, in much
14743 less time than we could have written a C program to do the same thing.
14745 A minor modification to the above pipeline can give us a simple spelling
14746 checker! To determine if you've spelled a word correctly, all you have to
14747 do is look it up in a dictionary. If it is not there, then chances are
14748 that your spelling is incorrect. So, we need a dictionary.
14749 The conventional location for a dictionary is @file{/usr/dict/words}.
14750 On my GNU/Linux system,@footnote{Redhat Linux 6.1, for the November 2000
14751 revision of this article.}
14752 this is a is a sorted, 45,402 word dictionary.
14754 Now, how to compare our file with the dictionary? As before, we generate
14755 a sorted list of words, one per line:
14758 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14759 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u | ...
14762 Now, all we need is a list of words that are @emph{not} in the
14763 dictionary. Here is where the @command{comm} command comes in.
14766 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14767 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u |
14768 > comm -23 - /usr/dict/words
14771 The @option{-2} and @option{-3} options eliminate lines that are only in the
14772 dictionary (the second file), and lines that are in both files. Lines
14773 only in the first file (standard input, our stream of words), are
14774 words that are not in the dictionary. These are likely candidates for
14775 spelling errors. This pipeline was the first cut at a production
14776 spelling checker on Unix.
14778 There are some other tools that deserve brief mention.
14782 search files for text that matches a regular expression
14785 count lines, words, characters
14788 a T-fitting for data pipes, copies data to files and to standard output
14791 the stream editor, an advanced tool
14794 a data manipulation language, another advanced tool
14797 The software tools philosophy also espoused the following bit of
14798 advice: ``Let someone else do the hard part.'' This means, take
14799 something that gives you most of what you need, and then massage it the
14800 rest of the way until it's in the form that you want.
14806 Each program should do one thing well. No more, no less.
14809 Combining programs with appropriate plumbing leads to results where
14810 the whole is greater than the sum of the parts. It also leads to novel
14811 uses of programs that the authors might never have imagined.
14814 Programs should never print extraneous header or trailer data, since these
14815 could get sent on down a pipeline. (A point we didn't mention earlier.)
14818 Let someone else do the hard part.
14821 Know your toolbox! Use each program appropriately. If you don't have an
14822 appropriate tool, build one.
14825 As of this writing, all the programs we've discussed are available via
14826 anonymous @command{ftp} from: @*
14827 @uref{ftp://gnudist.gnu.org/textutils/textutils-1.22.tar.gz}. (There may
14828 be more recent versions available now.)
14830 None of what I have presented in this column is new. The Software Tools
14831 philosophy was first introduced in the book @cite{Software Tools}, by
14832 Brian Kernighan and P.J. Plauger (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-03669-X).
14833 This book showed how to write and use software tools. It was written in
14834 1976, using a preprocessor for FORTRAN named @command{ratfor} (RATional
14835 FORtran). At the time, C was not as ubiquitous as it is now; FORTRAN
14836 was. The last chapter presented a @command{ratfor} to FORTRAN
14837 processor, written in @command{ratfor}. @command{ratfor} looks an awful
14838 lot like C; if you know C, you won't have any problem following the
14841 In 1981, the book was updated and made available as @cite{Software Tools
14842 in Pascal} (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-10342-7). Both books are
14843 still in print and are well worth
14844 reading if you're a programmer. They certainly made a major change in
14845 how I view programming.
14847 The programs in both books are available from
14848 @uref{http://cm.bell-labs.com/who/bwk, Brian Kernighan's home page}.
14849 For a number of years, there was an active
14850 Software Tools Users Group, whose members had ported the original
14851 @command{ratfor} programs to essentially every computer system with a
14852 FORTRAN compiler. The popularity of the group waned in the middle 1980s
14853 as Unix began to spread beyond universities.
14855 With the current proliferation of GNU code and other clones of Unix programs,
14856 these programs now receive little attention; modern C versions are
14857 much more efficient and do more than these programs do. Nevertheless, as
14858 exposition of good programming style, and evangelism for a still-valuable
14859 philosophy, these books are unparalleled, and I recommend them highly.
14861 Acknowledgment: I would like to express my gratitude to Brian Kernighan
14862 of Bell Labs, the original Software Toolsmith, for reviewing this column.
14864 @node GNU Free Documentation License
14865 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
14869 @node Concept index
14878 @c Local variables:
14879 @c texinfo-column-for-description: 32